Publications of the University of Eastern Finland
Dissertations in Education, Humanities, and Theology
isbn 978-952-61-0678-6
issn 1798-5625
Publications of the University of Eastern FinlandDissertations in Education, Humanities, and Theology No 24
Kamal Sbiri
Voices from the Margin Rethinking History, Identity, and Belonging in the Contemporary North African Anglophone Novel
Voices from the Margin is a study
that seeks to engage in the post-
colonial debate on the notions of
history, identity, and belonging. By
analyzing three contemporary North
African novels in English, the study
attempts to negotiate alternative
modernities in order to accommodate
those histories in the margin in a
transcultural context. The thesis
shows that transcultural belonging
can help capture the voices in the
margin and help them engage in
a process of reconstructing their
identities in a global milieu.
disser
tation
s | No
24 | Ka
ma
l Sb
iri | V
oices from
the M
argin
Kamal SbiriVoices from the Margin
Rethinking History, Identity, and Belonging in the Con-temporary North African
Anglophone Novel
KAMAL SBIRI
Voices from the Margin
Rethinking History, Identity, and Belonging in the
Contemporary North African Anglophone Novel
Publications of the University of Eastern Finland
Dissertations in Education, Humanities, and Theology
No 24
University of Eastern Finland
Joensuu
2012
Kopijyvä
Joensuu, 2012
Sarjan vastaava toimittaja: Jopi Nyman
Myynti: Itä-Suomen yliopiston kirjasto
ISBN: 978-952-61-0678-6 (nid.)
ISSNL: 1798-5625
ISSN: 1798-5625
ISBN: 978-952-61-0679-3 (PDF)
ISSN: 1798-5633 (PDF)
Sbiri, Kamal
Voices from the Margin. Rethinking History, Identity, and Belonging in the
Contemporary North African Anglophone Novel
Joensuu: University of Eastern Finland, 2012, 160 pages
Publications of the University of Eastern Finland, Dissertations in Education, Humanities,
and Theology; 24
ISBN: 978-952-61-0678-6 (nid.)
ISSNL: 1798-5625
ISSN: 1798-5625
ISBN: 978-952-61-0679-3 (PDF)
ISSN: 1798-5633 (PDF)
Diss.
ABSTRACT: VOICES FROM THE MARGIN. RETHINKING HISTORY,
IDENTITY, AND BELONGING IN THE CONTEMPORARY NORTH AFRICAN
ANGLOPHONE NOVEL
This study attempts to contest the notion of the writing back by emphasizing the act of
post-colonial re-writing. In doing so, this dissertation attempts to engage in the cultural
and theoretical critiques of hegemonies that have long marginalized the new minorities –
inside or outside of their imagined communities – from the post-colonial debates. In
considering new voices that emerge from the margin of the post-colonial canon, this
dissertation argues for new approaches that inform post-colonialism with the new
changes that permeate literary and cultural studies today. This study is concerned with
the emergence of new modes of literary expression from North Africa that consider
English as the language of their voice. In order to clarify such a purpose, this study
engages in the critique of post-colonialism by showing its limitations, as a literary and
cultural theory, in including the emerging voices from the margin, such as those from
North Africa.
While there are several works dealing with the emergence of Arab Anglophone
narrative, no comprehensive study exists that examines North African Anglophone
narratives in particular. In order to overcome such seclusion, the case studies in this
dissertation discuss two novels from Morocco and one from Tunisia, and each novel is
discussed in a separate chapter. The dissertation employs the notion of bricolage as a tool
to analyze the novels by means of deducing theory from the narrative. Deleuze and
Guattari’s approach on minority literature is relevant to my analysis since it emphasizes
the idea of language, identity, and deterritorialization of minorities. The texts address
such issues and further problematize the notion of the post-colonial writing back. The
thesis shows that the notion of transculturality challenges the aspects of the act of writing
back where the emphasis is laid on the act of re-writing. This dissertation concludes that
voices from the margin need to be heard: whereas language needs to be used to monitor
the process of writing back, it is suggested that the process can involve parallel processes
in which the post-colonial subject negotiates her/his past in spatial and temporal ways.
As a result, the North African Anglophone narrative seems to engage not only in the
critique of post-colonialism, but also in the processes of re-defining the post-colonial
identity and re-writing a counter-history of the North African subject. The thesis also
shows that in order to engage in the process of writing back, the post-colonial need to
negotiate their belonging, which can only be imagined transculturally.
Keywords: Anouar Majid – Sabiha Al Khemir – Laila Lalami – Gilles Deleuze – Félix
Guattari – language – North Africa – post-colonialism – minority literature –
deterritorialization – bricolage – writing back – alternative modernity – countermemory –
identity – transculturality.
Sbiri, Kamal
Voices from the Margin. Rethinking History, Identity, and Belonging in the
Contemporary North African Anglophone Novel
Joensuu: University of Eastern Finland, 2012, 160 sivua.
Publications of the University of Eastern Finland, Dissertations in Education, Humanities,
and Theology; 24
ISBN: 978-952-61-0678-6 (nid.)
ISSNL: 1798-5625
ISSN: 1798-5625
ISBN: 978-952-61-0679-3 (PDF)
ISSN: 1798-5633 (PDF)
Diss.
ABSTRAKTI: ÄÄNIÄ MARGINAALISTA. HISTORIAN, IDENTITEETIN JA
KUULUMISEN UUDELLEENAJATTELUA NYKYHETKEN POHJOIS-
AFRIKKALAISESSA ROMAANISSA
Tämä tutkimus pyrkii haastamaan jälkikoloniaalisen takaisinkirjoittamisen käsitteen
korostamalla jälkikoloniaalisen uudelleenkirjoittamisen aktia. Väitöskirja pyrkii
osallistumaan niiden kulttuuristen ja teoreettisten hegemonioiden kritiikkiin, jotka ovat
kauan marginalisoineet kuviteltujen yhteisöjensä sisä- tai ulkopuolella olevat uudet
vähemmistöt jälkikoloniaalisista keskusteluista. Tarkastelemalla jälkikoloniaalisen
kirjallisen kaanonin ulkopuolelta tulevia uusia kirjallisia ääniä, väitöskirja argumentoi
sellaisten uusien lähestymistapojen puolesta, joissa jälkikolonialismi ottaa huomioon
nykypäivän kirjallisuuden ja kulttuurin tutkimusta läpäisevät uudet muutokset.
Tutkimuksessa tarkastellaan Pohjois-Afrikasta tulevaa uutta kirjallisuutta, jossa
käytetään englantia ilmaisun kielenä. Tutkimus osallistuu jälkikolonialistisen
kirjallisuus- ja kulttuuriteorian kritiikkiin osoittamalla sen rajallisuuden Pohjois-Afrikan
kaltaisesta marginaalista tulevia uusia kirjallisia ääniä tarkasteltaessa.
Vaikka englanninkielisen arabikirjallisuuden nousua on tarkasteltu useissa
esityksissä, Pohjois-Afrikan englanninkielisestä kirjallisuudesta ei ole toistaiseksi tehty
mittavia tutkimuksissa. Tämä väitöskirja pyrkii korjaamaan tilannetta tarkastelemalla
kolmea esimerkkiromaania, joista kaksi tulee Marokosta (Anouar Majidin Si Youssef ja
Laila Lalamin Secret Son) ja yksi Tunisiasta (Sabiha Al Khemirin Waiting in the Future for
the Past to Come). Tutkimus hyödyntää analyyttisesti yhdistämisen ja uudelleen
tuottamisen käsitettä (eng. bricolage), jonka avulla teoksista luetaan ulos teoreettista
ajattelua. Myös Gilles Deleuzen ja Félix Guattarin esittämä tapa lähestyä
vähemmistökirjallisuutta on analyyttisesti relevantti, sillä se korostaa kielen, identiteetin
ja vähemmistöjen deterritoriaalisuutta. Tarkasteltavat tekstit käsittelevät näitä teemoja
pyrkien problematisoimaan ajatuksen takaisinkirjoittavasta jälkikoloniaalista.
Tutkimuksen mukaan transkulttuurisuuden käsite haastaa sellaiset takaisinkirjoittamisen
teot, jotka painottavat uudelleenkirjoittamista. Tutkimus esittää, että marginaalin äänien
tulee tulla kuulluiksi. Vaikka kieltä tulee käyttää takaisinkirjoittamisen prosessin
valvonnassa, tutkimuksen mukaan prosessiin voi kuulua erilaisia rinnakkaisia prosesseja,
joissa jälkikoloniaalinen subjekti neuvottelee menneisyyttään erilaisin tilallisin ja ajallisin
tavoin. Tästä johtuen Pohjois-Afrikan englanninkielinen kirjallisuus ei ole pelkkää
jälkikolonialismin kritiikkiä vaan se osallistuu myös jälkikoloniaalisen identiteetin
uudelleenmäärittelyyn sekä pohjois-afrikkalaisen subjektin vastahistorian
uudelleenkirjoittamiseen. Tutkimus osoittaa, että pystyäkseen osallistumaan
takaisinkirjoittamiseen jälkikoloniaalisten subjektien tarvitsee neuvotella kuulumisestaan,
ja sen kuvitteleminen on mahdollista vain transkulttuurisesti.
Avainsanat: Anouar Majid – Sabiha Al Khemir – Laila Lalami – Gilles Deleuze – Félix
Guattari – kieli – Pohjois-Afrikka – jälkikolonialismi – vähemmistökirjallisuus –
deterritorialisaatio – bricolage – takaisinkirjoittaminen – vaihtoehtoinen moderniteetti –
vastamuisti – identiteetti – transkulttuurisuus.
vii
Acknowledgments
This thesis would not have been possible without the guidance of my advisor and the
support of my family and friends.
I would like to express my deepest gratitude to my advisor, Professor Jopi Nyman,
for his guidance, caring, and patience. Professor Nyman has provided me with an
excellent atmosphere for doing research. His criticism and positive attitude have been
significant to the development of the dissertation’s main argument. I would like also to
thank Dr. John A. Stotesbury, for proofreading the language of the final draft of the
manuscript. I also wish to express my gratitude to Professor John McLeod and Professor
Gerald Porter for reading the manuscript. Their comments were encouraging and their
suggestions prompted new critical thinking to complete the final version of the thesis.
A dissertation in Finland is a challenge for a foreigner, especially if the area of
research does not fall within the interests of the locals. I am thankful to the Philosophical
Faculty for providing the research facilities needed to complete this dissertation. I am
also thankful to Amanuensis Kaisu Kortelainen for her help and assistance in matters that
concern the publication and the public defense. I am also indebted to Ms. Rosalia
Stamatakos for her support, help, and encouragement. I have been in constant
communication with her as she has had the opportunity to read chapters from my
dissertation.
I received remarkable support from friends and family in Morocco. In particular I
wish to thank my parents, and brothers and sisters for their support. I owe a special debt
of gratitude to my wife for her patience while I have been away in Finland and her
encouragement with best wishes. Special thanks goes also to Mourad and Abdessamad
Benrahmoune, Mustapha Kharoua, Abderrahim Anbi, and Driss Baba, who as good
friends, were always willing to help and give their best suggestions.
Joensuu, 1 February 2012
Kamal Sbiri
xi
Table of Contents
ABSTRACT .............................................................................................................. iii
ABSTRAKTI ............................................................................................................... v
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS ................................................................................................ vii
TABLE OF CONTENTS .................................................................................................... xi
1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................ 1
1.1 Aims and Research Problem .......................................................................................... 1
1.2 Texts and Contexts .......................................................................................................... 5
1.3 Previous Studies .............................................................................................................. 9
2 BRICOLAGE AND THE DISCOURSE OF TRANSCULTURAL MINORITY:
RE-WRITING POST-COLONIALISM .......................................................................... 11
2.1 Contesting Post-colonialism ........................................................................................ 13
2.2 Bricolage and Minority Literature ............................................................................... 21
2.3 Global Spaces, Transcultural Locations ...................................................................... 31
3 THE MOOR SPEAKS: MEMORY, IDENTITY, AND SPACE IN ANOUAR
MAJID’S SI YOUSSEF .......................................................................................................... 41
3.1 Whose Story? The Moor Fills the Void Between Memory and History ................. 42
3.2 The Moor Writes Back: An Alterative History ........................................................... 55
3.3 Tangier: A Contact Zone .............................................................................................. 67
4 GENDER AND SPACE IN NORTH AFRICA: HOUSE, REMEMORY, AND
HOSPITALITY IN SABIHA AL KHEMIR’S WAITING IN THE FUTURE FOR
THE PAST TO COME ........................................................................................................... 81
4.1 Negotiating Space in the Post-colonial House ........................................................... 82
4.2 Rememory: Liberating the North African Woman ................................................... 94
4.3 Re-defining the Post-colonial Female Space ............................................................ 103
5 ESCAPING POSTCOLONIALITY, RECONSTRUCTING IDENTITIES:
TOWARDS A TRANSCULTURAL BELONGING IN LAILA LALAMI’S
SECRET SON ......................................................................................................................... 111
5.1 A Multilingual Text: Between Language and Translation ..................................... 113
5.2 Gender and Transculturality ..................................................................................... 121
5.3 Aggressive Modernity: Compradors and Post-colonial Minorities ...................... 126
5.4 Towards a Transcultural Un/Belonging ................................................................... 133
xii
6 CONCLUSION ................................................................................................................. 143
WORKS CITED ................................................................................................................. 149
1
1 Introduction
This study aims to engage in the cultural and theoretical critiques of hegemonies that
have long marginalized the new minorities – inside or outside of their imagined
communities – from both the post-colonial debates and the process of writing back. A
reader of this dissertation may perhaps be involved in the critique that develops what
Edward Chamberlin calls “the new world” of the major minorities (1993, 187). This is a
world from which the voices from the margin of post-colonialism can emerge and engage
in forming new versions of memories and countermemories in North Africa. To put it
simply, this study aims to contribute to the debate that the writers of The Empire Writes
Back initiated by considering texts written in English from geographical spaces that have
not necessarily been colonized by Britain, i.e., North Africa. A shift in focus is already
underway, and to critically reflect on this shift, the study aims at locating the emerging
North African Anglophone novel within post-colonialism. This emergence is due to the
fact that there has been more focus, on the one hand, on works that have emerged in
post-colonial countries that were once part of the British Empire, such as India, the
Caribbean, East and West Africa, and Middle East and, on the other hand, on the
Francophone writings. As little attention has been given to this form of literary
production in English from this geographical space, it seems that there is a need to assign
new importance to this category. Its importance stems from the possibility of revisiting
the North African literature so that new voices can articulate their concerns as
deterritorialized minorities. It is also noteworthy that North African Anglophone writers
have not yet been studied collectively, and studies that have examined literary
production from North Africa have either aimed at focusing on the Arab or Francophone
narratives, or have merely analyzed single Anglophone novels in individual essays. In
contrast, this study considers this emergence using an inclusive approach.
1.1 AIMS AND RESEARCH PROBLEM
While the North African region consists of Mauritania, Morocco, Tunisia, Algeria, Libya,
and Egypt, my focus will be restricted to Tunisia, Morocco, and Algeria for two main
reasons: historical and technical. With regard to the historical, North Africa has been
under the dominion of three main colonial powers: France (in Tunisia, Morocco,
Mauritania, and Algeria), Italy (in Libya), and Britain (in Egypt). The French colonial
legacy in these four countries has created interesting sites where one can reflect on new
modes of writings. These new modes seem to shift the focus from adopting French as the
language of writing to the English language as a means of post-colonial bricolage. Such a
shift is also vibrant and provides a medium for reconsidering North Africa as a space for
identity construction that goes beyond what is cultural, religious, or national. At the
technical level, the lack of a diversified corpus restricts my choice of data and demands a
reformulation at the theoretical onset of this study. Consequently, three novels from two
2
nations form the case studies to be analyzed: two from Morocco and one from Tunisia.
Even though similarities do exist concerning Morocco, Algeria, and Tunisia, it is not my
intention to construct any generalized conclusion, as each of the imagined communities
may have its own cultural, social, and even historical specificities. Whereas Mauritania is
excluded because of its difference from these three countries – as a sub-Saharan country –
culturally, socially, and historically, Egypt and Libya are excluded due to their colonial
histories (not directly bound to French colonialism). In trying to frame my argument
within the geographical space of North Africa, I am emphasizing the following aspects:
language and history, identity, and transcultural belonging.
It is certainly true that in creating the “locations we study” one tends to “remap the
geographies of literary and cultural forms” (Jay, 2010: 4). The space of North Africa has
been structured and restructured on the colonial maps. Names have been erased, and
places have been established, and the history of a new generation has been left to the
hand of the progeny of the colonial powers. It can be said that only France might have
access to the historical archive of North Africa, and yet the intention of the post-colonial
to free the self from the power structure of the colonial language may result in new forms
of writing history without necessarily writing back to the canon. English, in North Africa
(as would be the case of French in India for instance), provides this kind of opportunity
to remap the geographies of not only literary and cultural forms but also memory, which
in turn implies new forms of countermemory.
North Africa has been, and still is, exclusively a French province in which the
margin for alternative representations to negotiate the political, economical, and social
changes is small. To write in English can provoke certain challenges to literary and
cultural theorists and critics whose focus on North African literature combines both
French and Arabic literature. Ahmed Boukous notes that, whereas French is deemed the
“colonial stratum”, the emergence of the English language in Morocco is considered a
part of the “imperial stratum” that makes Moroccan English a product of “localization
and globalization” (2008, 134-8). Nevertheless, with regard to this, to write in English
might inspire consideration of new methodologies and theoretical frameworks that
appropriate and transform the field of post-colonial studies into a larger arena that is
now characterized by the word “trans”- transcultural, transnational, and translational.
The increasing engagements in post-colonial studies have engendered a legacy that every
post-colonial writer has to start with/write against the colonial, and, accordingly, this
dissertation will also take the colonial as its point of departure, but with a rather different
focus.
The North African writes in English because s/he aims not at restoring or
romanticizing the past but at reading the past in order to make sense of the present. The
act of writing pioneers an engagement with a silent past that has been erased from the
memory of the collective in North Africa: a minor past. To invoke the memory of the
minoritarian is to foreground another form of countermemory that compels us to extend
the post-colonial horizon in order to include the minoritarian, though fragile but
significant, account of history as a collective version of memory. The minority seeks a
“line of flight”, as Deleuze and Guattari remind us (1986, 14), in order to deconstruct the
fixity of the notion of history that the mainstream represents. In addition, to reflect on the
3
term minority is to bring into discussion all that is political, social, cultural, historical, and
economic in the debate on the notion of voices from the margin. The term minority or
minoritarian does not imply minority in its normative aspect, such as that defined in
contrast to the majority, but it is a new approach, an epistemology, and a construct that
emerges from the inner structure of power of the majority and whose flavor is the
revolutionary. Subsequently, the North African writes in English for a political purpose in
order to take advantage of the diminutive space available as one such possibility to
deconstruct the binary of Mashreq/Maghreb. It can also be a way to reorient the narrative
map in the Arab Anglophone literary space, where English flourishes today.
It is pertinent to argue that North African literary production has also been
marginalized in the Arab literary and cultural map. In saying this, it is acknowledged
that a number of elements have contributed to this divide between North Africa (Al
Maghreb) and the Middle East (Al Mashreq) as regards the question of language. This
division has maintained currency since the era of colonialism. As a result, North Africa
has been identified more with Europe than the Eastern Arab cultures. In their Dialogue of
the Mashreq and Maghreb, Mohammed Abed al Jabri and Hassan Hanafi argue that the
terms Mashreq and Maghreb are a creation of colonialism that aimed at a drastic divide
of the Arab World, so that people from Morocco, for instance, could be more Westernized
than the Islamized, orthodox people of Saudi Arabia (1990, 7). This book executes a
dialogue between two intellects, al Jabri from Morocco and Hanafi from Egypt, and
addresses the core issue of this division. It also calls for an end to the use of these labels
(Mashreq-Maghreb) and focuses instead on the Arab Islamic world in its general sphere.
Nevertheless, the division is obvious in the construction of Arab Anglophone writing.
The rubrics Arab or Muslim are too wide for naming the emerging literature by North
African writers. Such a geographical distinction (Mashreq and Maghreb) does not,
however, evoke a post-colonial categorization similar to that of New Literatures in
English or literature of the Commonwealth. The aim is to position the North African
Anglophone novel in post-colonial literature. Middle Eastern writers seem to have a long
history of writing in English. The same would apply, to a certain degree, to North African
writing in French. Thus, writing in French flourishes today, whereas writing in English is
relatively new with regard to the North African novel.
The corpus of Arab writing in French in North Africa rests mainly on issues of
identity, hybridity, and the post-colonial condition. Many Francophone writers express a
certain sense of alienation and exile that emanates from the post-colonial condition. Their
writings are haunted by memories of the past and the condition of the future that
characterize a return home. In contrast with these Francophone writers, those who write
in Arabic can be said to address sociopolitical issues, intimacies, colonialism, post-
colonialism, and the issue of Arabization itself (the process of “Arabizing” the social
system in North Africa). Even though similarities may exist, the North African novel in
English may differ significantly from the Arab and Francophone novel. Interestingly
enough, North African Anglophone fiction may help to reach a larger audience than its
Arabic counterpart, for instance. It may also help in promoting a more in-depth
discussion of the transcultural identity as articulated in English by those writing outside
the nation.
4
The North African novel in English can be seen to be a new mode of writing back
and a way to remap the structure of North African literature. At the same time, it can also
be viewed as a way to re-route post-colonial studies. To use memory in order to establish
a platform for a countermemory suggests a typological convention that determines the
minimal level of authenticity that this literature might achieve. To account for the history
of reception by reference to such a newly emergent mode of narrative would be
inappropriate, because the fact that such a narrative is written in English makes it
enmeshed in what is called the transnational novel. The question more directly rests on
the notion of hospitality as an indication of a freeing of the voice. The term hospitality is
important to the North African novel in English, in essence because it generates a larger
space where writers can negotiate their positions in post-colonial society at home or away.
Such literature is emblematic of the transnational epoch in which borderlines are
deconstructed, nations become trans-nations, and the belief in the transcultural belonging,
let alone the feeling of no-belonging, permeates the writer’s narrative.
To reorient ourselves around this issue, transculturality becomes the aspect that
makes the minoritarian live without the cultural boundaries imposed by the nation. In
order to give a voice and to rewrite the past and the present, it is imperative for the North
African to belong to transculturality and collaborate with the transcultural
responsibilities. The transcultural dissimilitude requires each to recognize the subjectivity
of the other that is indexed in the question of incommensurability. The minoritarian,
revolutionary North African novel in English implies that new directions must be
considered in literary and cultural studies, and that to link a certain region to the former
colonial power becomes a legacy of the past that needs to be reviewed and reoriented.
Theories of post-colonialism prove their inadequacy in inhabiting rapid changes in
literary and cultural studies. In accounting for postcoloniality, which is no longer tied up
with post-colonialism, we need wider approaches that will inaugurate the beginning of
new forms of modernity.
Furthermore, it is important to note that to delve into the issue of transculturality of
subjectivities requires a different identity politics that discards differences and adopts a
more general economy of incommensurability as a key element in literary studies. It is in
no way possible to dwell on difference as an aspect of cultural syncretism. Rather,
transcultural forms of identities demand that one should think of other forms of
modernity that exclude the post-colonial division of subjectivities into the colonial and
the post-colonial, and engages instead in cosmopolitanism as a device of the new form of
modernity. In this sense, it is my intention to argue that the North African novel delves
into questions of language, identity, and history mainly to further the discussion on other
forms of modernity and to contribute to the post-colonial debate on the notion of
transculturality. To do this, one needs to think of new approaches to analyzing such
narratives without necessarily neglecting the importance of the post-colonial and the new
currents in the region.
Up to this point, I have already foregrounded the points that I seek to address in
this dissertation. To elaborate them clearly I would like to cite the main questions and
points that I aim to answer and clarify. First, in order to locate the North African novel in
English, I argue that new epistemologies need to be taken into consideration. Because
5
terms such as post-colonialism or new literatures in English designate a rather different
framework that may or may not exclude this emergent literature in English from the
post-colonial debate, I aim to emphasize the importance of bricolage as a methodological
aproach of re-writing modernity. Second, the question arises of how the North African
Anglophone writer re-writes the past, and what mechanisms are used in the process of
re-writing? Third, how does the North African writer in diaspora re-imagine space in
relation to gender? And fourth, in what ways does transculturality enable the
minoritarian to belong and to sketch the patterns for alternative forms of modernity?
1.2 TEXTS AND CONTEXTS
The attempt to answer these questions will emerge from analysis of three texts written in
English by North African writers. Chapter 2 aims to chart critical approaches through the
main concepts to be applied in the analytical chapters, with the aim of considering new
approaches for examining this emerging narrative in North Africa. This will lead us to
inscribe the notion of bricolage as an approach to the analysis of the novels. Furthermore,
I will argue that these novels follow the pattern of what Deleuze and Guattari call a
deterritorialized mode of narrative, whereby language represents an important aspect in
its construction. Following this line, I will argue that to start from the colonial in order to
write back seems to locate the post-colonial within the scope of the colonial itself.
However, the North African Anglophone novel seems to provide new modes of writing
back in which transculturality can be employed as an opportunity for the minoritarian to
engage in the post-colonial debates. In this vein, to be a transcultural can invoke the
possibility of becoming a diasporan, without necessarily functioning overseas. The
chance to integrate the critical discourses of post-colonialism and globalization with that
of minority narrative suggests an approach that transcends the epistemological and
ontological understanding of certain contemporaneities. As an effect of the discourses of
globalization, cultural syncretism, and displacement that shape the era of the 21st century,
minoritarian narratives insistently call for a voice that copes with such transformation
that affects literary and cultural studies at large.
Notwithstanding, this transcultural turn in literary and cultural studies challenges
our understanding of narratives in the English language that are emerging from countries
that have no direct or indirect contact with, for instance, the British Empire. Globalization
and transculturality remain two trajectories that bring the question of minorities and
hospitality to the fore of this analysis. In other words, the subsequent emergence of
voices from the margins of post-colonialism aims at a total engagement with such
narratives politically, socially, historically, and culturally and thereby obliterates any
instances of what Spivak calls “epistemic violence”, a process where knowledge
functions as a means of producing negative representations about the other (cf. Spivak
1988, 280-1). To invoke a minoritarian voice in the emerging Anglophone narratives from
North Africa suggests that the aspect of reading history provided by the majority in this
geographical space need not be totalized. The reason for this rejection is to help to clarify
the ambiguity maintained in the “major” history and to sustain the act of re-writing
history from the margin, which can be achieved through unveiling certain hidden corners
6
in the historical archive. By starting from the post-colonial discourse and ending with
transculturality, I aim at opening up new horizons in approaching the North African
Anglophone narrative differently.
To link the theoretical with the methodological, I will use Deleuze and Guattari’s
approach on minority literature, with an emphasis laid on the notion of bricolage as a
tool for my analysis. According to Deleuze and Guattari, a minor literature designates a
new understanding to literature in the sense that it attacks the major language from
within its structure of meaning (cf. Deleuze and Guattari 1986). By the use of a
deterritorialized English (e.g., English mixed for instance with Arabic as one’s first
language), the minor subject will be able to negotiate her/his identity and space within
the major culture. To quote Deleuze and Guattari, “only the possibility of setting up a
minor practice of major language from within allows one to define popular literature,
marginal literature, and so on” (1986, 18). In addition, the relative emphasis on language
as a site of struggle has been enabling for the minoritarian. The use of the major language
(English) reinforces the optimism of inclusion in the majority, especially in the hope of
deconstructing the potential danger of exclusion from cultural memory. Language in this
sense connects two distinct facades harmoniously. English connects the minor to the host
land, whereas connection to the homeland is a matter of cultural memory as reflected in
the use of Arabic words and cultural concepts.
I will link this question of language and cultural memory with the imagining of
transcultural communities. By writing in English the North African writer creates an
imagined community through different kinds of alignments at home or overseas, be they
memorial, historical, familial, ethnic or gendered, and so on. These identifications require
that the North African subject live in two places at one time. In other words, the post-
colonial subject inserts her/his cultural concepts into the major language through the
medium of cultural memory. Also, s/he gives new meanings to each space s/he comes to
inhabit through that memory itself.
In order to understand the transition from language to history, identity, and
belonging I will shift the focus from the theoretical to the analytical by analyzing the
three novels. Chapter 3 will therefore be devoted to the study of the first novel. Anouar
Majid’s Si Yussef (2005 [1992]) is a story of an old man, Si Yussef, told by Lamin, a young
university student, and narrated by different characters. Chourouq Nasri describes the
novella as Majid’s “psychological journey […] into the idealized past of Tangier” (2006,
27). The narrative describes the complexity of Lamin’s identity and Si Yussef’s desire to
re-write his past. Lamin encounters Si Yussef in Ashab Café in the city of Tangier and
they continue to meet for twelve days: four weeks before the death of Si Yussef. Lamin
learns of Si Yussef’s death three months later when he arrives back from Fés.
Si Yussef has worked as a tourist guide in the old city of Tangier, and later as a
bookkeeper at La Gazelle’s when he managed to marry the Spanish Christian woman,
Lucia. In the twelve-days encounter with Si Yussef in the Ashab Café, Lamin also seeks a
“psychological” journey into the past in order to re-constitute his identity in the new
Tangier. To do this, Lamin manages to tell the world about Si Yussef’s story. During the
course of narration, there seem to be certain gaps that Lamin fills in from his imagination.
He manages to meet both Si Yussef’s wife, before she dies, and his children to tell them
7
about his plan to write a book about Si Yussef’s memory. The English language remains
the main tool to make Si Yussef’s voice heard by the world. However, English becomes
also a site of identity construction where Lamin explains this as being “a nightmare” for
one to write in a third language (Majid 2005, 83).
In addition, to implicate identity with language, Lamin’s aim lies in making the
Tanjawi’s voice articulated in the world. Because Si Youssef wants his narrative to be
listened to/read by a wider audience than his home culture, Lamin puts himself in the
position of the reader who can give hope for North African literature in English to be
recognized. The questions of language, history, and memory are central to the structure
of the novel, in which the notion of place is also emphasized.
Sabiha Al Khemir’s first novel Waiting in the Future for the Past to Come (1993) will be
in the focus of Chapter 4. The narrative follows the feelings of Amina as a child in Kurba
(a small town in Tunisia), as a university student, and as an adult after she graduates. The
narrative opens when Amina returns from Britain to celebrate her graduation with her
mother, yet such a return reveals Amina’s identity as a split one. Using flashbacks, the
narrative moves between the real and the imagined to picture the changing of both
Amina’s emotions and the cultural values in Tunisia. Amina’s memories of her childhood
in Kurba and her life in the capital problematize her identity construction. Among the
stories she recalls is her childhood confinement in the family house where her uncles
sought to guard the family honor after the death of Amina’s father.
The smell of bread in the beginning of the novel suggests that the novel is about the
past and memories. It starts by painting a subtle picture of the cultural values of Tunisia
for an English reader by installing Arabic words, of which a glossary is provided in the
beginning. Amina’s account of her past begins to unfold: as her mother begins “knitting”
her own memories, she creates stories within stories. The concept of rememory is crucial
to the analysis of the Al Khemir’s novel.
In addition, Amina’s story seems to be Al Khemir’s own story. Amina’s account of
her past in the present seems to be an escape from her childhood confinement between
Kurba and the city of Tunis before and after her voyage to Britain. Kurba is also Al
Khemir’s town, and the École Normale Supérieure of Tunis, where Amina studies, is the
college where Al Khemir graduated in 1986 with a “degree in English Literature” (Shear
2009). It can be said that Amina’s story is an account of the childhood of Al Khemir’s,
who has later decided to live in Britain.
Even though Al Khemir’s narrative seems to subtly “design” two different cultures
of Tunisia before and after colonialism, the narrative seems to problematize the post-
colonial identity of Tunisia. This aspect is clearly indicated in Amina’s inability to take a
stand over living in Tunisia. Amina is incapable of deciding whether to stay at home or
leave for England. The narrative, also, employs the language of the body to delve into the
protagonist’s sense of alienation, given the heart-rending process she has undertaken to
refine her past. The post-colonial space becomes contested in this novel: Amina’s identity
is negotiated in the present through the medium of ethnic memory in order to reveal the
urgency of the call of minority literature to give a voice to the category of North African
writers in English.
8
Chapter 5 engages in the questions of belonging and transculturality in post-
colonial North Africa. It also questions new epistemologies that the North African
Anglophone writer employs in order to re-write modernity, by taking Laila Lalami’s
novel Secret Son (2009) as an example. The narrative maps out the life of the protagonist
Youssef, a student of English at the university, and his mother, Rachida, in Morocco. It
follows Youssef El Mekki who was born out of marriage to Rachida. At the age of 19,
Youssef discovers that he is not the son of El Mekki as his mother told him, but he is the
illegitimate son of a wealthy man called Nabil Amrani.
Youssef’s dream of re-establishing connection with his father becomes yet another
journey that forces him to re-constitute his identity. At college, Youssef realizes the
existence of another life in Casablanca beyond the slum of Hay An Najat, where he lives.
This aspect forces Youssef to search for his father and start a process of re-writing his
identity. The journey from the slum to the metropolitan Casablanca enables Youssef to
partly live the life he seeks. However, such a life remains a secret because his father
installs him in a penthouse apartment beyond the reach of Amrani’s “legitimate” family.
Youssef learns from his father that he has a sister, but since his father refuses to present
him to the other family, Youssef is unable to meet his sister. Dissatisfaction penetrates
Youssef, and his dream to be with his father becomes a nightmare when he is dismissed
from both his job and the apartment.
Youssef, after leaving his mother for the sake of the father and his short journey
from slum of Hay An Najat to the metropolitan Casablanca, decides to go back to his
imagined community in the slum. In Hay An Najat, the Islamic Party, Hizb, is gaining
ground through helping the underprivileged in the slum. Simultaneously, the feeling of
agony and the suffering from his father’s negligence, Youssef agrees to join the Party and
support his friend to “slaughter” one of his father’s friends, the journalist Benaboud. The
novel ends when Youssef is caught by the police as a suspect for the murder.
Nevertheless, Secret Son seems to go beyond such themes in the ways the narrative
expresses the feeling of alienation from class-based culture. In effect, to write in English
can be seen as a way of attacking the privilege enjoyed by the old revolutionist, the new
Francophone, neo-liberalist elites representing the majority within Moroccan culture.
Youssef and his sister, Amal, engage in a process of negotiating globalization: where
Youssef fails, Amal succeeds. The novel aims at conveying the message of the minorities,
that in order to negotiate globalization one needs to belong to transculturation.
What is significant in the three novels I have chosen to study is the fact that the
main character in each novel is a student of English. To project this aspect on the authors
themselves, we can presume that Sabiha Al Khemir, Anouar Majid, and Laila Lalami
have been exposed to English as students in one of the English departments in their home
countries. Travel to the United States or Britain has been part of the process of continuing
their studies. Sabhia Al Khemir moved to Britain to earn her MA in 1986 and PhD in 1990,
majoring in the History of Islamic Studies and Archeology. Laila Lalami went to England
to earn a Master’s in Linguistics and has moved to the United States to complete a PhD in
English linguistics. Anouar Majid is currently the director of the Center for Global
Humanities and Associate Provost for Global Initiatives at the University of New
England.
9
While there are other narratives by North African writers, in this thesis the focus
will be laid on narratives available in print. Mohamed Laamiri has created a bibliography
of all those writers whose novels, short stories, and poems appeared initially in English.
What is unique in his bibliography is that almost all those that he cites are by professors
or teachers of English (Laamiri 2008, np.). Consequently, my study will focus mainly on
the overseas writing, with a reading that centers on re-writing the imagined community.
1.3 PREVIOUS STUDIES
Even though North African writing in English can be seen as a new phenomenon in post-
colonial English literary studies and in North Africa itself, very few studies have been
undertaken to include their works for analysis. In her “Overview” in the Arab Voices in
Diaspora, for instance, Layla Al Maleh outlines the changes that come with the emergence
of the Arab Anglophone literatures from the 1950s to the contemporary Arab
Anglophone writers. She points out that the difference between those who wrote in the
1950s and those in early 1990s originates in the diverse topics they have undertaken to
emphasize their ethnicity. She notes that “whereas Arab immigrants to the USA […] were
busy settling down and assimilating, Anglophone Arab writing was beginning to shift its
locus elsewhere” (2009, 6). This “elsewhere” emanates from the fascination with the
Englishness that could be seen in the universities and that was inspired by the
Anglophone lifestyle, which ultimately expresses the difference from their lifestyle at
home. In this period, such literature was the outcome of the writing emerging from
within the mainstream of England and its discourse of Englishness: the production was
“not from a locally emergent language, an appropriation or subversion of it or from the
desire to challenge its dominance” (Al Maleh 2009, 7). For a long time after 1970, works
written in English by Arabs were mainly the offspring of exile and diaspora. The main
themes were the Arab-Israel war, escaping Arab despotism, and the desire to provide a
voice and to be heard. As Al Maleh suggests, much of the Arab Anglophone literatures
resonates between home and diaspora, nurturing a complex identity located in the
hybrid and liminal space of “inbetwixity” (2009, 38).
It is noteworthy that, although Al Maleh has included Lalami’s first work in her
account, the contributors to the Arab Voices in Diapora seem to focus mostly on the
Mashreq Anglophone writers. Furthermore, books such as Arab Voices in Diaspora (cf. Al
Maleh 2009), Steven Salaita’s Arab American Literary Fictions, Cultures, and Politics (2007),
and Amin Malak’s Muslim Narrative and the Discourse of English (2004) mostly concern the
Arabs writing in English from the Mashreq (mostly Lebanese, Jordanian and Egyptian).
The rubrics “Arab” or “Muslim” are too wide to be used to name the emerging literature
produced by Arab writers. Sometimes even those from Pakistan or India are considered
Arabs: “It did not seem to matter who was who, so long as the names and titles fed the
euphoria of luring the reader to a better comprehension of the ‘terrorist other’” (Al Maleh
2009, 2).
In addition, Geoffrey Nash’s interest in Arabs writing in English has resulted in a
book entitled The Arab Writer in English: Arab Themes in a Metropolitan Language, 1908-1958.
In this book, Nash aims mainly at exploring the aspects that influence an Arab to write in
10
English and whether postcoloniality can be seen as a condition for their writings. As
indicated in the title, the book traces Arab writing in English over five decades by taking
four major Arab Anglophone writers between 1908 and 1958. Even though the scope of
the title seems to include the Mashreq and the Maghreb, Nash’s thesis focuses on writers
from the Middle East such as Ameen Rihani, Khalil Jibran, George Antonius, and Edward
Atiyah.
This does not, however, explain the current absence of adequate academic interest
in North African Anglophone novel. Very few studies have tended to include the
emerging North African Anglophone writers in their scope. Jacqueline Jondot, for
instance, has pointed to Anouar Majid and Sabiha Al Khemir in her dissertation Les
Ecrivains d'Expression Anglaise au Proche Orient Arabe, but her focus has mainly been
comparative, which makes the Mashreq a more focalized aspect for study.
As a North African, Nouri Gana’s interest in Arab Anglophone narrative has
resulted in significant articles such as “In Search of Andalusia: Reconfiguring Arabness in
Diana Abu-Jaber’s Crescent,” (2008) and “Everyday Arabness: The Poetics of Arab
Canadian Literature and Film” (2009). Gana’s forthcoming edited collection initially
entitled The Rise of the Arab Novel in English: The Politics of Anglo Arab and Arab American
Literature and Culture may be a significant contribution that focusses on the rise of North
African Anglophone literature. In considering his position as a North African critic, his
works on the Arab writers in English may help to expand the horizon of the Arab
Anglophone novel for future research.
Yet, the reason for this neglect may be linguistic and related to language power, and
especially to the weight that Amazigh, Arabic, and French have in North Africa. The
corpus of North African Arabs writing in French centers mainly on issues of identity,
hybridity, and the post-colonial condition in North Africa. Many works express a certain
sense of alienation and exile that emanates from the heritage of colonialism. The writings
by Francophone Arabs are haunted by memories of the past and visions of the future that
characterize their return home. Most of those who write in French have lived for a
lengthy time in France or their studies have been conducted mainly using French: these
writers include Driss Chraibi, Abdelkebir Khatibi, and Abdelatif Laabi in Morocco; Assia
Djebar, Leïla Sebbar, and Mohammed Dib in Algeria, and Gisèle Halimi; and Hédi
Bouraoui in Tunisia. Their writings have also been preoccupied with the tension arising
between modernity and tradition at home. Nevertheless, I will argue that North African
Anglophone writing is a new area of research. Among the critics whom I cited above only
Jacqueline Jondot from France and Nouri Gana from Tunisia seem to display an interest
in the North African novel in English. This dissertation, therefore, is a contribution to
such efforts, with the aim of refining post-colonial literary studies by placing an emphasis
on the act of re-writing.
In sum, my reading of North African Anglophone narratives aims at presenting a
deconstructive approach to the “idea” of post-colonial literature. In Chapter 2, I will
attempt to locate the emerging literature of North Africa in the global space. The notions
of bricolage and transculturality will serve to locate this literature geographically resting
as it does at the meeting of several boundaries as a literature of the minoritarian.
11
2 Bricolage and the
Discourse of Transcultural
Minority: Re-writing Post-
colonialism
By the ‘right to narrate’, I mean to suggest all those forms of creative behavior that
allow us to represent the lives we lead, question the conventions and customs that
we inherit, dispute and propagate the ideas and ideals that come to us most
naturally […] When you fail to protect the right to narrate, you are in danger of
filling the silence with sirens, megaphones, hectoring voices carried by
loudspeakers from the podiums of great height over people who shrink into
indistinguishable masses. (Bhabha 2003, 180-1)
If a language seems to represent ‘us’ because it is ‘ours’, what of a colonial language?
It is not exactly ‘ours’ but it is not exclusively ‘theirs’ either: it is ‘ours’ because we
make it ours, and when we do so we choose to identify ourselves in a particular
contested, a particular ambivalent space. It is then no longer fully ‘theirs’ because
making it ‘ours’ we change its form. Quite simply, the post-colonial use of English
problematizes all those questions of identity that linger around our possession of a
mother tongue. (Ashcroft 2009, 96)
In the past few decades, our perception of the “idea” of literature has begun to hover
around multilinguality as a marker for the literature of deterritorialization. The works of
Kafka, the German-speaking Jew of Prague, have become a main referent of such literary
forms. More recently, the literature produced by writers in a language that is not affected
by colonialism but whose production is influenced by processes of globalization,
diaspora, and transculturation, remains a indicator of contemporary deterritorialized
narrative. The production of such a literature assumes that another process is already at
work, i.e. translation. This process challenges all the assumptions of the notion of the
“imagined community” positioned by Benedict Anderson (cf. 1991).
To write in a foreign language is to contribute to the act of re-writing the history of
the nation to which the writer belongs. However, belonging itself becomes an aspect of
contestation in such narratives, thereby offering alternative modes of modernity. Deleuze
12
and Guattari note that literature which comes from the complexities of migration can be
called “minority literature” (1986, 19) in terms of the ways in which, on the one hand, it
contests the mechanism of the mainstream or the canonized literature. On the other hand,
it provides a rather holistic revision of the “hidden” construction of identities in order to
delineate a reading of the imagined nation and its history from a much broader contact
zone.
Multilingual, diasporic, transcultural, and/or minoritarian writings are aspects of
North African literature written in English. In order to address these issues, this chapter
is devoted to a discussion of the theoretical and methodological framework permitting a
reading of the emerging North African literature in English in a “flexible” way. Flexibility
can be understood in the way the notion of bricolage is introduced in the discussion that
follows. In this chapter, I aim mainly to locate the theoretical starting-point that enables
the study of North African Anglophone literature in post-colonialism. The importance of
this location/locality is twofold: first, it presents a discussion of the notion of post-
colonialism in relation to the changes that alter the world today. These changes seem to
render the term post-colonial a problematic concept and incapable of accommodating the
emergence of this literature. Consequently, contesting the notion of post-colonialism
becomes, in the following discussion, an argument against the act of writing back to the
canon. I will argue that the act of writing back discussed at length by Ashcroft, Griffiths,
and Tiffin in their The Empire Writes Back does not allow for the inclusion of literature that
is not necessarily post-colonial. On the contrary, it only characterizes the period that
emerges as post-colonial, thereby giving credence to “Third World” canonized texts
without accounting for the new global contemporaneity that permeates in cultural
globalization.
Second, I will explain that the changes require us to reflect on this shift and to
attempt to contribute to the debate on alternative modernity, with an emphasis on the
notion of re-writing. At the theoretical level this discussion will cause me to think of the
notion of bricolage, introduced by Lévi-Strauss, as a way to challenge the post-colonial
and its idea of writing back. At the methodological level, minority literature, a concept
coined by Deleuze and Guattari, will be the basis on which the notion of transculturality
is constructed. In other words, in this chapter I argue that the concept of minority
literature helps in the deconstruction of the notion of “national literature”’ by offering a
more inclusive literature that takes the form of transculturality as its paradigm for the act
of re-writing. It also helps re-construct post-colonial identity, and thereby provides an
alternative modernity. With all this in mind, I suggest that to read the emerging North
African Anglophone narrative is to re-read the history of North Africa and to contribute
to the construction of an imagined community. Whereas Section 1 will be devoted to the
critique of post-colonialism, section 2 will be an introduction to the notion of minority
literature and its bricolage. Section 3 delves into the question of transculturality and the
ways of using it as a tool to re-imagine the space of literature in North Africa as one of
becoming.
13
2.1 CONTESTING POST-COLONIALISM
It is argued that colonialism has sown the seeds of post-colonial writing. The history of
the natives as mapped out by the discourse of colonialism has yielded post-colonial
literature, criticism, and writing. The overlap of language and colonialism on the one
hand, and post-colonialism and the writing back on the other hand, assumes a certain
sense of identity (re-)construction and self (re-)presentation. Post-colonialism has
engaged with the question of language to the extent that the act of writing back receives
its stimulus from the perception of difference that accrues to theories of colonial language
usage. As the epigraph from Caliban’s Voice illustrates, this engagement problematizes the
notion of identity “that lingers around our possession of a mother tongue” (Ashcroft 2009,
96). The flux of identities, hybridized borders, and hyphenation stimulates a discourse
that shares the epistemology of self-representation in a major language. The post-colonial
era in this sense is not marked solely by the subject’s engagement in a process of writing
back to the canon. Being in constant motion, the post-colonial subject struggles to live up
to the lives inside the borders and writing outside the nation.
In the mid-twentieth century, when most colonies struggled for their independence,
the act of writing back estranged the colonized from the colonizer, rendering the colonial
discourse obsolete. At a certain point, to write back meant to go beyond the “fixity” of
stereotypes in which the colonized subject had been entrapped (Bhabha 1983, 200). These
approaches endeavor to modify the project of writing against colonialism by pushing the
dominant ideals and layers of the discourse of colonialism toward a middle passage. To
go beyond fixity, or to become a hybrid: these are examples of the notion of identity
offered by post-colonial theories in order to create ruptures in colonial discourse and to
write the history of the natives anew. The process is complex because it touches on the
(re-) construction of both the history and the past of the natives.
Accordingly, it is argued that disconnecting past events from the current world
would imply the conception of the knowledge that the present has to receive. Rather,
such a conception may entail that knowledge of such thought has already been
determined by master historians (in the case of colonialism, they are the orientalists1).
Such arguments subscribe to the idea that any historical account of certain events is
ideologically determined (White 1973, 21-4). White has pointed out that any “historical
work” is reflected
in the mode of ideological implication by which an aesthetic perception
(emplotement) and a cognitive operation (the argument) can be combined so as to
derive prescriptive statements from what may appear to be purely descriptive or
analytical ones. (1973, 27; emphasis original)
1 ‘Orientalist’ evokes Edward Said’s notion of colonialism. The term is critical in its reference to the
scientific scholarship of the Orient among which writers, anthropologist, politicians, and all those
who had a certain effect in the Orient. By way of analogy – the Orient here is not perceived as the
geographical space that lies to the east of Europe, a concept of the 18th and 19th century. The Orient
refers to all those parts of the world that fell under British, French, Spanish, Portuguese, and other
European empires.
14
This quotation, apart from the critique it provokes, remains the background that enables
one to understand the importance of history in a narrative that writes back to the center.
The colonial subject has been represented as barbaric and ignorant of history and
culture. S/he was out of history or historyless. S/he was later described as an idea born
and bred as such for the Western reader. Developed for Europe2, knowledge of the
history of the subject race was represented as a story. In this way, the narrative that has
created a culture with an invented history is portrayed as a fact, where “the lines
between ’fact’ and ’fiction’ were becoming blurred […] subject to intense scrutiny”
(Loomba 2005, 39). In other words, historical works are meant to be narrative discourses
used as icons of past processes in an attempt to explain the nature of the indigenous by
means of representations (White 1973, 2). White’s argument apparently pinpoints the
historical eruption where events drawing the plot within a single story can be employed
to discern the elements of history (1973, 12). Nevertheless, this premise problematizes the
act of writing back because the prefix “post” does not designate a homogeneous
discourse that refutes the assumptions of the different versions of colonialism. Can we,
then, assume a beginning of a post-colonial discourse right after the colonial retreats?
Ania Loomba, for instance, points to the complexity of the term colonialism which
makes the naming of the era that comes right after “modern” colonialism as “post”
problematic, especially if we know that the process of maintaining colonies has not been
expressed only by Europeans. In historicizing colonialism, one could name, for example,
the Roman, the Islamic, the Mongol, and the Ottoman Empires. Yet European colonialism
is unique, because the empire “ushered in new and different kinds of colonial practices
which altered the whole globe in a way that these other colonialisms did not” (Loomba
2005, 3).
In The Empire Writes Back, the term colonial applies to the period wherein the
indigenous people fell under European control (Ashcroft et al. 2002, 2). Yet, in relation to
the definition offered by Loomba, one could ask, for instance: to what extent have
Europeans established a project of colonialism that is different from past subjugations?
How can we acknowledge these differences after all? Marxists argue that nineteenth-
century colonialism is distinguished in a temporal manner; i.e. earlier colonialism could
be grasped as pre-capitalist, while capitalism formed the basis for modern3 colonialism
(Ashcroft et al. 2002, 9). This explanation renders the term colonial more ambiguous.
Loomba points out that the term colonialism cannot be detached from terms like
imperialism or neo-colonialism. One way to clarify the difference between the terms is to
think of colonialism as a phenomenon that emanates from imperial control: whereas
imperialism does not require any direct conflict with the colony, colonialism does
(Loomba 2005, 12).
In drawing lines between various colonialisms, it is clear that colonialism, or at least
modern colonialism concerns more the way the West colonized the non-Western, hence
2 By Europe and the West I mean the very conception of the era of high colonialism attached
especially to Britain and France and to a lesser degree Germany, Spain, and Italy. 3 I use modern colonialism to refer to the era of 19th century and 20th century colonialism, in contrast
to the old forms of colonialism, which dates back to the pre-19th century.
15
relegating the subject race to an other. On the other hand, this perception coalesces with
other forms of colonialism which can be found within the West. Can we include the case
of Ireland, for instance? Canada? The United States? Malta? Do we need to think of North
America and Australia, as well, in a discourse of what comes after colonialism?
Colonialism from within? There are, as the questions indicate, various forms of
colonialism (or colonialisms); these forms invite us to view the term not only as an act of
power operated by the Europeans over the non-Europeans, but also as a version that “can
be duplicated from within” (Loomba 2002, 16).
Inasmuch as the term colonial in its both senses (colonized/colonizer) complicates
the issues, apparently the answer to write back to the center requires that first one knows
who is entitled to write? Who is eligible to write? Why write at all? According to Said,
when Westerners traveled to the Orient4, they created a discourse through which the
Orient was seen, viewed, and judged: the Orient was confined to this discourse. Further,
through this discourse the “European culture gained in strength and identity by setting
itself off against the Orient as a sort of surrogate and even underground self” (Said 1979,
3). In other words, representing the East as the only “real” image obliterates any
“fictitious” other: the colonial discourse promotes colonial hegemony.
This has become, as Said labels it, an “orientalized” version of the Orient. Its subject
race is viewed as being backward and unaware of its history and culture. This “race” was
an idea that rose out of Europe; hence the idea has become knowledge, a narrative on the
basis of which the subject is controlled (Said 1979, 22-3). This narrative has presented
imagined and created cultures with invented histories/stories of a subject race: they are
historyless subjects.
Such narratives have represented the colonized in a way that is different from the
colonial authority, and this dichotomy has become a pretext for Europe to instigate the
dialogical discourse of power that Marx condemned: “they cannot represent themselves,
they must be represented” (cf. Bottomore et al. 1983, 89). This means that the entire image
was based on an other: but other to whom? Alterity, in this regard, assumes a certain
sense of cultural and ideological syncretism: if the West has depicted the rest as other, the
rest, in a similar economy, will see the West as its other. Even during Columbus’s
“explorations”, when the natives welcomed their missionaries as others who came to
“our” land, Columbus saw the natives as cannibals, a way in “which ideologies work by
passing off partial accounts as the whole story” (Hulme 1992, 15).
Through this ideology, the history of the natives has become repudiated and
replaced by the colonizer’s version as “reality itself” (Hulme 1992, 15), and it is at this
specific point that Said introduces Orientalism as
a style of thought based upon an ontological and epistemological distinction made
between ‘the orient’ and (most of the time) ‘the occident’ […] through which a very
large mass of writers […] have accepted the basic distinction between East and West
as the starting point for elaborate theories, epics, novels, social descriptions, and
4 The Orient is not stated here as an allegory or, say, metonymy of the colonial subject at large, but
only as it informs western colonialism during the 19th and early 20th century in the near Orient.
16
political accounts concerning the orient, its people, customs, ‘mind’, destiny, and so
on. (1979, 2-3; emphasis added)
The idea generated by Orientalism, despite the criticism it has received5, is to point out the
spatial and temporal nuances characterizing the colonial discourse and to find a way out
of the impasse that renders the task of the post-colonial writing back more challenging. It
is challenging, as Benedict Anderson reminds us in his Imagined Communities, because of
the hybrid passage that the colonizer tends to create (1991, 93). This passage is what
Homi K. Bhabha terms as the in-betweenness that blurs the distinction between the
colonized and the colonizer (1986, 165). For Bhabha, the colonized, in addition to placing
the self in the colonizer’s position, want to see the self from the position of the colonizer.
This entails, Bhabha argues, that the colonized is distinguished as splitting and doubling
(Bhabha 1994, 194-7). Bhabha, in this regard, hints at the obliteration of the post-colonial
identity, while emphasizing the rupture that exists in the colonial discourse. Yet there is
still a space in-between: one can yield a hybrid post-colonial identity. Bhabha notes that it
is only through the notion of hybridity that the concepts introduced by the colonizer are
revised. This is so because hybridity modifies the elements of power, “questions
discursive authority”, and proposes a deconstructive perspective vis-à-vis the colonial
discourse (Childs 2006, 84).
The form of hybridity that Bhabha celebrates takes its meaning from Bakhtin’s
theory on language: “It is the mixture of two languages, an encounter of two different
linguistic consciousnesses” (Werbner 1997, 4). The process of the creolization of language
is similar to the production and fertilization of hyphenated identities and cultures. In
their “Introduction” to Reconstructing Hybridity: Post-Colonial Studies in Transition, Kuortti
and Nyman point out that historicizing hybridity denotes its connection to “the discourse
of the biological sciences. The hybrid is commonly thought to be a cross between two
different species” (2007, 4). This cross plays a role in revisiting the colonial discourse in
the way it offers a new reading of history.
In this context, could one assume that hybridity answers to the question that
concerns the notion of the post-colonial other? Can we, then, talk about post-colonialism
in light of colonial ambivalence? Or about the difference that marks both discourses:
colonialism and its aftermath? When Said read the colonial scripts as Orientalism, he was
criticized for detaching the colonial text from its context, which, ultimately, exposes
Orientalism as an incomplete project disengaged from the act of the writing back to the
center (Loomba 2005, 84). In this trajectory, it follows, the intensity of language between
the colonizer and the colonized waxes and wanes, delineating flows and rupture. As a
result, the passage existing between the colonial discourse and post-colonial writing
underlines the paradigm of difference as the key term in the reconstruction of identity.
As one critic suggests, if colonialism came to “wash” and “purify” the natives, conversely
it can be understood that the colonial self can be contaminated, signifying that the purity
of a certain race, the existence of center and margins, etc, is not an operational dialogic
5 Said’s argument has flattened the historical differences of colonialism into a mere division of
East/West or the fluctuated attitudes to non- western, and on this point that Bhabha refuses the
notion of orientalism introduced by Said.
17
(Loomba 2005, 99). In this regard, it can be said that “identity is […] never essential”;
rather, it is a result of a process of shared common values and relationships (Dirlik 1997,
5).
In addition, the ideology of difference seems to reiterate the challenges of the
process and the task of writing back. The ideology of difference may be used to inform
the unification of both discourses: the colonizer’s and the once colonized’s. This ideology
has been hegemonic to the extent that the discourse labeled orientalism has successfully
destabilized the cultural, historical, and linguistic values of the natives. The same
ideology is employed in the discourse of the empire writing back. Nevertheless, in spite
of the ideological “sameness” distinguishing both discourses, the paradox persists. Ella
Shohat queries when exactly the post-colonial begins (1993, 103). Given that colonialism
in its spatial and temporal construction is vague and encoded by uncertainty, the idea of
a discourse that comes after colonialism or anti-colonialism is controversial. Bill Ashcroft
et al. propose a limitation to the term ”post-colonial” and, accordingly, the term post-
colonial is designated to refer to those cultures that have undergone the process of
imperialism from the moment of colonialism up to now (Ashcroft et al. 2002, 2).
Conversely, Jorge Klor De Alva sees that the post-colonial are those
original inhabitants, who logically grouped themselves into separate cultural units
(i.e. ethnicities), all but disappeared after contact, wiped out physically by disease
and abuse, and later, genetically and socially by miscegenation, and lastly,
culturally, by the religious and political practices of the Europeans and their mixed
progeny. (1995, 243)
De Alva’s scope and meaning of the term is wider than that of Ashcroft, in the way that it
emphasizes the role of the culture and history of the natives. He also elaborates the
process of their colonization: either by the destruction of their history (wiped out) or by
the deformed inclusion of mestizage (miscegenation or hybridity). What makes the post-
colonial not clearly defined in De Alva’s view is the location of those who remain under
economic control, which suggests a new phase of colonialism:
Even in the regions where native peoples survived as corporate groups in their own
greatly transformed communities […] within two or three generations they were
greatly reduced in number and politically and socially marginalized from centers of
power. (1995, 243)
Subsequently, there seems to be a great variety in the use of the term post-colonial.
If it is used synonymously with the post-independence era of the once colonized nations,
terms such as anti-colonial or post-colonial discourses could emerge on that basis (Slimon
1991, 13). Yet post-colonialism can mean resistance to the “continuity of preoccupations
and […] a set of theory that rejects the premise of colonial discourse” (Childs 2006, 5).
Aijaz Ahmad argues that, in periodizing the history of the indigenous to pre-colonial,
colonial, and post-colonial, the concept of the post-colonial remains “the infinite
aftermath” that we need to adjust ourselves to. In so doing, this condition obliterates
18
even those palimpsests that reside in “our” history, through producing it as a mere
textual history of cannibalism (1995, 7). Dirlik holds the same view, suggesting that the
denial of history is a denial of our present in so far as the past informs the present. This
past needs to be conceived of in its plurality as “alternative historical trajectories that
need to be suppressed so that the present could become a possibility” (1997, 3).
Paradoxically, the lines of discussion within post-colonial discourse appear to be marked
by discontinuity, especially in the forms of the pre-colonial past and the future. From this
rupture it is possible to proceed to reassemble the history on the basis of “our premise”.
This remains an approach with which to reckon and which could enable the post-colonial
discourse to decipher the codes and practices shaped earlier by colonialism (Dirlik 1997,
169).
As the term post-colonialism remains ambiguous, it is said to cover two main areas:
it is used, first, to describe the condition that comes after, or begins with colonialism, and
yet, it never ends with it. Second, it is a designation of the movement whose
epistemology reflects the antagonism to colonialism. These two designations are
contested by Appiah, who notes that a post-colonial critic, like comprador intelligentsia,
is conceived of as a spokesman/woman for the once-colonized, which attempts to
elucidate the native’s perspective for the Western audience (Njubi 2002, n.p.). The post-
colonial comprador introduces a Western commandment in order to reconstruct the lost
harmony of a pre-colonial past. In his study of Achebe’s Things Fall Apart, Christopher
Wise points out that this sentiment is deemed significant in Achebe’s novel, where he
“aims not only at rehabilitating Africa's pre-colonial past; he also wants [ …] to fulfill a
more primal human need by providing” new forms of modernity (1999, 1057). This
alternate perception aims at restoring the real image that is demolished by exterior
representations of colonialism. The trajectory can only be set by rejecting stereotypes and
reconciling the past. But to what extent is this past significant? The conclusion that
Achebe proposes is that the past perfect (or pre-colonial conditions) “is finally a lost
world, or a world that remains significant only within the immediate context of present
day political struggle within Africa” (Wise 1999, 1065; emphasis original).
If post-colonialism is a condition that exists right after colonialism, why did this
condition not exist before? How can we differentiate between the past and the present in
this context? Can we distinguish between all kinds of colonialisms? Is hybridity a
criterion of colonialism? How could the subject race represent the self? Dirlik denies any
possibility of post-colonialism foregrounding those nuanced articulations without
engagement in the ontological and epistemological considerations of the term. This
ambivalence is a feature of post-colonial theory, whose basis stresses the text outside its
context. Alternatively, he suggests using the term “post-revolutionary” as a reference to
the contacts and confrontations designating resistance to colonialism in its spatial and
temporal contexts (1997, 167). Although the idea seems creative, it does not clarify or
limit the scope of post-colonialism. It renders the terminology of the past blocked within
the epistemology of resistance, and within the debate on cultural and materialist critique.
This polemical debate retains its currency only in accounting for colonial and post-
colonial resistance (such as that taking place in Palestine or the anti-government
19
movements of Africa and South-East Asia), and yet it can hardly be a designation for the
democratic movements that aim to establish a modern state.
In this context, the act of writing back may entail differnt meanings: to write back
may mean that one confirms the importance of the ideological concepts designated for
post-colonial consumption. Similarly, it can also suggest that one needs to corroborate the
authority of the topic, and to write back to the center would imply that one has already
accepted the predefined division of the world into center and margin. It is significant to
note that in order to contest this aspect, otherness need be seen as a means of affirming
the self and confirming its neglect. Writing from an “other” perspective may show how,
after the colonial era, the writing back often deals with a self-assertion but neglects the
other ”other”, which exists inside the post-colonial text itself. It is by concentrating on
reassuring colonialism indirectly that post-colonialism overlooks the other sort of
discrimination and the cultural violence that subsists inside the post-colonial societies,
the minoritarian.
As a result, the question of writing back indicates that “post-colonial studies seem
to have reached the limit – and hence must confront the limitations – of theorizing
political struggles organized around notions, however complex, of identity and
difference” (Grossberg 2001, 169). Or, as Dallo notes, the post-colonial seems to be “at a
crossroads” (2004, 129). The state of ambiguity, which has helped blur the lines between
fact and fiction in history and narrative in colonial fiction, has hindered the promotion of
a unified post-colonial theory and criticism. This unification is not possible at this
moment. Yet this ambiguity has armed post-colonial writers with methods for starting
the narrativization of their history, using their own story. The language (the colonial
language) has retained its power in post-colonialism because, according to Ashcroft,
“colonialism occurs most subtly and comprehensively in language, because language
itself is so manifestly connected to power” (2009, 3). Language – major or minor – is the
medium around which identities debate their hybridity.
On the one hand, the labels that set post-colonial narratives in a ghettoized praxis
such as that of Commonwealth literature play significant roles in preventing the
continuity of post-colonial studies. On the other hand, as location and dislocation hold
the spirit of the post-colonial subjectivity in the global era, reflection on minorities and
their emerging literature in major languages transcends the debate about nation and
community-based rhetoric and leads to the question of transnationalism and
transcultural identities. This reflection aims, first, at re-routing the post-colonial beyond
the center/periphery paradigm. Second, it is a way of looking for possible theories that
propagate the assumption of post-colonial studies and simultaneously elucidate the
contemporary dislocation that generates our world today.
Part of the problem can be solved by engaging with Stuart Hall’s critique of the
post-colonial question. In his “When Was ‘the Post-colonial?’ Thinking at the Limit”, Hall
argues that the transcultural moment has partly dismantled the notion of post-
colonialism by offering a new medium in which difference is repositioned and not
overcome (1996, 251). Hall further explains that
20
In this ‘post-colonial’ moment, these transverse, transnational, transcultural
movements, which were always inscribed in the history of ‘colonisation’, but
carefully overwritten by more binary forms of narrativisation, have, of course,
emerged in new forms to disrupt the settled relations of domination and resistance
inscribed in other ways of living and telling these stories. They reposition and dis-
place ‘difference’ without, in the Hegelian sense, ‘overcoming’ it. (1996, 251)
The transformation moment in post-colonialism continues to flourish today. Cultural
globalization illustrates this transformational process as the post-colonial discourse is
now experiencing spatial and temporal twists that enforce the delimitation of the post-
colonial paradigm (Hall 1996, 258).
Accordingly, John Thieme explains that terms such as “writing back”, “counter-
discourse”, and “con-text” have been extensively used to “identify a body of post-
colonial works that take a classic English text as a departure point” (2001, 1). Although
Thieme’s categorization might be applied to the “Anglophone writing from societies that
have experienced some form of colonialism in recent centuries” (2001, 4), it does not align
with recent calls that contest the term by viewing the “con-text” as a mere re-turn to the
canon. Maes-Jelinek observes that the “New Literature in English” is in “crisis” (2004, 2).
The reason behind this affliction, Maes-Jelinek argues, can be summarized in three main
terms: text, terminology, and theory. Literary texts, she argues, are important for the
post-colonial individual in order to “re-figure” the post-colonial discourse, and one way
to proceed with this reconfiguration is to reconcile “several methodologies” in analyzing
literary texts (2004, 11). Second, since the post-colonial is a “process”, it is important to re-
think the post-colonial terminology, because “the terminology we use and the encoding
of certain meanings to the exclusion of others” might prevent the creation of “a new
orthodoxy” (2004, 12). Finally, theory evokes the criteria that lead to a better
understanding of literary texts. Maes-Jelinek suggests that “because of the contemporary
implications of the word and its practice”, the objection to theory becomes widely
articulated, since the importance rests more, not on terminologies, but on the unearthing
of “wholeness” (2004, 14). Huggan confirms this view by stating that, because of the
“current debates on the interrelatedness of postcolonialism and globalization”, it becomes
crucial to “hinge on alternative views of the transnational ethos” in the ways
transnationalization is perceived as the “outlet […] for new, deterritorialized forms of
social/cultural expression and political allegiance” (2004, 31-2; emphasis original).
Like Huggan and Maes-Jelinek, Schulze-Engler points that engaging with post-
colonialism “almost includes a survey of its discontents” and in order to resolve such
“crises” in post-colonial studies he proposes an exploration of “more fruitful areas of
research and critical debate” beyond the “detailed critique of postcolonial theory” (2004,
50). Schulze-Engler postulates that the engagement with post-colonialism has accelerated
a process of modernization, which becomes visible not from “tradition” to “modernity”
but as “a transition within modernity that has been greatly accelerated by the
globalization process and that has led to the emergence of ‘reflexive’ or ‘late’ forms of
modernity” (2004, 60-1; emphasis original). It is therefore this notion of transition within
modernity that makes “sense to talk of the resurgence of modernity […] as a set of shared
21
problems and predicaments that increasingly need to be addressed in global contexts”
(Schulze-Engler 2004, 61). In a vein similar to Sculze-Engler’s pardigm, John McLeod
reminds us that
in a brave new world of liquid modernities, nations apparently no longer form the
backbone of international relations. We are urged to think instead across and
beyond the tidy, holistic entities of nations and cultures – transnationally,
transculturally – if we hope to capture and critique the conditions of our
contemporaneity. (2011, 1)
Yet, to think of postcolonialism as an area of research that has merely “prioritised matters
of nation and narration” (McLeod 2011, 1) does not necessarily mean “sending the
wisdom of the old prematurely into cold storage” as McLeod points out (2011, 2). The
promotion of a specific field sometimes requires critiquing “the wisdom of the old” in
order to integrate new vocabularies for transition can take place. One way to account for
such transition in a transcultural context, we have to reconcile, as Maes-Jelinek suggests,
different methodologies so as to account for the current changes in the global world
today. The engagement assumes that, in order to re-write modernity, it is imperative to
think of new epistemologies that make of the post-colonial and the transcultural, the
modern and the postmodern, and the poststructuralist the methodological “panacea”
with which to approach the emerging literature in English (cf. Schulze-Engler 2009, xiii).
As a result, post-colonial criticism need not depend on a single theory, but on a
notion of bricolage. This could be one way to address the limitations and also those
negative colonial emblems critical of the Euro-American terminologies. It is the belief that
each theory incorporates a certain weight of radicalism, which the post-colonial critic
would overcome if s/he refrains from the rhetoric of the culturalist/materialist debate and
constructs a more methodological and conceptual framework. We are, therefore, in
agreement with Louis Gates when he says that our task is not to choose between “Spivak
and Said […] Bhabha or JanMohamed or Parry, even between Fanon or Memmi” because
the epistemology “requires a recognition that we, too, just as much as Fanon, may be
fated to rehearse the agonisms of a culture that may never earn the title of
postcolonialism” (Gates 1991, 470). In order for such recognition to be established, the
post-colonial text has been considered as that which controlled the colonized. Yet it is
from the same text that the once-colonized begins the process of re-writing and engages
in the process of identity construction.
2.2 BRICOLAGE AND MINORITY LITERATURE
The challenges of redefining the aspects of the post-colonial text or delineating the act of
writing back render the text itself an exemplar of theoretical contestation. The discussion
of terms such as the post-colonial or new literatures in English exemplifies an abstraction
more than concreteness. In other words, to think of post-colonialism as a discourse that
defines the new literatures that challenge the colonial discourse is to accept the argument
that makes indigeneity an aspect of pre-colonial modernity, since the colonial discourse
22
has already defined the limits of modernity. Nonetheless, the same post-colonial text may
not permit the emergence of North African Anglophone narrative to be included in this
categorization because such literature needs to be written in French in order to carry the
weight of the title post-colonial. Regardless of these con/textual challenges, I will argue
that to regard the post-colonial text as a textual bricolage can be viewed as the
intersecting approach between the post-colonial text and its other, i.e., “the other other
literature” by which Lennon refers to the body of literature existing in the major culture
in the metropolis and which uses the language of the homeland without necessarily
translating it into the dominant language (Lennon 2010, 141; 217). What is significant in
this literature is the notion of incommensurability that helps in positioning such a
literature in the major culture. This meticulous suggestion aims mainly to work in-
between the text and its context, between language and its others, in order to emphasize
the dialectical process underway in the “other other literature”.
Edward Said carefully demarcates this “mobile” aspect of the text by arguing that
the text exists in the world, and that its worldliness is a textual construction, because each
aspect reflects on the other, and each confirms the other’s construction (1983, 183). In an
attempt to bridge Derrida’s attitude toward the notion of the text and Foucault’s, Said
aims to construct the notion of textual worldliness by arguing that since
Derrida is concerned only with reading text, and that a text is important […]
because its real situation is literally a textual element with no ground in actuality […]
for Foucault the text is important in as much as it inhabits an element of power […]
with decisive claim on actuality, even though that power is invisible or implied.
(1983, 183)
The difference concerns the notions of text and context. Whereas Derrida claims that
there is nothing outside the discourse, and hence stresses the writing, Foucault insists
that the inside of the discourse is already implied by an external power, i.e. the outside
informs the inside. Significant in this problematization is the way in which each
endeavors to discover the invisible in the text (Said 1983, 183-4). This iconoclastic
perception of the text induces a more objective perspective on the interchange of textual
meaning vis-à-vis the context.
The text is considered a social construct wherein communication with the social
strata exemplifies the balance of power that operates in the post-colonial text in
accordance with its social context. However, Derrida notes that the text must deconstruct
itself and that “play” remains the moment at which the center limits the movement of the
elements in the system and structure. The operation of the system is located between two
axes: a complete obedience or a full chaos; an absolute stagnation or a complete progress.
Language is a system in which the center controls the operation of its elements. Derrida
argues that Western philosophy has emphasized the single signification –
signifier/signified – where the multiplicity of meaning is blocked, restraining the motion
of signification. When the weight is placed on the center, all the meanings or other extra
elements within a single structure or system are blurred: the result is the ideological
construct of that center, the originator of meaning, the fixed meaning (1967, 352-4).
23
The relationship between the signifier and the signified is never absolute. The
binary opposition such as good/evil or day/night assumes that the first part of the binary
is privileged in a system and that its meaning is regulated by the center. It also postulates
that all of the elements within the system are stable. In other words, one can only define
good, for instance, when evil is not, or minor when the subject is not part of the major; the
absence of one term assumes the presence of one. Yet a rupture occurs when one of the
elements within the system starts to “revolt” (1967, 13). It is at this specific point that the
fixed meaning of the text becomes blurred, but the alleged need for finding other systems
might only replace one center with another one. As Derrida puts it,
it was necessary to begin thinking that there was no center, that the center could not
be thought of in the form of a present-being, that the center had no natural site, that
it was not a fixed locus but a function, a sort of nonlocus in which an infinite
number of sign-substitutions came into play. (1967, 354)
The structure of the text is collapsed, and the logic of meaning is replaced by unlimited
processes of signification. Thus the need to read the text against itself can be an argument
that impedes any intimation of other approaches within a central locus of post-
colonialism. Focusing on the ruptures and inconsistencies aims at decentering the center
and de-constructing the meaning of the post-colonial text in its context. Dependence on
the anatomy of the center is no longer a choice, but it is a call for a counter-process to use
multiplicity as it informs the instability within a certain text. The other post-colonial text is
subverted by the post-colonial text: it is the substitution of one center (colonial) with
another center (post-colonial). In order to reshape the elements within this structure,
Derrida notes that the term bricolage might provide the possibility of transcending the
logic of the center (1967, 360). The proposal is a matter of fluctuation rather than stability.
It is a designation of the system that is a construct of an absolute movement that cannot
keep all the elements in place because a bricoleur does not hesitate “to change them
whenever it appears necessary, or to try several of them at once, even if their form and
their origin are heterogeneous – and so forth” (Derrida 1967, 360).
The term is borrowed from Lévi-Strauss who defines the bricoleur while he
discusses the difference between scientific knowledge and mythical thought. In his The
Savage Mind, Lévi-Strauss explains that
in our own time the ’bricoleur’ is still someone who works with his hands and uses
devious means compared to those of a craftsman. The characteristic feature of
mythical thought is that it expresses itself by means of a heterogeneous repertoire
which, even if extensive, is nevertheless limited. It has to use this repertoire,
however, whatever the task in hand because it has nothing else at its disposal.
Mythical thought is therefore a kind of intellectual ’bricolage’ – which explains the
relation which can be perceived between the two. (1966, 16-7)
Both Derrida and Lévi-Strauss confirm “heterogeneity” as a feature of the bricoleur
because even bricolage “does not proceed in a straightforward manner; it seems to stray
24
or wander from one thing to another with concepts bouncing this way and that, as
interrelations and connections abound” (Pohen 2003, np.). This bouncing characteristic
advances the interplay between the center and the periphery, wherein each approaches
the other in a constant movement.
Despite this, a bricoleur does not have much concern for the coherence of the
structure and the choice of words. The use of words does not necessarily comply with the
notion of “truth”, so long as the words fit. The reciprocal process of code deciphering
permeates the understanding of words not as stable but shifting. In this regard, each
bricoleur sees her/himself as the center and the language as her/his. This system provides
new approaches to reading the text outside the stabilizing motives of the center. The
premise is twofold: when we use a word, we aim at discerning its meaning without
interpretations. But the aim is also for the meaning to hover, without any constraints and
hindrances. Bricolage, therefore, is a matter of “play” in the Derridian sense (Derrida
1967, 365). No meaning is concrete in itself, and the need for this “play” is indispensable
to the operation of the signification of meanings.
The concepts of bricolage and play do not, however, inscribe chaos in the
understanding of text (literary or non-literary). The very idea behind the word
deconstruction rests on an analysis of the dichotomies in a deconstructive paradigm and
“to show that the lesser or weaker part is necessary for the whole existence of the
stronger part” (Simon-López 2010, 35). The notion of bricolage is important to the
operation of the textual inclusion of the post-colonial minority, especially that the
bricoleur deconstructs the text, decenters the center, and revolts against its elements.
Bricolage thus aligns the new post-colonial literature to the status of minoritarian
literature. West-Pavlov notes that, post-colonial marginality, sometimes, offers
“possibilities of intervention – transversal intervention – in the world of which it is a part”,
in the way that it offers a “metonymic dialogue with the social context” (2005, 43;
emphasis original). West-Pavlov’s suggestion confirms this alignment and he further
suggests that the post-colonial marginality that emerges “within the ‘mainstream’ of
global English” problematizes the domination of mainstream literature (2005, 45). The
implicit emergence of minority literature in a “postcolonial bricolage” is meant, at least
methodologically, to problematize “the centrality of the dominant literary post-colonial
tradition” (2005, 45; emphasis added).
The work that a bricoleur produces might not correspond to the tradition of the
engineer (mainstream production), “because he doesn’t subordinate each of [the tasks] to
the availability of raw materials and tools conceived and procured for the purposes of the
project” (Lévi-Strauss 1966, 17). The same approach can be applied to the work of a minor
writer who seeks to deterritorialize his position within the post-colonial canonized
literatures. What a bricoleur produces is similar to that of a minor writer, because their
productions cannot be isolated from the general web of any significant, post-colonial
“production”; they complement the meaning in the “context of production” (West-Pavlov
2005, 47). In this vein, the work of a bricoleur (in the sense introduced by Lévi-Strauss
and Derrida) constitutes the basic element of the minoritarian (in the context of Deleuze
and Guattari) and represents a set of possible relations that can “be used for any
operations of the same type” (Lévi-Strauss 2005, 17). From the interstice of bricolage and
25
post-colonialism emerges the notion of minority literature that Deleuze and Guattari offer
as a possible deterritorialized version of post-colonial literature.
In Kafka: Toward a Minor Literature, Gilles Deleuze and Félix Guattari detail the
progress and the linear accumulation of the term minor literature, a term that is far from
conventional. A minor literature, they note in their analysis of the works of Kafka, has no
major authors, and a minor writer does not intimidate those “major” writers or their
canonical works. Lewis Renza points out that this “new” literature “is politically and
metaphorically a ‘third world’ kind of writing which eludes the totalizing formulations of
formalist, oedipal, and bourgeois or Marxist modes of organization” (1984, 29). The
preservation of the literary tradition is central to public life and more in sympathy with
the concern of the people than literary history (Bogue 1989, 114).
The function of minority literature, according to Deleuze and Guattari, is to describe
the social and political spheres of minoritarians in a “major” language that is “affected
with a high coefficient of deterritorialization” (1986, 16). In this regard, minority literature
does not represent the writer’s individual feeling, but subscribes to a more generalized
view of social representations. Subsequently, minority literature not merely focuses its
attention on the text, but it combines the social with the political and the textual with the
contextual in such a way that the author and the implied narrator work dialogically to
deterritorialize the “major” literature. To put it simply, Deleuze and Guattari name three
characteristics of a minor literature. The first is that a minor literature is a new and
“different” mode of literature that “a minority constructs within a major language”,
wherein its language “is affected with a high coefficient of deterritorialization” (1986, 16).
The second “is that everything in them is political”. The third characteristic concerns the
collective value of minority literature (1986, 7).
Crucial to these characteristics is that Deleuze and Guattari “locate in minor
literature the repressed and censored dimensions of the major language” (Seyhan 2001,
26). Producing a minor literature perpetuates a deconstructive proximity to the text from
within, using a major language. As a Jew from Prague, Kafka appropriates German as a
“paper language” for a minor usage. In the first place, minor literature faces three
impossibilities in relation to language: “the impossibility of not writing, the impossibility
of writing [and] the impossibility of writing differently” (Deleuze and Guattari 1986, 16).
The result is a celebration of a literature that is gypsy-like, not possible at all, with a
linguistic dispossession that is unique to the marginalized inside their culture.
Deleuze and Guattari argue that “[t]wo conjoined tendencies in so-called minor
languages have often been noted: an impoverishment, a shedding of syntactic and lexical
forms; but simultaneously a strange proliferation of shifting effects, a taste for overload
and paraphrase” (2004, 115). This would make “major” and “minor” languages: not two
different languages, but “two possible treatments of the same language” (Deleuze and
Guattari 2004, 114). Bogue points out that
[w]hen writers efficaciously experiment with language, then, they do not simply
manipulate signifiers. They experiment on the real; they activate lines of continuous
variation immanent within language. And in doing so they engage the same forces
26
of creative deformation that various minorities utilize in fashioning their own
speech within a dominant language. (1997, 108)
The linguistic impoverishment is not regarded as a defect, but is seen as a source of
creativity that shifts the conceptualization and exploits the major text. Each minor writer
has methodological tools to use to deterritorialize the major language. Consequently, the
“minor usage” of the language is primarily an attempt to be independent from any
linguistic, cultural or social construct. It is like being “a foreigner, but in one’s own
tongue” (2004, 109). Collectivity conflates within the writer a notion of liberation with
deterritorialization in order to form an asignifying 6 aspect. However, it does not
necessarily denote reducing a certain language to the state of a senseless language. As has
been noted, minor “languages are characterized not by overload and poverty in relation
to a standard or major language, but by a sobriety and variation that are like a minor
treatment of the standard language, a becoming minor of the major language” (Deleuze
and Guattari 2004, 116). The question concerns transforming the “major” language: the
“intrusion” is not to enrich the major language, but to expand its horizon and make
access to it problematic for the major “through all the resources of symbolism […] of
hidden signifiers” (Deleuze and Guattari 1986, 19).
While in major literature thoughts precede articulation (content/expression), “a
minor, or revolutionary, literature begins by expressing itself and doesn’t conceptualize
until afterward” (Deleuze and Guattari 1986, 28). Through this process, the
reconstruction of content will be resumed. To make it readable, other elements are added
to the post-colonial minority text so that the minoritarian text can fashion the notion of
the becoming. Yet this perception leads to a configuration of self-doubling. To dissociate
the fictional construct from the actual meaning in a text ascribes duality of meanings to
the textual context leading to a split of identities. To write differently would presume a
different understanding of the meaning of the text. The most startling fact of this split
resonates in the writer her/himself: between the subject of statement and that of
enunciation. According to Clayton Koelb, “the writer is split into two functions, one of
which can remain at home while the epistolary “subject of the statement” flits about” the
outside, whatever it means for the writer (1987, 377). This feature is a typical
characteristic of many post-colonial diaspora.
Minority literature offers the consolidation that is needed for the diasporan subject.
Even though the diasporan is “split into two functions”, Deleuze and Guattari explain
that minority literature “produces an active solidarity in spite of skepticism; and if the
writer is in the margins or completely outside his or her fragile community”,
deterritorialization offers “the possibility to express another possible community” (1986,
17). Deterritorialization is defined as “the movement by which ‘one’ leaves the territory”
(2004, 559). This movement can be either absolute (deterritorialization), denying any
possibility of territorializing anew, or relative, according to which one retains her/his
territory (reterritorialization). As a result, deterritorialization is “said to be negative” (2004,
6 Asignifying elements refer to elements in the text that signify nothing but themselves. According to
Deleuze and Guattari, the “asignifying rupture” is the space of the "text" where the presence of
asignifying elements force the text to its metamorphosis and writing to its death (2004, 9).
27
559-60; emphasis original). It is also argued that the moment at which deterritorialization
is achieved, it is followed by reterritorialization, i.e., one shows the ability to demarcate
the zone of her/his newly established space. Whereas deterritorialization might be
intrinsic in the emerging fiction from the former British and French colonies named post-
colonial (e.g. India, Pakistan, Nigeria, Cameron, Algeria, and Morocco), for minority,
diasporan writers the language is “one that still occupies its natural territory and […] the
literary history of the host country” (Seyhan 2001, 27). The term of “literary zone” I
invoke here, and which corresponds to that which Deleuze and Guattari describe as a
minority literature, resonates with frequency of the level of language deterritorialization
within its national territory. This could apply to the North African writers residing in the
United States, Britain or elsewhere, and their writing in English or in another major
language. In this particular aspect, the notion of minor literature introduced by Deleuze
and Guattari seems to be open to scrutiny.
In her study of minority literature in Germany in the early 1980s, Heidrun Suhr
voices her skepticism in regard to the “hasty” generalization indexed in Deleuze and
Guattari’s conceptualization of the term. She argues that the authors whom they used as
examples (Joyce, Beckett, and Kafka) may not be accurate instances of the generalization
in which they consider the problem of the literature of the minority to be a “problem for
all of us”( 1989, 73). The reason Suhr cites for her critique is more related to the new
movements of economic migration that spanned the last century and spurred a new
understanding and thematization of the term minority. These minorities “who were
forced to leave their home countries mainly for economic reasons, have produced
significant numbers of minority writers” (Suhr 1989, 73).
Although critiques of generalization are frequent in debating Deleuze and
Guattari’s notion of a minor literature, the concept retains its originality, at least, in its
rapprochement of three distinct categories: secondary literature, whether it be that of
a minor nation or linguistic group in relation to a major tradition, or that of a
humble, minor movement or tendency (e.g., American local colorists) within a
larger tradition; marginal literature, or the literature of minorities; and experimental
literature, which “minorizes” a major language (in the sense that a minor key in
music may be said to chromaticize and destabilize the harmonic order of a major
key). (Bogue 1997, 105; emphasis original)
The consequences of these rapprochements evoke a new paradigm within which to
regard the writing from the margin of post-colonialism as an experimental, contrapuntal
discourse. The most predictable way to approach such discourse is to transcend the
limitations of the binary minor/major as much as those of ethnic minority, and to think
instead of the term Becoming. These implications presume, according to Renza, that a
minor writer would help in delineating a fragmented, different, and imaginative world
that is anchored in collective enunciation of the minor community (1984, 29).
Consequently, it seems that these concepts – minority, minor literature, minor writings,
or minor writer – can retain their effectiveness when they are applied to post-colonial
literature. Politics, in this respect, is part of the literature of the minority. Deleuze and
28
Guattari have overstated the role of politics in a minor literature, and by doing so, they
have denied its notion in works by “great” writers, which, they say, are overwhelmed by
the “social milieu” that serves “as a mere environment or a background” (1986, 17). The
political significance of minority literature is apparent in many aspects, yet the use of
Kafka as an example of this dynamic calls it into question.
The discussion of minority in relation to literature stands as a paradigm within
which to consider the term minority, which in this case is rendered problematic in its
own right. The minority or minoritarian is not understood in its literal sense: the word
connotes a different conceptualization. But who can be included in or excluded from the
term minoritarian? For Deleuze and Guattari, minority is not based on a quantitative
scale. It is, by definition, based on the idea of “becoming-minor”, which blurs any
distinction between the major and the minor: “What defines a minority, then, is not the
number but the relations internal to the number. A minority can be numerous, or even
infinite; so can a majority. What distinguishes them is” the “included middle” that
designates the connection between the two (Deleuze and Guattari 1987, 518-9). Such a
location is similar to, but not reflective of, Homi Bhabha’s notion of the “third space”,
whose economy is built on new epistemologies of liberating the post-colonial identity
from colonial thought. Bhabha’s “space” is imaginative, whereas Deleuze and Guattari’s
space seems to be contextual. Everyone can operate in the state of becoming minor: minor
to major, women to men, and children to parents (Deleuze and Guattari 1993, 11).
Deleuze and Guattari’s is not an aspect of “dispersion or a fragmentation”, but, as they
suggest, it is a movement back to the conflict between the “coexistence and
inseparability” (2004, 522): one that is also characteristic of the transcultural identity.
Caren Kaplan, however, voices her discomfort with the notion of Becoming. This
uneasiness is mainly directed toward seeing “becoming minor” not as a choice but as
coercion. For her the choice is based on a power relation that “stems from the daily, lived
experience of oppression” (1987, 191). Oppression is the key element in Kaplan’s critique,
in which a minor in the sense proposed by Deleuze and Guattari blurs the distinction
between the major and the minor at this level (Bogue 1997, 5). The idea of oppression is
also critical when it comes to the question of minorities. Many critics aim at discussing
the notion of oppression as a factor relative to ethnic conflicts arising in certain nations.
To a certain degree, Anouar Majid in his We Are All Moors: Ending Centuries of Crusades
Against Muslims and Other Minorities holds this view. Majid explains: “[t]he Moor, I want
to show in this book, is not only someone who is religiously Muslim; even more
importantly, he or she is also a figure that stands for anyone who is not considered to be
part of the social mainstream” (2009, 5).
In other words, the Moor is not only those minority groups who were dispersed
from Spain to Morocco. The concept is extended to include all those immigrants living in
the United States (Hispanic and nonwhites), Asian migrant workers in the Gulf region,
and other minorities in Europe, including North Africans and Africans, whose fate is to
experience exclusion and oppression. Nevertheless, Lawrence points out that
in these conditions, the traditional binary models of political struggle – simple
models of coloniser/colonised, of oppressor/oppressed – seem inapplicable to a
29
spatial economy of power which cannot be reduced to simple geographical
dichotomies – First/Third, Centre/Margin, Metropolitan/Peripheral, Local/Global –
nor, at least in the first instance, to questions of personal identity. (2001, 170)
But these suggestions do not solve the problem posed earlier by Seyhan: if
deterritorialization can be a feature of post-colonial literature emerging out of the British
or French Empires, where can one locate the emerging literature in English from writers
who have not been directly influenced by British colonialism, such as the North African,
for instance? Even though Deleuze and Guattari make a comparison between Kafka and
the African American writers, the comparison seems to be inapplicable on this basis.
These writers are rooted in their “locales of origin” and do not experiment with an
imported language. The language is theirs (Seyhan 2001, 27). The difficulty of localization
is also articulated by Suhr in her “Ausländerliteratur”. Focusing on German literature
produced by immigrant authors especially in the 1980s, Suhr outlines a number of
concepts that may denote this emerging literature in Germany. These include
“Migrantenliteratur”, signifying literature by migrants; “Gastarbeiterliteratur”, implying
guest worker literature, and “ein nicht nur deutsche Literatur” a sentence that is
translated as a “not-just-German literature”. None of these definitions encompass the
germane concepts of the emerging German literature by non-native authors. If the first
title renders a vast area to characterize this emerging literature, the second one preserves
its limitation, and the third title seems to be absurd (Suhr 1989, 74-5).
However, when the Eastern part of Germany united with its Western counterpart,
radical changes reformed German migrant literature. The calls for national integration
become the main arena for discussing “an alternative community”, one that is marked by
multiple ethnicities wherein language itself has become “hybridized” (Hakkarainen 2004,
194). If literature of the 1960s and 1970s was “called affected literature” to symbolize its
impurity, Hakkarainen notes, the production of literature by non-Germans creates “a
hybrid language” that sustains “the polyphony of various voices” and enlarges the circle
of questioning the construction of identities in the plural (2004, 196-7). Such a shift in
emphasis can be an effect of the changes that alter the concept of the nation state, and
allow for a broader discussion on the “aesthetic of the hybrid” and cultural globalization
in Germany (Hakkarainen 2004, 200).
Subsequently, the fluidity of these titles can be viewed as problematizing the scope
of the emerging literature in North Africa. Migration, a term that has tenaciously
permeated the formulation of the emerging literature in a major language, is what
characterizes this literature. It is a literature that underlies, after all, the name of a post-
colonial literature. It is also a literature that comes out of migration. Either concept seems
to represent thematic limitations. These need be addressed in the following sections.
What is of central importance is that this age is characterized by a high degree of
migration, in the course which language is to be transformed. Transformation is a result
of the power relations that marked the era of high colonialism. Ashcroft ascertains this by
noting “that the colonizing language is taught and disseminated in a way that entrenches
difference: the colonized speak dialect or marginal varieties, while the colonizer speaks,
and has the status of, Standard English” (2009, 31). Ashcroft further problematizes this
30
“difference” by referring to the colonized in the plural and the colonizer in the singular,
as if to state that a colonial relationship is marked by efficiency, not by number. In other
words, one colonizer can speak the language that, for instance, a hundred of the
colonized cannot speak. And because the emphasis is not shifted from the mere binary of
colonizer and colonized, the roles and regulation of the use of language have been
changed. It is also a result of the growing number of those people who live today “in a
language that is not their own […] or no longer, or not yet, even know their own and
know poorly the major language that they are forced to serve […] this is a problem of
immigrants […] the problem of minorities” (Deleuze and Guattari 1986, 19).
The transformation, i.e. the deterritorialization of the language, is “infected” by a
series of errors in grammar and “defects” in pronunciations and orthography. As
Ashcroft suggests, these defects are contaminations of the mother language, whereas,
from a minor perspective, this is the reconstruction of a new language against the very
essence of cultural and ideological hegemonies indexed in the language of the colonizer
(2009, 8). But why is language transformation accepted as crucial to the formation of
identity? And is it true that any change of language is a change of identity and life, as
Derek Walcott once claimed (1965, 61)?
According to Ashcroft, language plays a role in forming identity. The very essence
of naming is a sign of domination. To name in a certain language presupposes that
indigeneity needs to be “dehumanized” and “the capacity for naming erased” (Ashcroft
2009, 27). This erasure means that the spaces that have been occupied were empty spaces,
where notions of place and space involve the denial of any participation on the part of the
native in articulating her/his indigeneity. In this way the acts both of naming and of
renaming retain their currency in post-colonial, minor literature, “for to name reality is in
some mysterious way to assume control of it” (Ashcroft 2009, 28). Consideration of
language transformation may be more pressing to adopt in post-colonial, minor literature
today than it was in the past. Various terms have been considered to effectively highlight
the “metonymic gap”, including glossing, untranslated words, interlanguage and
syntactic fusion, code-switching, and vernacular transcription (Ashcroft 2009, 174-6).
Together, all of these give a sense of “originality” to identity formation. This is clearly
indicated, for instance, in Kamala Das’s poem “An Introduction” when she says that
The language I speak
Becomes mine, its distortions, its queerness
All mine, mine alone. It is half English, half
Indian, funny perhaps, but it is honest
It is human as I am human. (1986, 7)
When we discuss the forms of language transformation, we are ultimately probing those
language vessels that carry a sense of “authenticity” and identity formation. We are also
interested in the role they play in filling the gap between languages in the global space.
These textual lacunae are wide to the extent that translation is perceived as akin to the
violence of transparency. Iain Chambers in “Signs of Silences, Lines of Listening” reflects
on the crux of this problem at length:
31
We are perhaps beginning to learn that in order to look towards this potential
horizon it is no longer possible to seek refuge, what used to be called critical
distance, in the supposedly neutral languages of science and knowledge: those
discourses that previously nominated alterity and then reduced it to the tyranny of
the logic of the same in the name of civilisation, culture and progress. We are
learning to substitute the violence of that translation with the disturbing recognition
that translation – mine of an other, an other’s of me – is never a transparent activity
but always involves a process of re-citing, hence cultural and historical re-siting,
and is therefore a travesty, a betrayal, of any ‘original’ or ‘authentic’ intention. (2001,
49)
The transparency of translation pertinent to the language of the national identity,
literature, and cultural hegemony has now been enveloped as the act of re-writing taking
place everywhere. Writers from elsewhere, whom Salman Rushdie describes in his
Imaginary Homelands – those who are caught between two shores, people whose existence
are determined “by an endless fluctuation between two polarities” (Manferlotti 2001, 190)
– are the hope that “energises post-colonial studies writing”, whose language
transformation is a “strategy of possibility” (Ashcroft 2009, 183). Their constructed
identity is derived from the filling of the gap between the text and the context, between
space and place, between major and minor, and between the center and the periphery.
They would perform what Deleuze and Guattari call the becoming and the included
middle, in that “Becoming is the spatialisation of transformation” (Grossberg 2001, 180).
Accordingly, Bassnett and Trivedi claim that the “original” or “authentic” are no
longer criteria for evaluating translation: “they are being questioned”, because translation
becomes the mechanism that allows one to understand the world where s/he dwells
(1999, 2). Bassnett and Trivedi further explain that if the colonial discourse has
represented the colony as merely a discourse duplicating the original, it has failed to
pinpoint the essential feature that undermines the process of translation, i.e. “value
judgement”, which can also include a process of “gain” (1999, 4). However, the one-way
translation that used to encode the relation between the colonizer and the colony has now
been adjusted to include the other-way-translation in which the post-colonial has come to
define her/his other. At this point, it is imperative to note that translation not only
features post-colonial writing so as to become the new original that speaks in an
“authentic” voice, but it also contributes to a process that has been under scrutiny for
years: the act of writing back.
2.3 GLOBAL SPACES, TRANSCULTURAL LOCATIONS
Since translation is becoming an important aspect in the post-colonial discourse, it remains
a sensible topic for the emerging literature in English; as soon as the act of writing in a
major language is questioned, the importance of space emerges. It is argued that the
interconnectedness between language and translation, and place and space is a salient
characteristic of colonialism. In the English language the difference between space and
32
place reveals an idea of manipulation that is not configured in other languages: in
German, for instance, the word Raum stands for both place and space. Space can be
emptied, and place can be “appropriated”, theoretically and practically. These
appropriations reflect on the sense of control maintained over “space through
cartography” and place as a site of colonial domination (Ashcroft 2009, 76). The tonality
of this textual relationship demonstrates the value and metaphorical meaning of the
palimpsest, which Ashcroft defines as “a text on which previous inscriptions have been
erased but remain as traces in the present” (2009, 77).
If we project the concepts of place, space, and location onto the notion of the post-
colonial transformation, we can summarize our project in terms of the following points:
first, the space introduced by Ashcroft for the colonial is perceived as empty. The process
of naming gives power to the colonial to manipulate that which becomes at a specific
moment place. Place is there because of the new space. However, it can be noted that
both place and space exist only as results of location. Second, location – the point from
which the post-colonial writes and the language s/he transforms – seems to connect the
two shores of writing in/outside the nation. The space becomes the horizon that enables
the minorities to negotiate their identities, and the place is the medium of this articulation.
Both space and place exist because of the deterritorialized language: the language as
location. Third, it is important to note that with the notion of place, space, and location,
the notion of home may be understood as neither stable nor definitive. The instability of
the notion of home can be defined in relation to the different locations that the post-
colonial inhabits. It is not definitive because the notion of home that the post-colonial
aims to re-construct might not be connected to a certain place, but home remains in the
space of language and translation.
In addition, location may be understood as a sequence of transcultural hybridity
wherein the subject occupies a number of “different positions”, suggesting that passing
through these locations would only provide temporary meanings for defining “home”
(Nyman 2009, 73). Sara Ahmed points out that “home is not simply about fantasies of
belonging (where do I originate from?) but that it is sentimentalized as a space of
belonging (“home is where the heart is”)” (qtd in Nyman 2009, 81). The implications of
location also suggest that the notion of home is mobile, and through its mobility that
identity is re-constructed. Place can no longer be perceived as determinant of fixed
identity, “neither is it envisioned as a locale in which difference fuses into a melting pot,
nor is it perceived as a new frontier of exceptional cultural status” (Raussert and Isensee
2008, 4). Place as a site of transcultural interchange has accumulated a new
understanding of the multiple temporalities in which identities are constructed. It has
significantly shifted the emphasis from the position of place as a closed space of national
and cultural identity to a more general framework that places identity beyond cultural
and national traditions.
The notions of location, place, and space are concepts through which to approach
the emerging North African novel in English. The construction of such concepts is
intrinsic to writing in the language of deterritorialization: English, for the north African
writer, is not her/his mother tongue, nor is it a language of colonialism, but it is one that
its presence is marked and conditioned by the existence of other major languages, such as
33
that of English (new medium of writing) and Arabic or Amazigh (mother tongue(s)).
Arabic and French have always been present, and much literature is written using one of
the two languages. But to write in English in this geographical space, or to recognize
these writings in a global sphere has been conditioned by numerous obstacles, which
need to be included in any analysis.
Arguably, a text in relation to globalization does not mean “text” in itself, so much
as an emblem of other textual events that connect to history (Gupta 2009, 76-7). As many
critics have suggested, the complex relations that interweave textual events with history –
these include authorship, the reader, social construction, and the history of reception –
exemplify a protean analogy for the function of literature qua globalization. Critics
suggest different meanings and approaches to globalization. Gupta, for example, assigns
disjunction to globalization as one of its characteristics. He points out that
‘globalization’ is one of those extraordinarily protean terms of our time, which
seems to be relevant, and is increasingly accepted as meaningful, everywhere. In the
absolute embrace of the core word, the ‘globe’ itself, struggles against the
modification of the suffix, the process marked by ‘-ization’. A wide variety of
possibilities slips through that slight disjuncture between the absolute and the
potential. (2009, 13)
In Gupta’s view, these include, for instance, the possibility to engage with the global
construction of concepts and the enunciation of the global and the local (2009, 14). Within
these possibilities, uniformity is not an option for homogenizing the post-colonial novel,
even though post-colonial literature may discuss globalization as an instrument of
transcultural identities. The absolute, nonetheless, is not parallel to the possibility of
restructuring a literature, and yet a potential solution perhaps remains in the possibility
for literature to dwell on global issues such as location. As a result, global movements
and the intense flux of identities are events characterizing globalization, which,
ultimately, connect them with the local events. Giddens reminds us that globalization is
“the intensification of worldwide social relations which link distant localities in such a
way that local happenings are shaped by events occurring many miles away” (1990, 64).
From the perspective of Giddens, both the local and the global interact in a rather
complex process that reflects on the subject of enunciation.
In addition, the discourse of the minoritarian that bases its rhetoric on the
dichotomy of minority/majority has been replaced by the discourse of transcultural
hybridity (Butler 2001, 190). Because of its connection to concepts such as
transnationalism and cosmopolitanism, tranculturality echoes the complexity and
nuances of globalization. In his “On Minorities: Cultural Rights”, Bhabha notes that the
emergence or the creation of the new minority group – “the partial cultural milieu” –
underlines a systematic operation that links the outside and the minor to the inside and
the major. This creation need not be understood in the sense that it restrains the
prosperity of the “nation”, but in the
34
[c]reation reveals a liminal, interstitial public sphere that emerges in-between the
state and the non-state, in-between individual rights and group needs; not in the
simpler dialectic between global and local. Subjects […] occupy an analytic and
ethical borderland of ‘hybridization’ in a partial and double identification across a
minority milieu. (Bhabha 2000, np.; emphasis original)
The “partial cultural milieu” for Bhabha refers to the transcultural subject, whose
intrusion in the cultural “uniformity” and national “stability” brings the idea of “loyalty”
into question. These new minority groups are conceived of as a political construct charted
in Article 27 of the International Covenant on Civil and Political Rights. This quilt-like
definition sets up minorities between the two affiliations: loyalty to the host society and
the preservation of their distinctive cultures. In this remarkable note on the “partial
cultural milieu”, minorities, to a varying degree, come to experience the malevolence
hermeneutic of the “nation”. Thus, Bhabha has justified the importance of this “partial
milieu” in relation to the “‘non-state’ social actors” as “they are increasingly relevant,
nationally and internationally, in the fight for cultural rights and social justice” (Bhabha
2000, np.).
In addition, the minoritarian seem to accept – in their fight for recognition inside or
outside of the imagined community – to engage in a dialogue in pursuit of recognition
through multiple processes of refining the discourse of the majority. As a result, the
minority text remains the space of liminal hybridity in which the transcultural subject
negotiates his/her position. Accordingly, it is argued that the literary text can be viewed
as a site of rewriting home and reconstructing new identities for an imagined homeland.
As such, the process of redefining concepts of home and identity seeps into “critiques of
origins and of national identity” (Nyman 2009, 25-6). The hybridized notion of identity
formation in relation to home in such texts is important in constructing the new
paradigm(s) of a nation, imagined or actual. It also creates a new meaning for nation and
mixes the local with the global at once. An affiliation such as this propagates the
discourse that homogenizes identity and nation, using transnational hybridity as a
substituting construction. Thus, between home and away, hybridity remains a tool with
which identity is refined, reconstructed, and imagined anew. This process of re-
construction locates the diaspora qua hybridity and liminality. Liminality recurs as a
salient feature of the diasporic identity. William Safran argues that to be in diaspora
implies that you are in two places at one time. It “implies tension between being in one
place physically—the place where one lives and works—and thinking regularly of
another place far away” (2004, 14).
It is imperative to note that this liminal space is not a result of the constant move
between two distinct constructions – home and away – but an aspect of transcultural
belonging. Liminality for Victor Turner (1974) is “transition rites” and it incorporates
three distinct phases: “separation”, “margin”, and “reaggregation”. The margin phase is
the most important period, in which one moves from the symbolic phase to the threshold,
“being in a tunnel” (Turner 1974, 80). Hybridity and liminality do not signify a single
emblem, i.e., inbetweenness. Inbetwixity refers to the movement that charts the transition
from being at the stage of symbolism to that of the threshold (the tunnel). The
35
inbetweenness, nonetheless, correlates with the locale in which two identities negotiate
their space of ambivalence. On the one hand, liminality signifies a complete “separation”
from the earlier point of social structure, and creates a dissolved identity of “neither here
nor there”: a state of ambiguity (Turner 1974, 80). On the other hand, hybridity connotes
a mixture rather than a detachment, and its usage in cultural studies aims to reduce the
discourse of imperialism to a stage of ambivalence, in order to weaken its power. To
become a hybrid may suggest the occupation of a new space, which Bhabha (1999) terms
the “third space”. As I have pointed out earlier in this Chapter, the “third space”
indicates that this newness might not be absolute because of the constant motion of in-
between the two cultural forms: colonizer and colonized. Rather, being in a liminal space
can cultivate a new understanding of the emerging of the transcultural space. When
leaving (the territory), the subject “becomes ambiguous, neither here nor there, betwixt
and between all fixed points of classification”. S/he has entered a territory, whose history
has no link with it. Once entered, the liminal is invisible, “there in the state of
outsiderhood” (Turner 1974, 231-3).
The process of being on the threshold suggests a change in the post-colonial attitude
that the subject needs to replace longing for belonging with that of “unbelonging”. In this
vein, since cultures become liable to global changes (Welsch 1999, np.), the post-colonial
subject strives to belong to a notion of home beyond that which is prescribed by single
cultures. The notion of “elsewhere” does not necessarily imply “home” in its traditional
cultural definition, but transculturality might imply that the cultural formation of the
post-colonial subject becomes that of a hybrid. Accordingly, Welsch points out that the
consequential aspects of global cultural interchange imply that contemporary writers, for
instance, “emphasize that they're shaped not by a single homeland, but by differing
reference countries” and that their cultural belonging is replaced by a transcultural
formation (1999, n.p.). Transculturality not only goes beyond the prescribed notion of
culture and globalism, it generates an affiliation to the local while comprehending a
“cosmopolitan side”: “Transcultural people combine both” (Welsch 1999, n.p.). This new
mode of belonging sets identity “independent of any determinate milieu”, whereas the
notion of “home” and “homeland” can be established elsewhere (Welsch 1999, n.p.).
David Attwell defines transculturality as a “counterpoint” that redefines the “myth
of essentialism and uniformity” in both colonial and post-colonial “forms of self-
representation” (2005, 19). Attwell further illustrates that transculturality “suggests
multiple processes […] of cultural destruction followed by reconstruction on entirely new
terms. Transculturation goes further than the weaker concept of cultural translation,
which would be the translation of material from one culture into the terms of another”
(2005, 18). The term has first appeared in the work of Fernando Ortiz in his Cuban
Counterpoint: Tobacco and Sugar, in which he offers alternative forms of modernity in post-
colonial societies (1995, 98). He suggests that the history of the post-colonial societies is
no longer defined by its acculturation but by its “transculturations”. Taking Cuba as an
example, he points out that
[f]irst came the transculturation of the paleolithic Indian to the neolithic, and the
disappearance of the latter because of his inability to adjust himself to the culture
36
brought by the Spaniards. Then the transculturation of an unbroken stream of white
immigrants. They were Spaniards but representative of different cultures and
themselves torn loose […] At the same time there was going on the transculturation
of a steady human stream of African Negroes coming from all the coastal regions of
Africa […] all of them snatched from their original social groups, their own cultures
destroyed and crushed under the weight of the cultures in existence here […] And
still other immigrant cultures of the most varying origins arrive, either in sporadic
waves or a continuous flow, always exerting an influence and being influenced in
turn. (Ortiz 1995, 98)
It is a new beginning for the act of writing back to the center. The history that Ortiz maps
for Cuba is one that repudiates forms such as “acculturation” and “deculturation” by a
process of “readjustment” in which the minor and the major exert “an influence and
being influenced in turn”.
The history now works in either way, and the dialogue, as Attwell suggests, is a
“dialogue in both directions” (2005, 19). Ortiz points to the importance of immigration in
the process of deconstructing what Attwell calls “the myth of essentialism” (2005, 19), in
the ways that the direction of the process is no longer characterized by its linearity, but
by its ubiquity. In his “The Location of Transculture”, Mark Stein points out that the main
objective for Ortiz is to delineate the ways in which the oppressed and minority cultures
operate within the host or major cultures beyond certain constructions such as
assimilation (2009, 254). In this vein, transculturation is seen as a model that modifies and
analyzes phenomena such as “the hybrid, hyphenated, [and] syncretic global diaspora”
that characterize our world today (Mirzoeff 1999, 131). Even though the term might not
account fully for the emergence of North African Anglophone fiction in diaspora, the
condition of transculturality can be significant in delimiting the discourse of the
majorities in marginalizing the minoritarian discourse in the post-colonial era. The
contemporary global condition proposes instead different types of migrants besides those
introduced by Ortiz, and yet transculturality remains the contingent space out of which
the minor voices emerge to re-write modernity.
Since transculturality is seen as the mechanism for re-writing modernity, it may
sound curious that the post-colonial writer needs to creatively invent new approaches to
sustain such a process. Svetlana Boym reminds us that to be “stripped of history” has
been replaced by nostalgia – nostos meaning return and algia meaning longing:
homesickness – as a search for home that may or may not exist after all (2001, xiv).
Nostalgia is a feeling of loss, but also a strategy for the minoritarian to produce a
countermemory. In the meantime, nostalgia is both inspiring and elusive. Sometimes it is
no longer connected with the past “but [it is] rather sideways. The nostalgic feels stifled
within the conventional confines of time and space” (2001, xiv ). Nostalgia is the art of
memory; it is the desire to re-construct the post-colonial identity and the attempt to re-
imagine home. It is an escape from trauma and a longing for a transcultural space in
cultural globalization. Accordingly, Jeffrey Blustein considers that the role of memory lies
in bringing the past into discussion in the real social world. Making sense of the past is as
if bringing justice to it (2008, 38). However, “memory does not consist in subordinating
37
the past necessarily to the needs of the present […] for he who looks to gather the
materials of memory places himself at the service of the dead, and not the other way
around” (Blustein 2008, 110; emphasis original).
Memory can be a site of continuity and a space for a countermemory (Baronian 2007,
12). Memory has two dimensions – the power to hide is equal to the power to reveal –
that place it in contrast to history. The ability to gain access to history is no longer a
matter of choice, since all that remains are representations and palimpsests. Memory
negotiates self-representation and self-awareness of that past. What is at stake here is that
the operation of memory is always practiced at the level of the unconscious,
subordinating authenticity to history. When wounded bodies proclaim historical events,
memory is no longer a matter of the unconscious but becomes the identity itself. At this
point nostalgia intersects with memory. Subsequently, nostalgia becomes the norm of the
minoritarian in the global world, and transculturality is the mechanism for applying it.
This mechanism seems to deconstruct the apparatus of control between the center and
the periphery: “There is no longer the norm or the center […] there is no one geographic
center pulling the world together […] there are, instead, scattered nodules competing for
our attention. [E]very competing center makes us marginal” (Hoffman 1998, 274-5). The
emphasis on transculturality in the post-colonial condition does not induce writing
between exile and diaspora. On the contrary, this emphasis aims at locating the
theoretical framework that problematizes the issues of memory, identity, and belonging
in the imagined communities, which literary critics localize under the rubric of
hegemony.
To use a variety of approaches to explore contemporary North African Anglophone
writing is to examine the nuances of literary techniques used to problematize these issues
in a foreign language. The post-colonial approach is significant in deconstructing the
novels that I seek to analyze. As a post-colonial narrative, it is important to establish a
locale for analysis in contrast to their location of culture. What is significant in this
analysis is the metaphorical aspect of the term minority as a tool that places these novels
in a position in-between. Consequently, I aim to write between minority discourse and
transculturality in order to chart new phases in the act of re-writing and to correspond to
the dialogue of re-defining transcultural identities of the imagined communities as the
North African Anglophone novel presents. In other words, I will define North African
Anglophone narrative as the production of the minoritarian with the intention of
demonstrating that they are minorities whose economy breeds hybrid identities in the
space of transculturality. In addition, between the language of transculturality and the
discourse of post-colonialism, it becomes the minority literature whose language is that
of transformational deterritorialization: a rhetoric that is relative to the notion of the
“included middle” that offers new possibilities concerning alternative forms of
modernity.
***
In conclusion, to discuss the North African Anglophone novel is both stimulating and
challenging. It is challenging because new approaches need to be introduced to locate this
38
literary fiction within post-colonialism. Many critics working between the axes of Arabs
in diaspora and the discourse of English call for new tools to dismantle the emerging
Arab literature in English. This attitude is vividly engendered in the post-colonial
counter-discourse, which calls for an end to the ghettoized labels that see the emerging
literature in English as marginal. For instance, Steven Salaita’s Arab American Literary
Fictions, Cultures, and Politics illustrates that the need for new approaches becomes the
new demand in literary studies when the subject matter is Arab Anglophone writers. It is
not easy to postulate this appeal in light of the challenges empowered by the act of re-
writing. Salaita argues that, since the events of 9/11, Arabs in America have become “an
unwilling addition to a racialized taxonomy packed with unwilling participants” (2007,
22). The discourse of racialism raises Arabs from the invisibility syndrome to the visible,
while the discourse of English has lifted Arabs as an ethnic group from the margin of
silence into a discourse of resistance. A literature that grows out of marginality addresses
complex issues such as identity, inclusion and representation, in a non-hegemonic way,
and “[a]s a result, the literature of Arab America does not quite bespeak a unified
tradition, but rather a communal grouping” (Salaita 2007, 57). Within this project, Salaita
asks “where might Arab American Studies leads us?” (2007, 146). Sailata’s question
addresses the possibility of new forms of pragmatic analysis in which Arab American
studies could influence the continuity of such a domain beyond area studies and the
discourse of racialism.
Another argument, but a more protean one, can be found in Amin Malak’s Muslim
Narrative and the Discourse of English. Malak argues that “in such conditions of flux and
ambivalent affiliations no neat discursive closure is possible” (2005, 89). Of course, when
Malak refers to this “flux”, he establishes the basis for an identity that exists in the age of
exile and diaspora. “No possible discursive closure” can be a hasty argument, since he
acknowledges that the need to find “a stable terrain to accommodate their hybridized,
evolving sensibilities” (Malak 2005, 89) is a timely and untimely project simultaneously.
In this vein, it appears that Malak’s project is a rather inclusive one where non-Muslim
writers would be able to participate in this discussion. Nevertheless, the approach
appears elusive: whereas the argument constructs itself on the “aching search for the
voices that articulate the point of view of the disadvantaged” (Malak 2005, 2), the
framework of the book seems to be based mainly on Islamic voices, excluding non-
Muslims (among them Kurds, Dalits, the Palestinians, and other minorities).
It should be clear by now that, regardless of the approach that I select, the notion of
bricolage, which I have discussed above, is a key concept in my study of these novels.
Through problematizing these concepts, I aim at locating the North African Anglophone
writing within a predefined scope of post-colonial transcultural minorities. This concept
makes it possible for a North African to write in a major language – a global language –
that is characterized by transcultural de-territorialization.
In addition, the relative emphasis on language as location has expressed a
contrapuntal balance in the process of identity self-construction and in the imagining of
communities. On the one hand, the use of a major language thrives on the optimism of
inclusion within the majority, especially in the hope of deconstructing the potential
danger of exclusion from cultural memory. Language connects two distinct facades
39
harmoniously. It connects the minor with the host land, whereas connection to the
homeland is a matter of cultural memory. On the other hand, it is hardly definite to seek
elements of visibility as markers of communities. Place, any place, connects people
without borders. Hybridity equally regards communities as imagined. What is
remarkable in this regard is that bodies are in constant motion; language is creolized,
borders and spaces are marked by the notion of liminality, identities are in flux, and
communities are imagined. While these contrapuntal inferences, remarkably, may belie
the arguments that call for a post-colonial, hegemonic community, they certainly direct
the internal stratification of (regional) dialects into a condition for the existence of both
language and place. My view of these relations as contrapuntal resides in the dynamic
recurrences of liminal spaces and hybrid identities – major or minor – negotiating the
locale of diaspora in a different language.
Post-colonial subjectivity is not a priori the study of diaspora, but it is part and
parcel of the treatment of (dis)placement in other tongues. The multifarious forms of
literature in English require a theoretical outlook that takes into consideration all the
responses and exigencies related to the text. A text can sometimes reproduce instability
and language may provoke this instability by reliance on the social space.
Transculturality, therefore, remains the space in which stability is negotiated, thereby
providing the basis for an alternative form of modernity.
41
3 The Moor Speaks: Memory,
Identity, and Space in
Anouar Majid’s Si Yussef
I began this study by arguing that labels such as “post-colonialism” or “new literatures in
English” either designate narrow areas or concern homogenizing discourses in literary
and cultural studies. These constructions are circulated to limit the inclusion of an
emerging literature in languages that are not simply colonial per se. That the scope of
English Studies, Post-colonial Studies, or the New Literatures in English deals with the
overarching contemporary English fiction in/outside the former British Empire does not
seem to help in any engagement with aspects of certain literary and cultural
contemporaneity, such as the case of the North African Anglophone novel. The cultural,
political, economic, and ideological specificities of this geographical space render the
intersection between the colonial and the post-colonial problematic.
I have also argued that English literature today is not tied to a certain geographical
space. Rather, its production has largely become transcultural as a result of
“multicultural groups of writers, working in disparate parts of the world, whose works
explore the intersecting effects of colonialism, decolonialism, migration, and economic
and cultural globalization” (Jay 2010, 91). As the forces of globalization have inspired
new routes in the post-colonial and English studies, the same forces can be used in the
Anglophone narrative produced by writers of North African origin. It is imperative to
our understanding that we forge new horizons with which to cope with issues of history,
identity, and belonging in a more specific and subtle way.
In order to direct attention toward such specificities, I will argue that such a model
consists of a theoretical level and a methodological level. At the theoretical level, the
notion of bricolage that I introduced in Chapter 2 construes the North African
Anglophone novel as a transcultural literature of the minoritarian. The transformational
aspect permits flexibility as a mechanism for analyzing such fiction beyond the standards
of all that is post-colonial. At the methodological level, Deleuze and Guattari’s approach
remains the framework for my analysis (cf. Aldea 2011). In defining my field of study, I
aim to reconstruct a new paradigm for approaching North African literary studies by
emphasizing the aspect of re-writing. In this way, my understanding of the abrupt
changes in North Africa will be based mainly on the transformational aspect that such
approaches could engender. There are different layers that constitute the production of
the Anglophone novel of North Africa, and such layers can only be thought of if we
accept the notion of translation offered as “being between” (Lennon 2010, 84).
42
In the following chapter, I will argue that questions such as those of history,
language, and identity can be seen as constituent elements in analyzing the emerging
North African novel in English. In paying these questions careful attention I would like to
start with Anouar Majid’s Si Yussef as an exemplary narrative that aims at re-writing
identity at the same time as it re-imagines its view of history.
3.1 WHOSE STORY? THE MOOR FILLS THE VOID BETWEEN MEMORY
AND HISTORY
When we talk about the act of writing in the geographical space of Morocco and,
especially, Tangier in this present narrative, the reader might anticipate a discussion of
the construction of Moor and/or the Moorish culture. At the same time, to talk of the new
Moor presupposes the existence of an old Moor, because the Moor I use in my discussion
resembles the construct of the Moor used during the Spanish Reconquesta. This includes
especially the expulsion of the Muslims and the Jews from Al-Andalus, now the Iberian
Peninsula. In contrast, to question the legitimacy of the act of writing is akin to the
epistemological debate that pertains to the construct of the “Moor”. Yet the invocation of
the Moor insists on the imaginative and mythological, but remains important to the act of
writing in North Africa. To do this, I would like to elaborate on three main aspects.
First, I will argue that the act of writing in the novel Si Yussef is inseparable from the
process of reconstructing the post-colonial identity. To elaborate on this, I suggest that
hybridity becomes a double-edged source of identity construction: the moment it
originates a new identity that helps the incorporation of the self into the milieu of
memory, the older construction of identity is obliterated. The process of hybridizing
systematically deconstructs the notion of indigeneity, the source of its birth. The second
aim is to contribute to the literary and cultural debate on the notion of cross-cultural
memory. To do so, I seek to show that in the interstices of the psychological struggle over
constructing identity vis-à-vis the changes that take place in the post-colonial space of
Tangier, there emerges a nostalgic feeling toward recuperating the lost past of the
minoritarian. It is a dichotomy that invites us, readers, students, and literary and cultural
critics, to explicate and develop new epistemologies beyond those preserved in post-
colonialism. Third, it is critical to the minoritarian voices and the methods of writing their
history to recognize inventiveness when approaching history. It is essentially pertinent
for identity to emerge, that history be discussed in the present. This becomes a “U-turn”
back to the past, as Si Yussef, in the novel Si Yussef, indicates. In brief, I would like to start
from this point (identity in colonial Tangier) and indicate how it maps and remaps the
space of Tangier in the narrative of Si Yussef. This narrative structure can be seen as a
combination of how the young Lamin defines Tangier and how Si Yussef represents it in
different ways.
Si Yussef, the first and hitherto only novel by Anouar Majid, was first published in
1992 by Quartet Books and republished by Interlink World Fiction in 2005. It tells the
story of an old man called Yussef, honored by the narrator by adding the title “Si” (sir).
The story tells itself, as Lamin suggests, trying to distance himself on his first encounter
with the reader, mentioning that he is a mere recorder of Si Yussef’s story. As the
43
narrative moves back and forth, relying on the modernist techniques of stream of
consciousness and flashbacks, it is evident that the aims are twofold: first it seems to
dismantle the discourse of modernity, and second it aims to introduce a new form of
memory that re-writes the history of the city of Tangier in Morocco. Between the two
representations, the story of Si Yussef unfolds, but remains a crossroads whereby the
notion of identity is problematized; meanwhile the gap between history and memory is
filled with a transcultural memory. This chapter therefore is about these issues, and how
they all function to offer an account of the erasure and re-imagining of a space that no
longer exists except in the narrative: Si Yussef’s Tangier.
On a gloomy day, Lamin, a university student in Fes, meets with Si Yussef – a
meeting of which he “had been expecting the honour for seven years” (Majid 2005, 1).
The narrative spans “exactly twelve days after that gloomy afternoon” (Majid 2005, 15).
The opening of the novel reveals that the quest for re-reading identity vis-à-vis history
remains a space to be explored in this narrative. Two parallel principles characterize this
moment: first, it is a quest to record the past of Tangier and, second, it is an emblem to
reconstruct identity. The first meeting illustrates two different yet connected objectives. Si
Yussef wants the narrator to be the recorder of his story because, as Si Yussef says, his
“mission is done” (Majid 2005, 6) and the next generation ought to know part of their
past. As a university student, Lamin is qualified for this mission. Nonetheless, Lamin
seems to be overwhelmed by Si Yussef’s stories:
For the fifteen minutes that I had spent with Si Yussef, I was suddenly introduced,
for the first time in my life, to a world not of Herculeses and gladiators and other
mythical or semi-mythical heroes that history creates everywhere, at any time, but
to the world of anonymous men on the verge of extinction, and these men talking of
the fabulous wonders of their collective unrecorded past, suddenly making of the
legitimate knowledge I had been acquiring for years in public and private
institutions, an intolerable lie. (Majid 2005, 7)
The implication of this passage concerns the denial of the notion of history – the one that
is produced by the state – by referring to its production as “an intolerable lie”.
The conversation with Si Yussef for the entire fifteen minutes is enough for Lamin
to build up his assumption: the knowledge of the history he “had been acquiring for
years” is limited and contingent, since the collective memory of certain individuals has
been left unrecorded, unheard. Most problematic in this moment is a belief in the need to
de-historicize history itself, of which the act of re-writing needs to lean proportionally, at
least, on those in the margins. In this way it is possible, as Lamin shows, to encroach on
the territory of the predefined notion of the history of Tangier. The institutionalization of
history has discarded a remarkable archive, which memory alone preserves.
Consequently it could be suggested that the past is marked by its discontinuity in the
present. In her “Writing the Individual Back into the Collective”, Crane argues that “[i]f
history is both the past(s) and the narratives that represent past as historical memory in
relation to present/presence, collective memory is a conceptualization that expresses a
sense of the continual presence of the past” (1997, 1373). Such representation is ultimately
44
what both Lamin and Si Yussef aim to emphasize, but each in his own way. Collective
memory is an important aspect that brings the past into current discussions, and it is
through this collective notion of memory that each individual becomes her/his own
historian, as Pierre Nora emphasizes (1989, 14). However, between the notion of
collective memory and Nora’s lieux de mémoire, a void characterizes the transition
between the experienced version of memory (Si Yussef) and the learned one (Lamin).
Nora’s argument concerning lieux de mémoire has been useful for post-colonial
criticism. Maria Lauret, for instance, argues that sites of memory remain significant for an
understanding of Alice Walker’s novel The Temple of My Familiar in its way of preserving
history “which does not try to suppress or eliminate memory but actively incorporates it
and infuses it with imagination” (2000, 158). In the context of North Africa, the notion of
the lieux examplifies a tool that edifies the notion of collective memory. In his study of
Assia Djebar’s La femme sans sepulture, O'Riley notes that the text can be seen as a site of
memory that “articulates a national commemoration of resistance to Western imperialism
ultimately ’illuminated’ by its spectral light and ethereal staging” (2004, 75). Djiar also
notes that some sites of memory in Algeria constitute the mechanisms through which
Algeria re-writes its history (2009, 186). Just as the notion of lieux de mémoire remains
significant for the North African subject to re-write her/his own history, it also becomes
an important aspect in the study of Si Yussef.
In his “Between Memory and History: Les Lieux de Mémoire”, Pierre Nora argues
that memory is seized by history because the search for “memory is the search for one’s
history” (1989, 13). Such transition from memory to history is dramatized in the sense
that speaking of memory becomes primarily a factor of its own diminishing (Nora 1989,
7). Accordingly, an interest in lieux de mémoire becomes an obligation the moment after
which memory “secrets itself […] a turning point where consciousness of a break with
the past is bound up with the sense that memory has been torn” (1989, 7). Susan Crane,
in this vein, asks a timely question: “[d]o we write history because we have experienced it
ourselves, or do we see ourselves as looking at something that is distant and virtually lost
to us?” (1997, 1374).
An explicit distinction between the two questions leads us to explore how history
and memory operate in the novel. Whereas Lamin looks at history from a “distance” (the
consequences of which he is able to interpret only through his interlocutor), the history
that Si Yussef represents is part of an “experienced” memory. The difference between the
two positions is significant but one that takes the shape of the old debate concerning
history and memory. The paradigm that Crane presents exhibits a channel of
interchangeabilities. It is difficult to state from which position history can be viewed, as
Crane asks, but we may assume that history can be retold as operating in both directions.
To conceptualize the difference, one needs to measure out her/his own involvement in
the preservation of memory (which she calls historical memory) and the involvement
with the experience of that memory (1997, 1375). To emphasize this paradigm, I will term
these Si Yussef’s and Lamin’s histories. For Si Yussef we may argue that his past
experiences are historical traces in themselves, and yet the distance that stands between
Lamin and his account of Si Yussef’s history does not imply that this past is “virtually
lost” to Lamin.
45
What interests Si Yussef is memory as a recorder of a lost past. Si Yussef refuses to
regard history as merely a book to read or as an archive to become enchanted by. History,
as Si Yussef defines it, can be grasped only through memory. Yet Si Yussef regards
history as the essential part of memory, since, for Si Yussef, that
memory is not the past, no; it is the present struggling with the past. And the
present is a point of return, a U-turn to the past, because one day you will
understand that the future is the biggest lie of human history […] the future is
where the past is projected, and when we reach that projection, that frightening
screen, we attain the recycled past again. (Majid 2005, 59-60)
History must be brought into the present discussion through memory, and Si Yussef in
this passage seems to recall his memory. Si Yussef suggests that it is always important to
go back to history: history alone grants access to the present in the ways that lessons can
be extracted from such memories. To understand this movement, Halbwachs suggests
that we need to distinguish between two forms of memory: one that is historical and the
other collective. The “U-turn” to the past explains “[t]he need to write the history of a
period, a society, or even a person [that] is only aroused when the subject is too distant in
the past to allow for those who preserve some remembrance of it” (1980, 78). Distance
from the past does correlate with the position that Lamin inhabits, and yet it seems as if
Si Yussef’s experience of history is becoming distanced as well. In addition, both
positions towards the past differ significantly. Halbwachs points to the way that
proximity vis-à-vis the past is understood as distant from memory; in other words, “the
historical memory is the representation of a lost past” and that “[t]he past no longer exists
as collective memory” (Crane 1997, 1377; emphasis original). It could be true that history
is not the past or even part of it. Besides, there is an experienced history that alters and
renews itself every now and then, “and permits the recovery of many old currents that
have seemingly disappeared”, leading to the assumption that this is the collective
memory (Halbwachs 1980, 64).
In the Moroccan discourse of memory, memory operates between the individual
experience and symbolic incorporation of collective memory. Mohammed Melyani points
out that “collective memory gravitates between two modes of reminiscences”, one in
which the singularity of perspectives causes the collective experience to appear as that of
the individual, and the other which makes the symbolic incorporation of memory
meaningful beyond the individual through its transmission at the national level (2007, 6;
translation mine). In other words, Melyani argues that collective memory “gravitates”
between national allegiances and personal experiences in order to dictate a history of the
Moroccan imagined community. The codification of such history might abandon the
resurgence of minor memory such as that of Si Yussef, and it is because of this negligence
that Si Yussef feels the need to discuss the past in the present. What is left to the reader in
the end is a new version of the past, a “recycled” past of a minoritarian. Accordingly,
Orlando reminds us that “for a nation to construct a collective conscious in the present, it
must never forget the events of the past” and that only the notion of the “collective” lieux
can sustain this consciousness (2010, 287).
46
To incorporate such a process of inclusion, Si Yussef considers the present to be a
mere process of turning to the past. He explains this aspect by asking:
what about the light in between? That is the present: an emanation of memory
bouncing on the illusion of the future. “Live your present!” Do you realize that this
is a criminal philosophy? It is as if you asked the projected light to enjoy itself in its
trajectory! No, the moment is useless, because the moment has a goal that started in
the past. (2005, 60)
The passage above explains that the present, without a recovery of the lost past, without
the collective memory, is not a present but an illusion. The search to long for the
trajectory of the present without “projecting” on the past is to enjoy a “useless” moment,
because “the moment has a goal that started in the past”. This is a call for a revisionist
reading of the past through the narrative of the minorities, in a way to provide a
countermemory. To live the present, one needs to know how much of this present
belongs to the past, or, rather, to what extent the memory of the past is preserved in the
present. The movement from the past to the present thus prevails when Si Yussef claims
that the transition needs a more focused and inclusive approach to history and memory.
This includes, as the passage shows, the individual, whenever s/he has the chance to,
penetrating the historical consciousness of the collective. It is through a historical reading
that memory becomes important, but that does not suggest that there is a need to
“supplant the continuity of the collective” (Crane 1997, 1381).
Consequently, to define the present demands “justification through the illumination
of the past” (Nora 1989, 10), and that is exactly what Si Yussef calls for:
I hoped that remembrance would be taught at schools, but there they only teach
them big events like wars and state affairs and plagues and dates. Take Sheikh El-
Mdini, for example: why is he never mentioned in our history books? Why would
an American scholar cross the Atlantic to interview him while we abandoned him to
the winds of the sea? (Majid 2005, 59)
The possibility that Si Yussef articulates concerns remembrance perceived as a continuing
act in the present. Since at schools “they only teach them big events”, history remains
destructive of memory. However, does it essentially mean an end to Si Yussef’s and his
generation’s memory? If so, what, as Si Yussef’s question indicates, drives an American
to cross the Atlantic in order to interview an old man about a vanished past and its
world? This is an interest in the history of Tangier as a way to forge an understanding by
indulging in the act of writing a past in an unconventional way. The idea of lieux de
mémoire in this way is pertinent to the memory of Si Yussef. It does not forecast the end of
memory but reinforces it, because it is through memory that transition from an actual
past to a preserved one could take place.
Since Si Yussef understands that his life is about to end, he looks for someone (but
not simply anyone) to record this part of the history of Morocco. He relies on his memory
and the lieux de mémoire without interrupting the transition from memory to history. But
47
how does such transition work? In my view, it is precisely the narrative voice that fills the
gaps left open in this transition. It is the voice of Lamin himself, who beholds the remote
past of Si Yussef.
Subsequently, Lamin regards himself as “the seeker of truth” who analyzes himself
to recapture the past, a past that has retreated in anger and shame, spreading its
curse on the future with the vindictiveness of hurt orphans and brutally mistreated
widows; it is neither the French ‘involuntary consciousness’ nor the meticulous
picture of scholarship, but a past shrouded in the divine protection appointed for
innocents, a past that is forever closed to the insufficiently trained, a past that
certainly exists, but which now requires the supersensory and epileptic vision of
prophets and saviours. (Majid 2005, 34)
Is it legitimate to use the word “deconstruct” in the case of such a representation? The
manifestation of the past that Lamin prefers to elaborate on is a deconstructive version of
mainstream history. There is an incisive claim to vocalize a reconstructed self that is
conceded Si Yussef’s memory. The narrator has first deconstructed his preoccupation
with the history propagated in Moroccan national institutions in order to explore other
“histories” torn by the “legitimacy” of the monolithic, majority history. To argue in this
way is to accept that both Lamin and the main character are in dialogic connection. They
are indeed, because, after all, this is a dialogue between two different generations, one
past and one present, discussing the “myth” of the future. At this same time, though
contradictory at the surface level, the two manifestations of history complement each
other. Memory is in need of history, and, as Nora notes, “it is memory that dictates while
history writes” (1989, 21). Memory seems to become ephemeral, and Lamin
acknowledges this idea, because the memory of a certain minority group has been
marginalized to the national remembering. Lamin, in contrast, suggests a history that is
distinguished neither as an “involuntary consciousness” 7 nor as a part of his own
scholarship, but as one that designates the notion of a countermemory of a marginalized
people.
The term countermemory was coined by Michel Foucault in his essay “Nietzsche,
Genealogy, History” to call for a separation between memory and history, with an
insistence on considering memories from the margin, and to negate those of the
mainstream. It implies “a use of history that severs its connection to memory, its
metaphysical and anthropological model, and constructs a countermemory – a
transformation of history into a totally different form of time” (1977, 160).
Countermemory, according to Marie Law, is not memory itself but a designation of the
“role a particular memory is playing in a larger construct of remembrance […] It can be a
memory whose job is to subvert the dominant memory, or it can dislodge the tenacity of
the mainstream or obvious memory” and it might function as an act “of re-remembering
7 Cf. Marcel Proust’s novel in seven volumes (1913-1927), entitled À la Recherche du Temps Perdu is
known in English as In Search of Lost Time and also known as Remembrance of Things Lost. The
concept of involuntary memory is introduced to indicate that certain encountered events in daily life
might evoke the past consciously.
48
the past” through its projection in the present (2005, 9). To this we must add that
countermemory becomes the potential tool, or the “supersensory” vision, that saves those
marginal memories, like those of Si Yussef, from present oppressions.
Si Yussef knows that Lamin is a potential recorder of history, and the same belief
emerges for Lamin when he acknowledges that he is becoming the recorder of Si Yussef’s
past (Majid 2005, 72). This perhaps becomes more significant when it comes to Si Yussef:
Making confessions of love to a boy who hasn’t even started in life, an unbroken
shell! But this is precisely what I want: not for you to be my disciple or to see
nothing but a beautiful, spotless panorama of history; no, I want you to drive a
lesson – somehow! somehow! – from this tale. It is not, you see, a document with a
message: I wish I could produce such thing. Maybe you can when you’ve listened to
me. (Majid 2005, 68)
The exhaustion of marginal history makes the task problematic for Si Yussef. He does not
want the young Lamin to be overwhelmed by his stories, yet he is in need of some ways
to document them. His inability to produce such a document of his memory inspires him
(Si Yussef) to look for a recorder. At this point, it becomes important to answer Lamin’s
question: “Why he chooses me?” It is perhaps because “he had for some reasons trusted
the serenity [that Lamin] displayed by the act of reading newspapers and playing less
dominoes, and because [he] wasn’t exactly the typical young man of the new generation”
(Majid 2005, 14). But the other main question remains: why is it this urgent to emphasize
the act of recording?
It is critical to the act of writing back that the means of gathering memories of the
past should conform to that of the present. In order to write back, or preserve the history
of the native, such representations become important in the struggle over historical
inscriptions. As I have suggested in Chapter 2, the importance of examining the
authenticity of representations becomes greater when it concerns the question of
colonizer vs. colonized. Modernity is critical in such a process because the discourse of
modernity encloses the major histories within a national archive. Consequently, is
confusion likely to arise in this respect as to why, for instance, Si Yussef wants his story to
be heard? As the last man of the Khaldi family, he feels a sense of obligation to narrate
the story of Tangier in order to preserve what has already been diminished by modernity
and globalization. Of course, Si Yussef has children, but their hybrid identity and their
absolute “loyalty” to the modern machine engage them to a different way of life. This
engagement causes them to be torn apart from their pasts, and consequently renders the
history of Tangier subversive: his children “seem to have inherited a different blood”
(Majid 2005, 139).
It is a serious matter for Si Yussef that he should articulate his memories to a “non-
hybrid” subject in order to preserve them, and later tell them to the world. But the feeling
of reviving his stories is troublesome to Si Yussef:
I feel like digging in my memory to resuscitate my stories and bring them before me
like complicitous ghosts against the present. But who wants to hear them? People
49
my age would think that I am trying to make a big deal of a time that we all lived,
and the young think that I am compensating for my displacement by romanticizing
a past that was as boring as ours. That is what my children told me. (Majid 2005, 59;
emphasis added)
Si Yussef feels that he is in opposition both to his own generation and to more recent ones
(children). If the former think of him as making a big deal out of minor events, the latter
see that he only wants to romanticize a past that has nothing to do with their present
ideals. The question here is not to judge, romanticize, or even to idealize the old, minor
events; rather, it is “to care and understand” (Majid 2005, 13). The passage also hints at
filling the void of displacement: there seems to be awareness among Si Yussef’s friends
that he is displaced, and that the only way to fill in the gap is to imagine his past through
“digging” in his memory. History and place intersect at this moment to problematize the
identity of Si Yussef, to the extent that he feels incapable of living either in his past or in
his present. It seems that the moment the post-colonial minorities emerge to break silence,
they need to take into consideration the difficulties and the ethical encounters that
emanate from this process. It appears to be difficult to arrive at the conclusion that the
past can be negotiated in the present through memories alone. Memories can sometimes
fail to justify ethically a presence or an absence. But Si Yussef’s aim goes beyond a merely
constructed, romanticized version of his own past.
Moreover, it does not seem to be a trumpet call to cherish the history of a place and
time in which Si Yussef lives. Quite the contrary, the call has rightly found a listener
whose education makes him a distinguished figure; such is the case when Si Yussef
chooses Lamin and makes him the listener to his confession. To overcome such obstacles
that may face Si Yussef in his process of re-telling the past, he mentions the history of
Tangier to the Young Lamin. Lamin, the English student in Fes, is overwhelmed by Si
Yussef’s story, and sometimes he regrets the moment he has accepted his invitation to
discuss Si Yussef’s remote past. Lamin confesses that “in the abysmal corners of my
solitude, I wish I had never met the man; I wish I never knew, and I wish I remained the
fortress that I had been, protected by the trenchant and pitiless exaltation of our times”
(Majid 2005, 71-2).
The sense of guilt or remorse springs mainly from the weight that Si Yussef’s past
has on the young Lamin. This moment is significant both to Lamin’s identity and to the
authenticity of the narrative itself. Lamin’s identity is in a liminal position: he can neither
retreat from the imposed obligation nor continue the linearity of the narration. There
seems to be a flattering subjectivity that visualizes the whole narrative as merely Lamin’s
composite. It is difficult, however, to talk about the complexity of Lamin’s identity
without considering the dynamic of temporal differences between himself and Si Yussef.
Lamin later seems to be relaxed about this position, regardless of such complexities, as
long as it helps him to restore his consciousness that modern life confuses. It is this
encounter that “resuscitated in him a natural inclination, long obfuscated by the various
satanic temptations of our modern and developed civilization” (Majid 2005, 72).
The accumulation of historical consciousness with the complexity it leaves on the
narrator’s identity compounds a reading that moves from the question of the history-
50
memory into the filling of the void that exists in the narration process itself. The
determinacy of the void in this narrative does not suggest any inauthenticity or
inappropriateness in Si Yussef. On the contrary, it remains a paradox that designates the
space between the narration and the re-narration, between memory and countermemory,
and between past and present: it is a space of transcultural memory, which fills in the gap
in this narrative, as I will show in the last section of this chapter. Even though Si Yussef’s
story is narrated, and “told in a thousand tongues” (Majid 2005, 71), it seems that the
same story at its outset becomes an obsession with Lamin, providing him with the power
to reconstruct his identity. Si Yussef inhabits the mind of Lamin, and Si Yussef’s presence
remains
a silent ambiguous presence that seems to have sprung spontaneously from the terra
incognita of my soul, requesting utmost visibility with such an urgency that I find
myself sometimes seating and screaming in my privacy […] while my work will be
remnants of myself, the technical self oversees self-preservation and maintains a
certain sociability that, in the long run, keeps us alive. (Majid 2005, 71; emphasis
original)
The “right to narrate”, as Bhabha (2003, 180) reminds us, is similar to the right to read.
Narration is the meaning of Yussef’s own life, and for the young Lamin re-narration can
be viewed as an act of reconstructing identity. The “silent” presence of Si Yussef
resembles the minoritarian past, which is hived off from the mainstream historical
archive. The visibility it requires resuscitates both the collective memory of Si Yussef and
the other minority groups, and provides the possibility of revision of their identities.
More importantly, the present process of identity construction gives credence to the
memory of Si Yussef and also becomes a remnant documentation of a diminished past for
Lamin. However, to become a reminder of the “lost” past and to be at the same time
obsessed with that past is to leave the space open and to regard this optimal picture of
the past as unreliable. Obsession can be applied to both Lamin and Si Yussef, which
permits viewing the narrative of the past as a subjective version of history. Marie-Law
notes that it is the effect of nostalgia that renders the past unreliable, but concludes that
such an effect can also be regarded as “a kind of countermemory” (2006, 10).
The haunting picture of Si Yussef makes the reader uncertain about the story and
the history. To argue this reading, one may recall, for instance, Hayden White’s notion of
“emplotment” where the notion of story and history intertwine to interpret historical
narratives. Such an interpretation creates the trajectory of the story itself, because, as
White reminds us, “[e]mplotment is the way by which a sequence of events fashioned
into a story is gradually revealed to be a story of a particular kind” (1973, 7). Lamin is
aware of this “particular kind” of a story, and this status of uncertainty drives him to
enquire whether the story is “plausible” or the mere fabrication of a “deluded young
man” (Majid 2005, 72). Yet Lamin insists that the story must be told. He does not know all
of the stories, since Si Yussef’s friends and relatives know other stories. Although history
can be decoded, the ethics of the sources from which it can be decoded may be difficult to
ascertain. Lamin and Si Yussef believe that history is dead and so, too, are the people
51
narrating it, but only palimpsests can extract its memories, and perhaps this is what
exemplifies how history should be re-written. Lamin, like Si Yussef, haunted by his
memories, wants to remember this story, to be remembered and taught at schools and
public institutions. He wants to locate
the agents of time the motive of our odyssey. And to record the lives of men for
redemption foreseen […] And to express my unending gratitude to you Si Yussef
[…] to become that past, and to look at later generations with the pain of abandoned
parents, and then know a truth revealed for thousands of years to different nations.
(Majid 2005, 81)
Lamin relentlessly argues for the possibility of the story appearing to belong to Si Yussef
rather than as his invented “propaganda”, and the novel seemingly opts to mask its
inability by separating the two stories: Lamin’s and Si Yussef’s. It is at this point that
filling in the gaps in Si Yussef’s narration becomes plausible. Lamin wants Si Yussef’s
past to be his as well, and when that past is revealed, recognition and understanding
remain two facets of the act of writing. In her reading of Si Yussef, Nasri points out that
the act of writing becomes the psychological space in which identity is negotiated and
reconstructed, whereby identity becomes a process of narration in its own right. Nasri
suggests that “[t]he space of writing unveils a new territory for the exploration of a new
identity” (2005, 29). Nasri further explains that the “new territory” is understood as an
effect of diasporic displacement, which is a vibrant aspect of the novel.
Dislocation operates in the novel on three levels. On the level of the individual, the
recognition of the past becomes the “motive” of the individual’s journey and the purpose
of her/his return to lost origins. On the level of the collective, it is a way to start thinking
about individual histories in a more inclusive way. On the national level, in order for the
story of the marginal species to be recognized, it has to be the individual’s and the
collective’s need that is to be negotiated across cultures and nations. On the first two
levels, Si Yussef’s historical experience seems contradictory but inspires a responsibility
that supersedes the mainstream historical archive. In order for Si Yussef’s story to foresee
its ultimate dimension of what it means to be a Tanjawi in modern Morocco, Lamin
resorts to the space of language, as a possibility for re-narrating Si Yussef’s story.
When Lamin meets with Omar, Si Yussef’s son, in his office, he discusses with him
the possibility of writing a narrative about his father. The conversation begins with
Lamin telling of his plan “to write some kind of document (I said it was a book in order
to impress him) to record my brief encounter with his father. So unusual was my gesture
that he thought it was a joke” (Majid 2005, 114). The narrator clearly indicates that the
purpose behind such document or the book is to tell Omar’s father’s story to the world.
This aspect reminds us of Si Yussef’s plea addressed to Lamin to establish re-memoration
as an educational subject. Lamin points to this meeting by saying that Omar
believed vaguely and gave me enough respect and permission to record these lines.
It was awkward for him to know that his father reflected on his life with a
young man who is not even a Khaldi. (Majid 2005, 114)
52
This is so because neither of his children is willing to reflect on the life of people on the
verge of extinction; the children of history will become fathers of the of late modernity
and globalization. Paradoxically, the English language becomes the vehicle for
transferring the minoritarian memories. When Lamin is asked why he chooses to write in
English and not, for instance, in Spanish, the language that Si Yussef’s offspring have
mastered, he replies that “because I want the whole world to know what your father said,
Mr Omar” (Majid 2005, 115).
The English language offers a significant margin of freedom for the narrator, and, as
I noted in Chapter 2, the English language in North Africa is considered a neutral tool
that enables the North African writer and her/his novel to step away from cultural or
social barriers. To write a book in English about the memory of the marginalized Si
Yussef is to document an era of a place that is no longer available on the map (at least in a
symbolic way). Changes do affect territories: countries have been erased and others
established; people die, and their offspring emerge as part of an economic and cultural
globalization that bifurcates all that is original and pure. As a result, hybridity becomes
the only marker of the newly emergent space. Lamin wants to make of Si Yussef’s story a
timeless “register of accurate descriptions of human actions” (Majid 2005, 115), the
English language incisively offers new directions for approaching of the story of Si
Yussef. Nasri reminds us that through the modification of English, through the insertion
of untranslated words (but for which a glossary is offered in the beginning of the novel),
and its heterogeneity, “a new life is given to a true interweaving of plural histories”
(2005, 31). Since “language embodies the thought processes and values of a culture”
(Ashcroft 2009, 105), it is undoubtedly a persistent reminder of the culture of Si Yussef
precisely because it transforms the language in this way.
However interesting the process might be, the language “is becoming an
unresolved nightmare, precipitating all kinds of moral dilemmas and generating a guilt
whose redemption speaks in a shy stuttering voice” (Majid 2005, 83). The sense of guilt is
projected onto the use of an “imported” language, a language of becoming and dislocated
writers. This passage shares the observation that I made earlier concerning the diasporan
language, in which language becomes the alternative home for the imagined community.
As an American writer of North African origin, Anouar Majid aims to fill in the empty
space of dislocation by writing in the English language. Nevertheless, the fear emerges
because of the language’s inability to carry the weight it should bear in the memory of
the marginal Moroccans, and the new Moors. It is an “unresolved nightmare” and a
“dilemma” that focuses primarily on the sacredness of the Arabic language, its diction,
and the inability to utter the unspeakable. To use English might solve the dilemma of the
unspeakable, but it might not resolve the writer’s displacement or the possibility that Si
Yussef may be interpreted out of context.
In an interview conducted by Ghambu, Majid points out that this story is mostly
about his “home sickness” (2002, np.). This homesickness becomes a priori central to the
transition from memory to history in Si Yussef. Majid’s remark provides a point of
departure to link displacement in diaspora to language and memory. He says:
53
The central question that animates my world is how to envision a world in which
cultures maintain their sustaining traditions while pursuing a progressive agenda of
change and fruitful dialogue with one another. Very often, we find people rightly
criticizing the reactionary tendencies of Islam […] or attacking Western colonialism;
but rarely do people critique both at once. (2002, np.)
At this point, it is significant to our understanding that the novel should limit the milieu
that the language inhabits in this epistemology.
There is of course a general shift from the question of memory/history to that of
identity/language, and yet, I think, they both operate at the same level. The fear that the
English language might prevent the reader from understanding the logic of translating
the undocumented historical events is directed toward the efficiency of the writer’s own
translation. Lennon notes that, in such circumstances, the relationship between
translation and the text (as memory and its script) often turns the reader into her/his own
translator; in other words, the reader is the translator (2010, 75). Moreover, to translate
the oral into the written assumes two processes of translation, which may lead to
historical lacunae and misunderstanding. As a result, it is logical for Lamin to think of
erasing such a document, especially when he feels that the interference of the language
might contaminate the memory of Si Yussef. Thus it turns out to be the task of the reader
to translate/transition these gaps into a less coercive but significant translation, either as a
document or as a transcultural text. The English language not only sometimes fails to
transmit the narration from orality to scripture because of the gaps it leaves, but it
also screams in a long uncompromising whisper, and when it pierces my being, I try
to erase this script, to avoid this deadly responsibility for an activity that is as
meaningless as the illusion of ambition […] I still have the choice of neutralizing the
whole enterprise, of cancelling pretensions. (Majid 2005, 83)
In this regard, Lamin wants to fill these gaps with as many memories as he can, but his
failure to master the language prevents him in this move. Lamin says that, “I would like
to fill these pages with them, but I already feel obliged to my readers. That is to say, the
English-speaking ones” (Majid 2005, 83). To argue in this way is to neglect an important
aspect used in the narrative, which is the insertion of untranslated words. This process
not only refers to the complexity of Lamin’s identity and the writer himself, but it also
foregrounds the possibility of neutralizing the English language, with process making it
one’s own. Such an understanding could probably explain the word “fill”, i.e., to fill in
the narrative with untranslated words, which may confuse the English reader. It has been
argued that the use of untranslated words in post-colonial fiction written in one of the
colonial languages aims at positioning the post-colonial identity as independent of the
colonial power. It also alludes to the social and cultural specificities of the post-colonial
subject (cf. Ashcroft 2009; Ashcroft 2001). In contrast, Lennon points out that the fact of
translating a local story for the contemporary global English reader remains a process of
“untranslation” that shifts the focus of “our” writers (2010, 143). In other words, Lennon
explains that in such circumstances, “‘our’ writers turn – may have turned – from the
54
U.S.-based literary-critical scene toward those of competing modernities” (2010, 142), that
makes globalization a choice for their re-writing.
If writing in English “sounds exotic” in the post-colonial space, probably for
“English-speaking” readers it becomes a tool for highlighting those mechanisms that
sustain the act of re-writing modernity in “other” post-colonial spaces such as North
Africa. This may explain why the writer of Si Yussef resorts to the insertion of
untranslated words and a glossary at the beginning of the novel. Who could fathom the
meaning “that the story of a new generation would be told in English?” (Majid 2005, 83).
As Lamin points out, it is because he seems to become a rebel: to rebel against that is
national and transnational, to offer a critique of both, the traditional and the global, and
to understand all in order to offer a transcultural reading of the past, the present, and the
future. Lamin’s fear, as the translator and the “re-narrator” of Si Yussef, apparently
becomes logical, because the meetings with Si Yussef have been quick as if memory were
marked by the assemblage of time and space. Lamin explains his acquaintance with Si
Yussef at length in the following passage:
There were random meetings, urgent, fast, vague like the ocean, but God forgive me
if I missed a message he had intended. I felt like a vessel for his recollections,
dumped on me with our typical carelessness, and I, for some mysterious reason, the
same reason that justified the writing of old documents and scriptures, struggling
with them as if it was a matter of life and death, I did better than listen. And I hope I
remembered. (Majid 2005, 121)
I may argue that the transmission of this memory at the oral level (from Si Yussef to
Lamin) and then in writing (not an immediate process) might not give credence to this
narrative and its history, because, after all, the story becomes Si Yussef’s, as the narrator
notes. However, orality remains significant in this transition from the memory of Si
Yussef into the scripture entitled Si Yussef. The history of Tangier and the Tanjawi people
has been documented as part of an oral culture. The culture of orality is the space that
stands between memory and history. It is not the destruction of memory by history as
Nora suggests, but it is the hybrid space in which lieux de mémoire play a role through
which it offers a countermemory. Both actors collaborate in the construction of such a
document: Si Yussef with his memory and Lamin with his language. There are moments
in which Lamin fears that he will forget such memories as the passage above suggests,
but forgetting can also be part of the countermemory whereby Lamin provides his own
explanation (not imagination) of the historical events, and translates, or re-narrates, them.
This is a new mode of writing back: writing the history whose legitimacy is not
dependent on the professional historians alone. Everyone can participate in such
documentations, becoming her or his own historian in a collective manner, and write and
document others by referring to the lieux de mémoire without necessarily speaking in their
place. Crane concludes her essay with a poem by Mark Strand8 saying that the future
8 The poem starts with the following: It came in a language/ Untouched by pity, in lines, lavish and
dark, / where death is reborn and sent into the world as a gift, / So the future, with no voice of it own.
55
“with no voice of its own, nor hope of ever becoming more than it will be, might mourn”
(qtd in Crane, 1385). Crane explains that this poem is the “lieux de mémoire. The fourth
great poem will be written by each individual who is thinking historically: and it may or
may not be ‘saved’” (1997, 1385). The reason why Crane considers such a poem as the
fourth lieux lies in her considering a historical document as history. She points out that
Perhaps the most banal thing that could be said about history, in general, is that ‘it
happened,’ or something happened. But of course, history is not only the past or
pasts that ‘happened’ or continue to happen, it is also what is written or produced
about those pasts both then and now. And so whenever we think about history, we
are thinking about […], in Mark Strand’s words, the ‘gift’ sent into the world so that
the future might remember. (1997, 1372; emphasis added)
To answer the question that heads this section, “whose story?”, I would conclude that
this is the story of the new Moor, whose intention is to demarcate the history of Tangier
in a new tongue. This story is told by Si Yussef, written by Lamin, and imagined by the
reader, and all of the participants have their share in figuring out how Tangier (a former
colonial space) is reconstructed in the modern era. A deconstructive version of reality is
on hold, a mere fictitious prototype designates yet another venue to dismantle the
boundaries between fact and fiction, on the basis of which the next section will be
developed.
3.2 THE MOOR WRITES BACK: AN ALTERNATIVE HISTORY
In the previous section, I have sought to explain how the passage between memory and
history undergoes a process of filling and refilling the void in order for the
transition/translation to take place effectively. I have also argued that the new mode of
history proclaimed in this narrative either by Si Yussef, Lamin, or by both remains a
discursive strategy for memory to appear as a counter-account of the mainstream
memory. However, the discussion does not explain precisely the sort of history that the
narrative aims to write back to. Hence, this section aims to delve into this question and
the ways in which the narrative employs magical realism as a device linking Si Yussef,
Lamin, and the other characters with their native past. It also aims to show how the
amalgamation of two conflicting perspectives, the magical and the real, deconstructs the
binaries of past-present, real-imagined, and colonial-post-colonial, and offers a flexible
approach for the role of the presence of the past in the present.
When Lamin claims that his role in Si Yussef does not align with that of realism, he
intends to fashion a new mode of narrative history out of the memory at hand. The claim
that he is not “a realist” because he only knows “that some things are more real” to him
than other things (Majid 2005, 75) foregrounds the demise of yet another mode of history
in North Africa. In this vein, Lamin aims to fill in the void that is left in the remembrance
nor hope,/ Of ever becoming more than it will be, might mourn. “Orpheus Alone.” Mark Strand, The
Continuous Life: Poems (New York, 1990): 9.
56
of Si Yussef and his own memories altogether by claiming that his/Si Yussef’s tale is
“foretold, narrated for salvation of some and the confusion of others” (Majid 2005, 75).
In accepting this new mode of narration, I could argue that Si Yussef is meant to be a
new voice that challenges the epistemology and ontology of Western realism that have
empowered colonialism. Many critics have elaborated on this connection that forestalls
any possibility of writing beyond the cultural baggage of Western terminology. In her
“The Question of the Other: Cultural Critique of Magical Realism”, Wendy Faris argues
that the resurgence of what can be called magical realism is a discursive strategy that
examines the struggle between two contradictory systems. She notes that such positional
struggle “serves to reflect the postcolonial situation especially well. It has therefore
served a decolonizing role, one in which new voices have emerged, an alternative to
European realism” (2002, 103). Faris further notes that the associative link between the
discourse of colonialism and realism is meant to explain the importance of post-colonial
writers’ deconstruction of realism. As she puts it,
whatever a realist text may say, the fact that realism purports to give an accurate
picture of the world, based in fidelity to empirical evidence, and that is European
import, have led to its being experienced by writers in colonized societies […] as the
language of the colonizer. (2002, 103)
Critics of magic realism, however, define the concept as a yearning for the primordial
past characterized by a nostalgic feeling on the part of the writer for “identity and
cultural emancipation. The magical realism […] is shown to develop from an urge to
reclaim a space of otherness by appealing to myths of difference” (Warnes 2009, 5).
Magic realism, by definition, is a mode of narrative that brings the real and the
imagined in a “troublesome tandem”, as Lamin notes (Majid 2005, 71). Dale Carter
suggests four characteristics that define magical realism:
First it is the combination of reality and fantasy and second, it is the transformation
of the real into the awesome and unreal, thirdly an art of surprises, one which
creates a distorted concept of time and space, fourth a literature directed to an
intellectual minority; characterized by a cold cerebral aloofness it does not cater to
popular tastes, but rather to that of those sophisticated individuals instructed in
aesthetic subtleties. (1969, 3-4)
To align magical realism with the minoritarian narrative, we are driven to think more of
the ways in which Deleuze and Guattari connect Kafka with this narrative mode. A
minority literature, from this point of view, suggests both an inclination to create magical
realism and a deconstructive approach to language, history, and to the colonial discursive
tradition. To argue that magical realism is a narrative mode that aims to demystify the
magical in reality is to state that new voices can emerge from such de-mystification.
Whereas Faris reminds us that “magic realism often gives voice in the thematic domain to
indigenous or ancient myths, legends and cultural practices” (2002, 103), Warnes points
out that “magical realism represents the ’writing back’ of the margins to the center”,
57
regardless of the meaning the center might inhabit, and “it blurs the binaries of modern
thought” (2009, 6). It also suggests and “critiques the assumptions” of, and reveals, the
“ethical failings of realism” (Warnes 2009, 6).
We have already hit a snag central to “writing back” in the narrative of Si Yussef, in
the problem of how to account for the potential failure of the process of writing back
without subjectively interfering in the memory of Si Yussef and the Si Yussef story.
Magical realism appears to be introduced in this narrative to suggest the multiplicity of
voices in history in order to incorporate different forms of histories. The aim is threefold:
first, magical realism, as a mode of writing back in this post-colonial text, becomes a
context for the post-colonial identity to renew its mode of reconstruction. The third voice
filling the void becomes a transcultural voice that incorporates the past in the present,
thereby imagining new spaces for constructing new identities without necessarily
restoring that past. Second, the implication of magic realism in this narrative is to account
for the misconception that incarnates the major history by giving credence to the memory
in the margin. Third, as a hint to such formulations, magical realism is grasped as a tool
that introduces new epistemologies toward rerouting post-colonial studies. It is at this
point that a responsible understanding of the present past can take place when Si Yussef
mentions the U-turn to the past.
When Lamin declares that he is “not a realist”, he suggests that something
underneath the structure of the story is employed to account for the act of writing,
something that goes beyond the real: the magical. The story of Si Yussef is constructed on
this basis, mixing the real with the magical without any part dominating the other. Such a
juxtaposition necessitates complexity in the narrative, whereby the identity of the post-
colonial Moor becomes an interwoven complexity of the old, the new, the mythical, the
real, and the minor.
Si Yussef’s identity, as represented in this novel, is a consequence of all these. Si
Yussef’s remembrance revokes the notion of the fixity of identity the moment the
mythical is invoked to construe his identity. As a young boy, Si Yussef describes at length
what his memory could grasp of the encounter between his father and the Maker of
Hearts, a black fortune teller from the south. The prophecy says that Si Yussef’s story will
be “preserved for the future, to be recorded in the oppression crying vengeance” (Majid 2005, 36;
emphasis original). It also suggests that hybridity will attenuate the continuity of the
Khaldi family. Purity of blood is no longer a characteristic of the new Moroccan
generation (not only the Khaldi family), because, as the Maker of Hearts prophesies, there
will be “an irreversible dilution, a mixing more powerful than the therapeutic métissage, a dance
of souls, separated by the sea and the history of our glory and defeat […] El-Andalus” (Majid
2005, 36; emphasis original).
The line between the real and the magical is blurred in this passage, suggesting that
transculturality is the main construct that engulfs the next generations in North Africa.
The Maker of Hearts notes that the mixing of the Khaldi blood is not that of hybridity or
métissage, but something different and new, something in which the power to write the
past is equal to that of constructing new identities. This magical description of reality
reproduces and redefines the linearity between the two shores, Spain and Morocco. It sets
up a history of the Mediterranean crossings as it is marked by stories of hate and love
58
and “glory and defeat”, when the Iberian Peninsula was part and parcel of the Almoravid
and the Almohad dynasties under the name of El-Andalus. The space of the invisible
emerges in a total visibility so as to examine this historical subjugation.
The reference to the existence of Islam in Europe highlights a prominent issue that
concerns the coexistence of minorities vis-à-vis the major cultures: the Moor, or Moorish
heritage. The construct of the Moor originally defines those Muslims, Jews, Berbers (the
indigenous people of Morocco), and Arabs who lived in Andalusia before the fall of
Granada in 1492. In the words of Emily Bartels, the
Moors had been subjects of Spain for so long that their history and Spain were
effectively inextricable […] Even after Spanish inquisitors began (in 1492) to
condemn their Muslim beliefs, it would take over a hundred years for the Moors to
be officially banished from Spain. (2008, 14)
Anouar Majid, in his We Are All Moors, extends its usage to include “anyone who is not
considered to be part of the social mainstream” (2009, 5).
We encounter in this narrative a history that is marked by hatred, fear, and a lack of
trust between the two shores. It is not by accident that the Maker of Hearts suggests that
the new history will no longer be marked by the question of purity. If the Muslims and
the Jews were forced either to show an absolute submission to Christianity or to be
expelled from Catholic Spain, the new history of contemporary Morocco and Spain
would be one that is characteristically transcultural. The Moor’s religious and cultural
differences “that allowed sixteenth century Castilian monarchs to forge a slippery notion
of identity” (Majid 2009, 9) have no space in modern nation states, because the
quintessential attribution of religion and/or culture to the construction of identity has
been deconstructed by the new mode of belonging that is defined as transcultural.
Si Yussef, as the prophecy says, will be Khaldi no more, and his father was the last
of the Khaldis. Impurity, the end of a family line, marks the new construct of identity, “a
mixing more powerful than the therapeutic métissage”, which is ultimately confirmed by Si
Yussef’s engagement to Lucia. Impurity is also clearer when Si Yussef acknowledges that
his children born by Lucia “seem to have inherited a different blood” (Majid 2005, 139).
The Maker of Hearts, therefore, testifies to the new space that the post-colonial
subjectivities will inherit, a “space of the invisible forces that move the world: dreams,
legends, myths, emotion, passion, history” (Allende 1991, 54). As the Maker of Hearts
fades away, “he has become a condition, a state of mind, dead nostalgia, a surrealist myth
for the disbeliever” (Majid 2005, 37), with the function of reminding the coming
generations of the new space that exists between the real and the imagined, between
hybridity and purity.
There is an urgency in this narrative to rethink the history between Spain and
Morocco. This is evident, especially at the beginning of the story, when the narrator tries
to testify to the myth he says he “always believes”. When he meets with Si Yussef for the
first time that gloomy afternoon, Lamin is reminded
59
of the myth I always believed: Hercules, standing on top of the caves he carved after
separating the continents of Europe and Africa, saying, ‘Let the winds and the
tempests blow forever on this land,’ and his entourage, then the generations that
followed, then the historians, and now the meteorologists, all acknowledging that
the prayer or prophecy had been fulfilled. (Majid 2005, 7)
Especially Tangier, with its location and cosmopolitan milieu, is rendered as a space of
interaction with a bond that links Africa to Europe. The Myth of Hercules remains a
reality engulfed in a magical way and which contests the “European myth” of whiteness
and superiority. Tangier in this context is the magical reality that helps in the destruction,
followed by the reconstruction of the European identity. Majid, in commenting on the
locality of Tangier, points out that “[t]his ancient, borderline city, renowned for its
laissez-faire attitudes, where calls for any kind of purity keep stumbling over the
imperfections of our human nature and our multiple ethnicities” has certainly affected
his approach to the concepts of history and culture (2009, 25). This is similar to Si Yussef
and Lamin, who regard Tangier as a space of identity reconstruction. In such a place,
identities are in constant flux, and cultures and histories are not stable constructs, but
marked by differentiation, always in motion. If the Maker of Hearts has faded away, it is
because he becomes a reminder to the coming generations that this geographical space is
not strange to Europe, nor is Europe to Africa, but they share a history distinguished by
both hybridity and purity, culturality and transculturality, a crossing of the threshold.
The persisting transculturality produces the character of Si Yussef who himself
becomes transcultural and hybrid at the same time. Many have contributed to the
construction of his identity, a process that ultimately takes him more than seventy-seven
years, in the course of which he encounters, for instance, fortune-tellers, Christians and
Jews, the Spanish, Italians, and French, and the local Tanjawis. In addition to the hybrid
locality of Tangier (to which I will return in the following section), Si Yussef’s identity
becomes one that is constantly changing with place: Tangier. Since his childhood, and his
encounter with the Maker of Hearts, Si Yussef encounters many Europeans who help
directly or indirectly in reconstructing his identity. As a tour-guide in Tangier, Si Yussef
meets with an American anthropologist for whom he arranges a meeting with Sheikh El-
Mdini. The reason behind this meeting rests in Si Yussef’s belief that “the cannons facing
Spain never fired one single shot but that they were placed in that strategic position to
frighten the jinn and the affarit away from our town” (Majid 2005, 41). Si Yussef starts to
become interested in the stories and histories of his ancestors, and later he becomes
obsessed with how history will be narrated for the coming years or centuries. As El-
Mdini narrates his story to the American, he points to his interlocutor to mark his words,
noting that “this story will be told for another hundred years, because it is the same story,
whether it be the damned Portuguese, the Spanish, the French, the Chinese, whatever”
(Majid 2005, 42). It is as if the Sheikh insists on the act of documentation more than in
who is documenting. The importance lies in the act of re-writing, blurring the line
between the weak and the powerful, or the colonizer and the colonized. It is the act of
writing that matters, not who writes.
60
In addition, two contradictory elements seem to coalesce here: the magical (jinn and
affarit) and the real (Spanish, Portuguese, and the American anthropologist). The
narrative suggests that the invisible is important if we want to understand the colonial
legacy of the Spanish and the Portuguese in Morocco, and the way the anthropologist
rationalizes the magical. Both colonial powers have wanted to seize Morocco, and yet the
importance of this seizure lies mainly in how to understand such a culture. The reference
to the jinn and affarit is significant for an understanding of certain aspects of Moroccan
culture, and since the Portuguese realize this aspect, they start building a huge cannon.
The Sheikh explains that the Portuguese have built the cannon because they want to
frighten the jinn and the Spanish at the same time. As a consequence, the two elements
seem to be employed to indicate the history of colonialism that is documented by an
anthropologist. It is a counter-history, whose existence cannot be represented by
“ordinary realism […] because ordinary realism looks like an evasion in these contexts”
(Wood 2002, 10; emphasis added).
The re-imagined past of Tangier is combined with the provocation of Western
literature and philosophy. It is as if the narrative tells us that Si Yussef is not a mere
product of Tangier but an amalgam of modern philosophy as well. Si Yussef comes to
know “Baudelaire’s poetry” and the literary tradition of the Jewish Kafka (Majid 2005, 49),
but without necessarily neglecting the Baraka of his culture (Majid 2005, 50). The first
lesson in philosophy comes from the Spaniard Pedro del Sol. At first, Pedro is critical of
Si Yussef’s country, as Si Yussef notes while “listening to his linguistic prejudices – how
the Basque and Catalan were barbaric languages, ‘just like your language,’ he told me
without hesitation” (Majid 2005, 57). These prejudices are part of the history of power
and fear that characterizes Moroccan-Spanish relations. However, mutual understanding
might clear certain ambiguities between the two cultures. As Si Yussef tells Lamin, there
are certain changes that seem to affect del Sol’s view of Morocco:
he started liking this country because he finally understood what it takes a lifetime
for the dumb never to understand, and that is how right del Sol was, how beautiful
this land is, that in our djellabas and rezzas and belghas, that with our unshaven
faces and noisy souks, that at this mysterious crossroads of the forbidden something
of the past, a spirit, a miracle, a persisting hope, a legacy that has been brushed
aside in other places, a victim of too much humanness, has survived. (Majid 2005,
58)
Communication and transcultural understanding may clarify cultural and linguistic
prejudices. It is also noteworthy for an understanding of this passage that transculturality
does not intimidate cultures; rather, it sustains an equilibrium of which
incommensurability becomes a realm in the modern world. Si Yussef becomes interested
in learning Spanish, in the same way as Majid learns it. Majid tells us that he “never
learned Spanish in school” but he tended to “use the language by watching soccer games
and music shows on television, reading magazines, and talking to friends” in order to
gain an understanding from a position closer to Spanish culture (2009, 26). This parallel,
while an interesting intersection between the author and certain characters in his fiction,
61
also leads us to believe and understand how Spanish culture comes to inhabit a part of Si
Yussef’s identity.
Pedro eventually disappears, leaving his wallet with Si Yussef, in which he finds a
note “CARLO MARX” (Majid 2005, 59). Si Yussef tries to look for his teacher, and
because neither his age nor his position allows him to go beyond the Mediterranean, he
asks one of the fortune-tellers to spy on Pedro. Again, the parallel between the real and
the imagined remains an important tool for people in his position to extract truths
beyond their reach.
The philosophy of del Sol seems to influence and shape the personality of Si Yussef
for his entire life, and its existence can only become ephemeral in connection with the
faith of the country where he lives. Faith, as Si Yussef notes to Lamin, “is neither past nor
future, it starts in eternity and ends in eternity and makes the present as ephemeral as
desire” (Majid 2005, 60). Pedro’s philosophy makes Si Yussef displaced, “occupied by or
merged with other beings and places” (Faris 2002, 111), and such displacement
encourages him to marry Lucia, and merges with her the first time he sees her: she
becomes his “salvation” (Majid 2005, 61).
His marriage to Lucia remains another stage in the process of Yussef’s identity
construction that continues to the moment of his death. To become engaged to a Spanish
woman in Morocco is a matter of choice that very few dared to consider at the time of
high colonialism. When he is destined to marry her, Si Yussef is left between two
extremes: the refusal of the Christian mother and the denial of the locals. Because he is a
Moor, Lucia’s mother sees this marriage as a sort of blasphemy, an act of contaminating
the Spanish Catholic blood: “When Lucia declared her love for the skinny Moro and
Antonio gave his consent, Isabella made the sign of the Cross and regretted her whole life
[…] One year after Lucia’s wedding, she returned to Spain where she died” (Majid 2005,
79). Neither do the locals accept such an arrangement.
The women in Tangier urge Si Yussef’s mother to “exorcise him and expel him to
the desert before it’s too late” because, following his marriage to a Spanish woman, he
will no longer be one of them (Majid 2005, 66). Fear and suspicion dominate the thinking
of the dwellers on both shores. Each one, Spanish or Moor, is alarmed by the potential
threat the other may cause religiously and culturally, and it is to this that the men in the
Café Nejma object as they are very hesitant to initiate any dealings with Si Yussef. “These
Spanish women are no good” is the sentence Si Yussef hears every time he is in the café,
because “if they can’t suck our blood with guns and malice they suck it by stealing our
best men” (Majid 2005, 16). The inscrutability that seems to be a part of this relationship
is linked to the historical heritage that defines Morocco and Spain. In my view this partly
explains “Spain’s quest for the northbound modernity as an attempt to repudiate its
Moorish legacy, but we also knew that Spain was no typical European country. Spain
was part of who we are; it was our rival and semblable at once” (Majid 2009, 26). This
uncanny relationship suggests that Si Yussef should look for a space where he can start a
new process of what Bartels refers to as “cross-cultural exchange that not only opens out
but also opens in, to the improvised interiors of domestic life” (2008, 189). Thus his
marriage to Lucia is a first step in this process, one that reshapes his identity and opens
up new spaces for negotiations.
62
The role of religion is significant in this narrative, especially when it comes to Lucia.
Lamin points out that “the only thing worth mentioning about Lucia’s version is her
absolute devotion to her husband” (Majid 2005, 80) and not to Islam. To begin with,
Lamin is not sure whether Lucia has “given up her Catholic faith, and this fact alone had
intensified the awe that surrounded Si Yussef” (Majid 2005, 6). Later in the narrative,
Lamin disavows such a question, because he believes that this concerns only Si Yussef:
[w]hy should I give my opinion on Lucia and her faith? Of the men at the Nejma
objected to this relationship of cultures, they have their own reasons for doing this.
Their wisdom comes from the time of the affarit and holy men. If wisdom is
timeless, I am from a generation that is not. We speak from invented moments and
we perish like consumer goods. (Majid 2005, 127; emphasis original)
Lamin agrees with the fact that the people in Café Nejma belong to a generation of the
past, a generation that is characterized mainly by religious and cultural purities. These
have no space in the age of cultural globalization, since he himself testifies to a generation
of hybridity and transcultural understanding. The old Tangier and Tanjawi people are
remarkably religious and mythical, and in their world the space for magic is exclusive.
The new testimonies postulate a new paradigm where the magical is imbued with the
real to incarnate the spirit of what is beyond cultural understanding.
Si Yussef clearly underlines the path of his life journey, and his decision not to stick
to the tradition of Tangier and its religion demarcates his identity as hybrid, but also
liminal at the same time. The hybrid space of Tangier facilitates the task of Si Yussef to
meet with diverse people from all parts of the world. The Italian lady who wants to adopt
him as her child is a remarkable incident in this context. It is an event that hovers around
Si Yussef’s memory. Passages such as these serve to complicate the identity of Si Yussef,
and he becomes even more complex in his encounter with the Moroccan Jewish Isaak
Benkalim. In the words of Si Yussef, Isaak Benkalim
was another generation and another faith, so I never had a chance to speak to him. If
you saw him, you’d think the man was living in some other place. He had one of
those uncertain expressions, somewhere between cracking out in hysterical laughter
and hopelessly bursting into tears […] His sunken cheeks and piercing look gave
him the air of a bankrupt gangster, suspicious and deeply hurt. He wore simple
clothes which, like his face, appeared ragged in spite of their newness. (Majid 2005,
84)
This detailed description of Benkalim poses many questions with regard to ways Jews
live in Morocco and their relations with the Muslims. Being part of “another faith” would
mean being either a nassrani (Christian or any European or American) or a Jew. The
importance of faith becomes problematic only when the Moroccan has a religion that is
different from Islam. Subsequently, the narrative does not suggest any tension with the
European Christians who live in Morocco, except for the Spanish, which might not be a
consequence of Christianity but of the historical conflict between the two countries. We
63
can notice the existence of the American, the Italian, the French, and the Germans who
live in Tangier without suffering from any prejudice. But when it concerns the locals
having a different faith or aiming to change their existing faith, they face absolute
isolation. Thus, the narrative describes the incident that occurs when Si Yussef’s proposal
to become engaged to one of the girls in Tangier is rebuffed: “I knew that my love had to
be more sophisticated than the daughter of a man who wanted to become a nassrani in
the land of good Muslims. Who could have guessed that I would fall in love with a
nassrania?” (Majid 2005, 66; emphasis original).
We come to know Isaak Benkalim only through the lens of Si Yussef. Benkalim is
not a foreigner because “[o]lder people knew him well, and some even had known his
father, who was buried in the Jewish cemetery. But his whole person suggested a
distance that made him neither local nor foreigner” (Majid 2005, 85). The same level of
uncertainty that demarcates the relation between the Spanish and the Moroccans seems
to characterize Moroccan Muslims’ view of their Jewish counterpart. Even though he is a
citizen of Morocco and collaborates in business, his partners have “continued to eye him
with suspicion” (Majid 2005, 85). Benkalim’s life is unknown to many of his neighbors,
but his philosophy affects the way in which Si Yussef interprets his life experiences.
When recalling Benkalim, Si Yussef points out that he “spoke out of the blue” and he
“wished he was talking to me”. Then he continues:
It is a strange feeling without addressing you. He was always watching: keeping an
eye on the rough contours of a life that promises so much and gives so little. There
was a deep mistrust in that look. I cannot find the right word for it. It was neither
skepticism nor despair, and it wasn’t dead look either. For Isaak Benkalim was a
lively man at heart. His story, however, is written in deep silence; we never had
access to it. (Majid 2005, 87-8)
It is Benkalim who finds the job for Si Yussef as a book-keeper in the La Gazelle
company. The conversation he has with him reshapes his identity, thereby blurring the
line of suspicion that demarcates Benkalim’s personality. Later in the novel, Si Yussef
comes to realize why Benkalim hides his personality and lives the way he does, to die in
silence. When Si Yussef reads of Hitler’s philosophy he understands “why Isaak had to
die, and why he lived the way he did” (Majid 2005, 90). According to Richard Gunther,
[t]he Holocaust had a traumatic effect on Moroccan Jewry, even though their
community was saved from the devastation which struck the Jews of Europe. When
Jews looked ahead, particularly after Moroccan independence in 1956, and even
though the new Constitution said that only Muslims and Jews could be citizens,
they saw an uncertain future. (1997, np.)
Gunther is partly right in this point, especially that this is used as a rationale behind the
outflow of the Jews from Morocco to the established state of Israel in Palestine. In
addition, the Jews in Morocco “relied on an already existing religious feeling of
membership in a diasporic community forced to settle in Morocco” (Boum 2009, 55), and
64
the conjunction of both (diaspora and Nazi) forced the Jews, such as Benkalim, to remain
hidden in “his deep silence”. However, it is argued that the Moroccan and the Muslim
share more than they can think. The Moroccan flag used to include the Star of David, and
when the French took over the protectorate of Morocco, they banned the star and
replaced it with the pentagram of today’s flag. The terrorist’s attack on a Jewish
Synagogue in Casablanca and other targets in May 2003 alarmed a million Muslims and
Jews. They marched in the streets of Casablanca together in protest, in a refusal to be
“intimidated or divided” (Majid 2009, 25).
The Holocaust has become a site of memory that Si Yussef invokes to chart his
memory. In this respect, Si Yussef’s will to reshape his identity according to Benkalim’s
philosophy is a significant call in this narrative to cease cultural prejudices, because there
may be “a risk that today’s youth will grow up believing that Arabs and Jews were
simply meant to coexist rather than living together” (Moroccan Jewish Community
Council; qtd in Majid 2009, 25; emphasis added). Consequently, as a site of memory, the
Holocaust might not belie Si Yussef’s memory but supplement it, and may give credence
to its existence as a major minority narrative.
It seems that all these figures and others enlisted in this novel collaborate in the
process of reconstructing Si Yussef’s identity and re-writing the history of Tangier.
However, as the memory of Si Yussef moves to its end, an anecdote about
disenchantment emerges to demonize, indirectly, the space of hybridity. Even though Si
Yussef’s story corroborates the importance of the space in-between for the construction of
identity and for the epistemic model of the nation (which emulates the predefined notion
of a nation in modernity), he feels that the goal is in essence utopic. His marriage to
Lucia, regardless of its success in an era that is marked by high nationalism and where
the question of purity and hegemony are significant paradigms to Tanjawi people, leaves
in him “an emptiness that she cannot fill” (Majid 2005, 129). His engagement to Lucia
gives him the support to live in Tangier, but it also, in a significant way, deprives him of
the need to perform his religious prayers. This is evident when he sighs as he mentions
Isaak Benkalim’s daughter’s conversion to Islam:
Si Yussef sighed like a wounded wolf. His face sank into a deep expression of pain.
It was beyond, far beyond the restlessness of unresolved trauma. The pain seemed
engraved with insistence on his soul, raging soul behind the carcass of fatal age,
desperately seeking space for air and relief in his random and unexpected narration.
Suddenly, he looked defeated, frantically reaching back for an irrevocable,
irrecuperable past, negotiating with a passion that only such sudden dead look
could generate or cause. He had frequent bouts of depression, but I couldn’t tell
how much they had to do with his old age. Yet this interruption, this agonizing sigh
struck me with so much urgency that I spent the following four years speculating
on it. (Majid 2005, 87)
Lamin is not able to fathom the meaning of this sigh, though it comes right after Si Yussef
mentions Benkalim’s daughter’s conversion. This incident will be repeated in the novel,
but with a much clearer view of how depressed Si Yussef becomes, because neither does
65
his wife convert nor does he perform his prayers. Si Yussef feels the need and the desire
to recover the culture of his origin. Si Yussef believes that “good luck” denies him “the
chance [and] the passion to regain and to continue to recite the Qur’an” (Majid 2005,
139), and in light of this he confesses to Lamin that “he hadn’t performed his prayers
since he was twenty or so” (Majid 2005, 139).
The narrative positions the notion of hybridity in a paradox. Si Yussef’s devotion to
his wife Lucia prevents him from living within his cultural milieu in Tangier. This liminal
space, within which Si Yussef partly rejects his own culture the moment he encounters
the new one, ultimately becomes the weak spot in the process of identity construction. Si
Yussef tries to explain that his need to pray is not a choice for him, because he believes
that “people pray when they are under some kind of pressure. They pray to seek help
and they pray to show gratitude” (Majid 2005, 140). It suggests that people sometimes do
not need their culture to balance the old with the new, and yet he later assumes that the
culture of origins becomes an important aspect of the identity of the post-colonial.
Si Yussef points out that he “wavered between these two extremes, solidly stable in
the middle, as if he had no big passions or needs. It was like early autumn: no storms, no
upheavals, but good steady predictable weather” (Majid 2005, 140; emphasis added).
Such cultural detachment suggests that there are at least two forms of hybridity: the first
is liminal and the other transcultural. Liminal hybridity is performed by Si Yussef, who
stands “solidly in the middle” but at the same time nullifies his cultural tradition upon
the moment of encounter with the other culture. However, this does not necessarily
means that Si Yussef adopts the other culture totally. Quite the contrary, his engagement
with Lucia is Si Yussef’s life journey to choose from her culture what he needs in order to
live in his own cultural medium. Here, Si Yussef is at the threshold, as Turner reminds
us, “neither here nor there” (1974, 80).
The second aspect of hybridity is that of transculturality, which is performed by
Lamin, and Tangier can be seen as an aspect of it. Lamin’s refusal to comment on Lucia’s
faith is a key in this context. He does not want to comment on her Catholic faith, or to the
question why she does not convert to Islam, and even though he inquires about this at
the beginning of the novel, Lamin later feels that he belongs to a different world of
otherness, not that of faith or culture, but one that is transcultural. We can observe such
identity transformation by the end of the novel, when Lamin falls asleep in the mosque in
the old Medina (the name of the old towns in Morocco) after his afternoon prayers. When
he wakes up, he sees a gathering waiting for him to regain consciousness. The people’s
faces are not recognizable; some of them speak in a language that he cannot fathom,
while at the same time they start whispering. The strangers turn their faces towards the
mihrab in the mosque and apparently start talking in the language of the locals, “making
an intense supplication for salvation” (Majid 2005, 151). These strangers (who are defined
as the affarit or jinn) address Lamin to help them take the faith (Si Yussef’s) back from the
nassara. The lost heritage of Si Yussef, his lost culture and past, needs to be restored so
that he can align with the new, modern aspects of Tangier and Morocco in general. The
affarit say that they “cannot remain in that dungeon forever” (Majid 2005, 151), a
statement that forecasts change in the social and cultural sphere in Morocco. The modern
66
changes that affect the life of Tangier no longer accept that a single cultural tradition can
dominate, and the affarit urgency to be released is a case in point.
In the course of this conversation, Lamin hears the voice of Si Yussef calling him,
and immediately he starts his prayers on Si Yussef, joined with his “visitors”: “we pray
that you keep our memory alive, in this and other men, so that OUR STORY, not someone else’s,
drifts along the banks of this curse, until Your mercy engulfs us” (Majid 2005, 153; emphasis
original). Again, two points are worth noting with regard to this passage: first, that the
prayers performed after a death in Islam are not performed for a non-Muslim, and
Lamin’s prayers for Lucia can be understood as a call for an end to the tradition. In other
words, to use one’s own culture to account for others becomes part of the past, while also
suggesting that the destiny of the new Morocco is to engage in cross-cultural
understanding. This can only be achieved through education as the affarits note
addressing Lamin in their prayers: “You show us the way to our old selves, now mutilated by
too much knowledge, because don’t they know that it is a sign of your mercy not to give that
knowledge to those You favour?” (Majid 2005, 153; emphasis original). The second aspect
concerns the way in which Lamin engages in a dialogue with the affarit. In order to
understand this amalgamation of the real and the imagined in this passage I would like
to refer to Faris, who suggests that the combination of the real and the magical in the
modern world “means that the cultural function of the mode as it has developed is not, or
certainly is no longer, only to allow its readers to indulge in nostalgic return to a
vanished past” leading to a triumph over modernity (2002, 114-5). Or, rather, the
narrator’s awaking from his midday dreams supports what Gerald Martin suggests,
namely that “life is a dream - the ‘unreality’ and ‘unauthenticity’ imposed by almost five
hundred years of colonialism - and that when a dream becomes a permanent living
nightmare it is probably time to wake up” (1995, 108). The combination of the magical
(affarit and jinn) with the real (Lamin’s conversation with them) informs about the
possibility of reconstructing the history and space of Tangier. Lamin feels that it is time to
”awake” from the dream of subverting the minoritarian narratives and histories, and in
order to do so, he shifts to the text as the space to write space and history.
In a significantly more vehement manner, the text in itself has become an example
of magical realism. The gaps that appear in the narration are left unfilled. At this stage, it
seems that Lamin cannot control the linearity of the narrative, and this inability can be
interpreted as a consequence of magical realism. There are many narrators who tell the
story of Si Yussef, some of whom we know, such as Lucia, Omar, Lamin, and some at the
Café Ashab, but there are also many others whom we do not know, such as jinn, affarit,
and fortune-tellers. To illustrate the ambiguity of the version of history that the narrative
aims to present, there are passages in which metatexts intrude on the narration,
concluding that magical realism refutes the idea that “we” know history. The basic
assumption that history can only be represented in a magical way may provide
opportunities for Si Yussef and Lamin to engage, each in his own way, in representing
the Tangier that each of them sees, and this is the point the next section is intended to
highlight.
67
3.3 TANGIER: A CONTACT ZONE
Si Yussef is intended to contest Euro-American representations of Tangier in the ways in
which its narrative re-imagines the space of Tangier as a contact zone in the sense
understood by Mary Louise Pratt (1995). Greg Mullins, in his Colonial Affairs: Bowles,
Burroughs, and Chester Write Tangier, for instance, cites some of these representations
through which the three American writers construct their Tangier. He points out that
Burroughs defines Tangier as an “interzone” “of intermediacy and ambiguity, a place
that remains outside standard narratives” of Moroccan identity (2002, 3). And yet each of
the three writers Mullins cites creates his own notion of the interzone because the Tangier
of the postwar period was “an attractive place for foreigners to live” (2002, 6). Especially
for Paul Bowles, Tangier has “represented the possibility of living [the] idealized lifestyle
[…] a ‘colonial’ setting” that he has desired (2002, 20). Because the Tangier of Paul Bowles
has been viewed as a space of sexuality and a version of an “orientalized” North Africa,
Si Yussef can be seen as a narrative that re-writes Tangier by offering different
constructions of Tangier. In this way, the act of writing forms a part of the continuous
process of representations and counter-representation, especially those of Si Yussef and
Lamin. It also shifts the focus from the writing back to re-writing.
Significant in these constructions are the ways in which, on the one hand, identity
and space overlap to produce new meanings and opportunities to view the past from a
minor perspective. On the other hand, it seems that the language of magical realism
becomes the narrative mode that substitutes the idea of Tangier as past with a
transcultural space in the present. These two representations replace the old Tangier, but
also add a new version of Tangier that aligns with the new mode of writing back. Si
Yussef’s Tangier is one that becomes “surplus” in the history of Morocco and reveals the
inherent and hidden sites in Si Yussef’s memory. Nevertheless, the way in which Tangier
is perceived by Lamin is different, and its name signifies nothing except itself. The
narrative thus juxtaposes itself with the two modes of narrative, coalescing in a
supplementary way. In order to explain this paradox, I will refer to Tangier as a site of
memory and Tangier as a space for criticizing modernity.
While this novel focuses on the notion of representation from a native point of view
(Si Yussef, Lamin, and the locals), a parallel emerges to indicate another version of
narration contributing to the invention of “another idea of Europe” (Ash 2004, 13). Many
tend to claim for a European modernity whose “idea”, as Ash Amin notes, is built “on
four myths of origin” and which includes “the supremacy of a legal system based on
Roman law”, ethics based on “Christian piety”, a political system based on democracy,
and “a universalism based on Reason and other Enlightenment principles of
cosmopolitan belonging” (2004, 2). Such a classification, or definition, of Europe might be
“pitched against” any other individual, racial, and religious communities that do not fall
under such European standards (Ash 2004, 2). However, some critics claim that this “old”
idea of Europe does not allow for the imagining of a “different Europe” (Dainotto 2007, 5),
among whom we can find Iain Chambers.
In his Mediterranean Crossings: The Politics of an Interrupted Modernity, Iain Chambers
extensively discusses the importance of the space between Europe and Africa in the
68
formulation of new understandings of the role played by Africa in Europe. Because
Africa has essentially been silenced in the colonial period, the post-colonial aura becomes
significant in providing this geographical space with the mechanisms to contradict the
notion of modernity that engulfs it. Chambers, however, postulates that such a shift
remains evasive, in as much as the strait at Gibraltar is excluded from this post-colonial
preamble. He notes that there is “unfinished business” in the narrative of history between
Europe and Africa, a matter that is remarkable for its silence, but for which its insistence
could mean “interrogation” rather than a mere void (2008, 8). Chambers also points out
that “[s]uch an insistence supplements [and] challenges the fixity of the past and the
reification of its authority deposited in a one-sided remembering and representation”
(2008, 23). Between Europe and Africa, the Mediterranean Sea becomes the oxymoron
that divides and links the two continents, which are mostly characterized by a history of
enmity and of linguistic, religious, and cultural differences. The signification of the space
of Tangier in this narrative forces us to think beyond the national allegiances of each, and
to open, rather than to close, a new chapter in history of a “contemporary presence
molding and modifying the horizon of possibilities” (Chambers 2008, 8).
Tangier, in this construction, is rendered as a contact zone. Pratt defines such zones
as “spaces where desperate cultures meet, clash, and grapple with each other, often in
highly asymmetrical relations of dominations” (1995, 4). In this description Tangier seems
to conform to the space that Pratt sees and which “invoke[s] the spatial and temporal co-
presence of subjects previously separated by geographic and historical disjunctures, and
whose trajectories now intersect” (1995, 7).
One could claim that this is, then, the “Yussefian” Tangier (if such a label were to
exist) that would link parts of Morocco and North Africa to Europe through Spain, while
its route is rooted in Africa. To say that Si Yussef’s Tangier belongs more to Europe than
to North Africa is to reiterate a discursive power that has long been part of the orientalist
strategy of remapping the orient (cf. Said 1979). But what I would like to offer instead is a
new reading of the relationship that crisscrosses the linked geographical spaces from a
minority perspective. We come to know Tangier, its history and its people through Si
Yussef’s memory. Si Yussef’s Tangier becomes, through narration, an imagined presence
of an absent space that lives only in his memory. We also come to know Tangier from the
location of the Ashab Café, as if the reader were exposed to a screening in which flashes
from the past were projected onto its presence, or that s/he would be sitting in a corner
from which all of the events could be seen.
Si Yussef’s choice to spend his leisure time in the Ashab Café resonates in him a
local reality that implies that changing locations may accidentally announce a potential
caesura in the revision of identity. The move he makes from the Café Nejma to the Ashab
Café may be understood in light of the process of the (re-) construction of his identity,
since his attachment to the Ashab Café is reminiscent of his own past. The Ashab Café
becomes a vivid light in Si Yussef’s world, since it “gave Si Yussef the assurance he never
had in the Nejma” (Majid 2005, 20). The same desire (assurance) justifies Si Yussef’s secret
plea to think of this oblique corner as a site where he can tell his stories to a young man.
The Ashab Café becomes a driving force in the narrative of Si Yussef and the point from
69
which to rethink the history of North Africa. Lamin explains this aspect in conjunction
with what he knows of Si Yussef:
Ashab’s café offered a timely revisionism: at the age of fifty seven, Si Yussef came to
see his friend Laarbi in the newly opened café, Si Yussef was already reminiscing
about a past whose traces he gently felt and assessed. For the next twenty years, he
would also follow with an intense curiosity the newly laid path of the future. (Majid
2005, 22)
In order to understand the embeddedness of the Ashab Café in the history of Si Yussef,
we have to be aware, first, of the significance of the space of the café in Moroccan culture.
In his study of café culture in Morocco, entitled “A Place on the Terrace: Café Culture and
the Public Sphere in Morocco”, Graiouid argues that it can be characterized by two
significant aspects: equality and identity re-construction (2007, 532). He points out that in
the café the individual “engages the notion of privacy in a dynamic whereby the
economic, social, cultural, ethical and psychological identity of the individual is not
marginalized or silenced, but empowered and given voice in the collective space” (2007,
537). This might also be the case of Si Yussef, because it is from this marginal space that
we come to encounter a marginal history documented by a young college student.
Different figures can be found in the Ashab Café: students, diplomats, spies,
workers, teachers, and so on. The Ashab Café, as the novel puts it,
promised a cosmopolitanism that no other could challenge. There were, of course,
whorehouses, hotels, and casinos that offered more than liberalism and more than a
refuge from the unendurable miseries that the European and American people who
frequented them suffered in their own countries, but these were zonas francas, places
outside the logic of our lives, where men drifted in and out with the same mystery
that condemned them to the life of peripheries and edges, for reasons that were too
complex for us to understand, except for the foreign habitués who knew these places
and wrote about them with the same authority and scholarship that allowed them
to gain the respect that they were now forfeiting in the forbidden territories of our
lives. (Majid 2005, 20)
On the basis of this passage, we come to understand that the function of the café in
Moroccan culture is not merely limited to friendly conversation during people’s free
time. Rather, it becomes the space wherein people could share their views and,
sometimes, “fill in the gaps in the mainstream media text” as if the act became a process
of rewriting mediatized discourse (Graouidi 2007, 545). The café itself becomes a
document that uncovers the different sites of memory that constructed the space of
Tangier before the independence of Morocco was declared. There are places the locals are
not permitted, or are unable, to visit, and these are the “Zonas Francas”, an historical
reference to the position that Tangier used to occupy before World War II.
In 1923, Tangier became an international free zone under the control of the
European powers, mainly France, Spain, and Britain, making of Tangier and Morocco
70
two separate geographical spaces. This process of internationalization has pushed many
to flee to Tangier as the war begins in Europe. Si Yussef describes this at length:
The war, you see, had sent us all kinds of people: intellectuals who believed in the
philosophy of a disenchanted Frenchman who lived in Algeria, war criminals,
wealthy men and women who didn’t know what to do with their money back
home, spies hunting men with a past, divorced women who had made up their
minds that to be kidnapped and sold in the market is ultimately better than to
spend their lives reading Baudelaire’s poetry, separated women who had had
enough of their civilized husbands, deposed princes who came to enhance their
tragic destinies with the stimulation of kif, excommunicated priests leaving their
parishes to form some kind of club called Kafta or Kafka, I don’t remember, exiles,
passionate men and women who were convinced that one of our people had the
passion of twenty Europeans, renegades who believed in the struggle for the
liberation of our country, thieves who had run away with millions to enjoy the
protection of your grandfather, pathetic painters who were said to be famous in
their countries. (Majid 2005, 49)
The narrative becomes a vibrant memorial to certain historical events and, in so doing, it
makes of Tangier its lieux de mémoire. Si Yussef aims to tell the reader that the Tangier that
he is speaking about at this moment has been a witness of the brutality of French
colonialism in Algeria since the invasion of Algiers in 1830. The allusion to Baudelaire is
also significant in the ways the narrative suggests that people are no longer interested in
Romanticism but have drifted into a world of modernity instead. Through this passage,
Si Yussef wants to tell his interlocutor that Europe at that time was a space in a state of
absolute chaos and political turmoil, which affected the position of Tangier in all possible
ways.
In my reading of the novel, Tangier becomes, not only a cosmopolitan city, but a
city of hybrid identities. It welcomes the Jew and the Christian, the French, the Spanish,
and the Italian, men and women, the poor and the rich, and invites all of them to dwell in
Tangier. What ultimately emerges from this constructivist notion of Tangier is a city that
becomes a site of memory witnessing its transformation from traditionalism into a world
of modernity, as the name “Kafka” may suggest, and Tangier is “renowned for its laissez-
fair attitudes”as Majid reminds us (2009, 25). The consequence is an influx of migrants,
refugees, and spies into the city, whereby foreign things and people become intertwined,
and identities become more hybridized (Laamiri 2009, 14).
Si Yussef’s way of describing the old Tangier to Lamin not only aims at rewriting a
probably undocumented past but also at using it as a palimpsestic episode that constructs
his memory as a countermemory. Si Yussef reminds his interlocutor that it is Sheikh El-
Mdini who tells us about the roots of the city of Tangier because “it was our people who
had welcomed the blessed ship of God’s chosen; it was he who pointed to the ship and
yelled Tin ja! Tin ja! And the Romans and probably other nations calling it Tingis, and
now, you know, Tanja, Tangier, Tanger, ta ta tat” (Majid 2005, 116). This episode seems to
fill in the interval or the gap that might exist between the sites of memory and the notion
71
of countermemory. On the one hand, Si Yussef wants to project a history from the
margin, whereby the use of magical realism embodied in Noah’s ship becomes
inseparable from the dynamic deconstruction of the history of Tangier. In this vein,
magical realism becomes the way in which the history of Tangier undergoes a process of
re-writing. On the other hand, Tangier becomes the geographical space that exists not in
isolation from, but in conjunction to, the many sites that may or may not exist at all as a
historical archive for Si Yussef’s memory.
The memorial and memory form a linear movement, and yet it should be noted that
such a movement does not necessarily exist at a concrete level, or rather it influences the
flexibility of the lieux de mémoire. Whereas Si Yussef himself might be understood as lieu,
his memory becomes precisely a counter-version of the mainstream history. Nora tells us
that “lieux de mémoire have no referent in reality; or, rather they are their own referent:
pure, self-referential signs” (1989, 23), and to this it may be added that self-referentiality
in the narrative of Si Yussef operates on a horizontal level together with memory. The
horizontal representation provides the mechanism for deterritorilizing the mainstream
history and suggests that the minoritarian is no longer vulnerable to destruction but it
sustains deterritorialization through ways in which such representation connects the
archival with memory.
As a site of memory, Tangier remains, for Si Yussef, a powerful memory tool, the
use of which aims first at rewriting Moroccan history and, second, at writing back.
Tangier’s Si Yussef attempts to tell us about colonial Algeria and the political turmoil in
Europe, and how the Moroccans from the Rif region were dragged into participating in a
war that was not theirs, the Spanish Civil War. Si Yussef recounts this episode when he
meets with Juan Frederico, who confesses to him that “‘Riffi men who guarded Our
Saviour, Francisco Franco, the man of genius who knew better than to bow to economic
pressure and preserve ambition,’ were the only Moros worthy of praise and respect”
(Majid 2005, 109), a war in which many Moroccans from the Rif were killed (cf. Graham
2005). Si Yussef remembers these incidents because they are sites of memory that are
significant in the reshaping of the new Tangier. He claims that, immediately after the war
ended in Spain in 1939: “ [p]eople said that it was our men who had made the difference”
(Majid 2005, 11).
The War in Spain, moreover, is another lieux de mémoire by means of which the
narrative revives the memory in the margin. It suggests that whatever happens in Spain
directly influences Tangier and simultaneously contributes to the historical discourse
concerning the enmity and friendliness between Spain and Morocco. Spain, as some
would argue, is “a great, detached fragment of Africa, and the Spaniard is the first-born
child of the ancient white North Africa” (Havelock Ellis, qtd in Majid 2009, 161). The
same feeling resonates in Speaking of the Moor, as Bartels argues that “Europeans were no
strangers to Morocco [...] Nor were Moors strangers within Europe” (2008, 14).
The memory that Si Yussef charts in this narrative is rooted in a global and
transnational context. The narrative constantly moves between different pasts, one that is
marked by global conflicts and another that is national. In so doing, it aims at rerouting
the history of Tangier and Morocco in a new way. When Si Yussef talks about the conflict
of the Riff region and relates it indirectly to the first wave of immigrants to Tangier, Si
72
Yussef refers to the Spanish defeat by the Riffi people under the command of Abd El-
Karim El-khattabi in 1921, after which riots spread in Spain. Much of what Si Yussef tells
his interlocutor happened either in Morocco or in Europe, but in either case the events
influence Tangier and its people. The creation of the Riff Republic in September 1921 and
its forced collapse in May 1926 becomes another site of memory that Si Yussef invokes to
give credence to his own memory.
Moreover, the end of World War II was significant in the history of Tangier. Even
though the narrative represents a Tangier that is torn away from its motherland,
Morocco, Si Yussef insists that Tangier is an important site of memory that contributes to
the re-writing of Moroccan history. Si Yussef’s memory of the French protectorate that
forced the king of Morocco Mohammed the Fifh and his family into exile on Corsica in
1953 and later to Madagascar, is triggered when he recounts the incident of the atomic
bomb attacks on Japan.
The war ended in Europe and the Americans had dropped two atomic bombs on
the Japanese […] The French had stolen our king and put him on some island in
Africa. And that was it: the French were suddenly confronted by our wounded will,
a will bigger than technology itself. (Majid 2005, 118)
Tangier at the beginning of the narrative is not a part of Morocco but something that
springs from Si Yussef’s memories. This Tangier exists as a space in which transcultural
identities enjoy a certain level of freedom and peace. As the narrative reaches its end, we
come across a Tangier that belongs to Morocco, but it is also transcultural. It is as if Si
Yussef wants to tell his interlocutor that the notion of Tangier that he has in his memory
also exists in the historical archive. It is history that proves the existence of Tangier, and it
needs to comply with its hybrid space. In the end, to belong to Morocco suggests that
identity, since it is transcultural, does not necessarily deny its roots, but only reroutes its
ambitions to reconstruct itself in order to live in the contemporary world. It is significant
to mention here that Si Yussef insists on the difference that exists between his generation,
his children, and Lamin. In the meantime, the difference is incommensurable, because the
possibility to become cosmopolitan in the matter of Tangier means the denial of the
cultural baggage on the first occasion that the history has to be accounted for and
reclaimed.
Although the Tangier that Si Yussef devises for his interlocutor suggests that it
exists, at least symbolically, for Lamin it remains a name with no relevance in any major
history. The equivocal aspect of Tangier suggests a gap that exists between two different
narratives, or histories. When Lamin visits the soap factory in Tangier he does not intend
to locate the factory in the city of Tangier. Rather, his aim is to adapt the image that he
has grasped from Si Yussef’s memory to that of the existing factory as a site of memory.
In other words, Lamin’s unstable, fragmented attitude towards Si Yussef’s memory,
whether it is an extract of history or merely a notable disposition of his story, reverses the
role of power from that of space (Tangier) into that of the discourse (the narrative).
Lamin’s arrival at the soap factory where Si Yussef used to work can be interpreted in
two different ways: on the one hand, Lamin’s arrival might be intended to assure himself
73
of Si Yussef’s existence, and thus of the existence of his memory. On the other hand, none
of what Lamin hears from Si Yussef exists the moment he visits the factory, because Si
Yussef’s Tangier is not that of Lamin. Lamin is struck by the numbers of Tangiers in
existence. Instead of one, Tangier becomes multiple and therefore offers multiple
histories, among which we can find those of Si Yussef and of Lamin. This is evident when
Lamin starts describing the beach in Tangier, on his way to the factory:
The whole area had the look of an abandoned industrial site, although, as far as I
know, only Coca-Cola had an operating plant there. The beach was, unlike the main
one that is connected to the main part of the city, open to the poor. Old men and
women dressed in Jellabas would bring their children to swim, while they sliced
watermelons, ate hot and dry egg sandwiches. (Majid 2005, 92)
The deserted place in the new Tangier is now open to the poor, but it is a place that once
played a significant role in the history of Tangier itself. The desertion of the area may also
suggest that it is people in the margin who might preserve, albeit indirectly, the history of
places and their meanings. Lamin tells his reader how the progeny of Si Yussef, for
instance, do not visit the old town in Tangier, because their life is preoccupied with the
intensity of modernity. In contrast, these people (the poor, minorities, etc) have no access
to the new Tangier and its beaches, because, like history, certain spaces are not open to
everyone. The other beach is already separated by a fence that makes it difficult for the
masses to access the new Tangier (history). It is “accessible only to tourists, cabin renters
and naked people, glowed with false promise. It glowed in the distance like a beautiful
European woman” (Majid 2005, 92-3). In the same way, history is restricted to
monuments and museums.
In addition, it is worth noting that the fact “only Coca-Cola had an operating plant
there” assumes that Americanization is a fact in North Africa. It is as if Lamin wants to
tell the reader that in the process of cultural globalization only Americanization can
survive in post-colonial spaces such as Tangier. This probably refers to the end of Si
Yussef’s story, suggesting that globalization may deter minoritarian history, thereby
distorting the authenticity of minoritarians themselves.
The elements that make Si Yussef’s history “authentic” are the same that might
cause its destruction, because they are liable to disappear. The soap factory, for instance,
“was slowly dying; the major business had been relocated to the suburbs or to other
towns and cities” (Majid 2005, 93), while Si Yussef’s memory, if it is not documented, will
no longer be viable. Lamin is aware of this aspect, especially when he starts thinking of
taking a picture of Si Yussef’s boss and thinks that, by taking the picture, he might give
“Si Yussef’s story the solidity that it lacks” (2005, 93). But because of the ethical issues
that the photo might need to “acquire the historical legitimacy that scrupulous academics
demand” (Majid 2005, 93) he decides not to take it.
Unable as he may be to escape from the lieux de mémoire, Lamin insists that their
effect on the legitimacy of Si Yussef’s story in Moroccan history is feasible. The question
may not be whether to take the photo or not, or whether the factory remains in its place
74
or not, but the palimpsestic existence of such reality remains a remnant of Tangier’s
history. Lamin thinks that
the picture accuses; insists on remembrance: the factory, the soap, the workers, the
hope, the ambition, the retirement, the ups and downs, historic moments of glory,
death, the struggle of the unprotected protégé, his demise, partnership, the
unheralded rise of a new version of Reason, threatening claims to privilege, and
more. (Majid 2005, 93-4)
Bill Ashcroft reminds us that “[p]lace is never simply location, nor is it static, a cultural
memory which colonization buries. For, like culture itself, place is in a continual and
dynamic state of formation, a process intimately bound up with the culture and the
identity of its inhabitants” (2001, 156). The dynamism of space and its susceptibility to
transformation impose new visions on the reconstruction of old places in new spaces.
This may also be applicable, as Nora suggests, in the use of memory. In Nora’s view it is
important for the individual to record, because something in the end will remain (1989,
14), and something of the old places will emerge once more.
Even though history and memory are viewed as incompatible elements with the
restoration of the past, it is argued that to represent the past may suggest the need to rely
on “the traces that remain. We do so through memory, and the writing and reading of
history” (Touaf 2005, 150). This contradictory aspect between memory and history is also
triggered by the ways in which Si Yussef and Lamin approach historical accounts of their
stories. If Si Yussef’s countermemory comes into existence mainly through multiple sites
of memories that bear the notion of Tangier as a historical construct, the latter, according
to Lamin, exists only as an indication of its absence.
The Tangier of the past becomes a mere name that signifies nothing except itself, a
concept which Deleuze and Guattari call the asignifiying element in representation. The
photograph that Si Yussef finds in Monsieur Francois Sardon’s office at the La Gazelle
factory visualizes Tangier as empty. Indeed, Si Yussef mentions to Lamin that he has
never seen any photograph of his town apart from the one he finds in the office. The story
of the empty Tangier reminds each of the characters of incidents similar to this one. Si
Yussef remembers how, for instance, a picture taken of Tangier by an English
photographer raised a controversy among the residents of Tangier: “It started with two
men arguing about whether the picture was indeed a photograph of Tangier, or whether
it was just another satanic deception. “‘It has no spirit,’ argued the man who refused to
believe that he was seeing his own town. ‘It looks barren empty’” (Majid 2005, 94).
Furthermore, the Englishman insists that the picture is real, and he argues that “If you go,
I bet you’ll have exactly the same view” (Majid 2005, 94). The locals see the picture as a
simulacrum that has no traces in reality. The locals corroborate the fact that the picture
represents a denial of their town of Tangier, which could be interpreted as yet another
process of colonialism, in which the old, the historical, is erased and renamed to serve the
new.
The second incident concerns the teacher who elaborates on the importance of place
and the existence of Tangier. A frustrated student argues that “I’ve never seen the
75
damned place […] All I know are the streets and the people. I don’t care what they call it:
Tangier or Tetouan” (Majid 2005, 108). The teacher tries to warn his students about the
possibility of erasing their places by teaching them how to retain the names of places on
the map. The teacher also points out that, if the progeny of post-colonialism are not
aware of their spaces and the names of the places, their towns will be erased from the
map, named and renamed. What is startling in this picture is the way in which the
teacher erases a whole continent from the map. The real map for him consists of the
British Empire and only “tiny dots in the middle of a blank surface” (Majid 2005, 109).
The power of space is significant in this passage. The students do not recognize the
existence of this geography, because their experience of it springs from the place itself.
Whichever name is given to the city of Tangier, it becomes theirs. In other words, the acts
of naming and renaming do not affect the students’ consciousness of the city, and to be
named, for instance, as Granada or Algiers does not make any difference. And yet the
process of naming is as significant for the teacher as it is for the post-colonial subject
because, unless the student consciously realizes that Tangier is a space and a place, the
history will be demolished by the colonial systems. This probably explains why the
teacher leaves the British Empire on the map, since it was the main colonial power during
the 18th and 19th centuries.
But such a method and the teacher’s typology do not hold for the others, especially
when we learn that he is forced to permanently leave his job as a teacher. Neither is this
applicable to Lamin. Lamin comes to know Tangier in its modern phase. The old Tangier
has no existence in the global space because its existence is marked by
deterritorialization. Globalization creates a city that “will vanish into a large sprawling
metropolis, erasing all memory of its beginnings, naked and vulnerable, exposed to a
thousand bureaucratic schemes” (Majid 2005, 89). John Tomlinson explains that
“globalization promotes much more physical mobility than before, but the key to its
cultural impact is the transformation of localities themselves” (1999, 29). In addition,
Tomlinson points out that this act of cultural deterritorialization leads a life that results in
“the various forces of global modernity removing its connection with locality” (1999, 137;
emphasis added). Deterritorialization pinpoints the changes that affect Tangier and, in so
doing, Tangier is transformed from a mere historical place into a global space detached
from its “social and cultural practices” but linked to a more transcultural milieu (Heise
2011, 158).
The reshaping of Tangier from a place into a space suggests new configurations in
the construction of the city of Tangier and of Lamin’s identity. Nasri explains this
transition in two distinctive ways: first, she argues that Lamin’s understanding of Si
Yussef’s historical trajectory means that Lamin’s identity undergoes a process of
dislocation and displacement; and, second, being dissatisfied with the present, he wishes
to “recover lost origins” (2005, 32). At this point Nasri suggests that Lamin might act as
the implied author for Majid himself, because “Lamin clings to the old world and his life
is split in two separate halves: the present, real and unsatisfactory and the past, remote
and unattainable” (2005, 32). Gérard Genette terms this aspect “internal focalization”,
whereby the implied author becomes part of the story that s/he tells through monologues
(cf. Bamberg 2009; Coste and Pier 2009). It is precisely this aspect that pushes the narrator
76
to invoke magical realism in order to emphasize the role of his ancestors in making sense
of his past. This split is clearly indicated when he mentions that
the brutal and unannounced clash of cultures that it engendered, leaving behind it
the fatal trail of homelessness, the feeling of being suspended in a no man’s land
forever, of fighting against self-made demons, and that is why he sounded unlike
himself, too nationalistic […] and besides, Didn’t we stay in Spain for centuries (Majid
2005, 112-3; emphasis original)
In other words, the “clash of cultures” might well suggest the writer’s displacement as a
Moroccan living in the United States of America. The “clash” also refers to El-Andalus as
a territory to be reclaimed as the past of his ancestors. But the “clash” may also refer to
Huntington’s seminal work “The Clash of Civilizations?” in which he forecasts that “the
fundamental source of conflict in this new world” will be primarily religious (1993, 22).
Despite such an exordium, Si Yussef can be said to envisage a new phase in world politics
far from that of the disputed “clash of civilizations”. Both Si Yussef and his interlocutor
want to re-imagine the relations that North Africa can have with the adjacent Europe.
In order to reclaim his past as a Tanjawi, Majid uses different modes of
representation, including magical realism, dialogue between generations and across
cultures, and language itself. The invocation of mythical symbols, like Affarit, hajjouj and
majjouj, and jinn is interpreted by Elkhouche, for instance, as a mode of articulating the
absence of Tangier in Majid’s displacement (2008, np.). The aspect of combining the
magical with the real may also be used to account for uninterest in the past since
globalization has deconstructed all forms of representation. The legacy of colonialism can
easily be traced in modern Tangier, and direct colonialism may no longer be needed in
“the wonderland of high-tech and monetarism and huge sprawling banks and more and
more and more Europeanized and Americanized men and women, edified by progress,
measured by GNPs” (Majid 2005, 81). Language, the novel suggests, becomes a
“nightmare”, and to solve the problem he aims at transforming it, which appears also to
confirm the writer’s displacement.
As a result, Lamin represents a Tangier that no longer exists, because his dislocation
requires him to figure out other modes of belonging. Lamin, through this representation,
wants to belong as he digs in the past of Tangier. But as soon as he realizes that the
Tangier of the past does not exist in the present, he retreats to a new phase of
representation, i.e., narrative itself. Lamin, by the end of the novel, points out that the
Tangier he has left behind, probably when Majid left for America, “was no more” (Majid
2005, 144), which might suggest that Majid’s belonging to Tangier is replaced by his
unbelonging, apart from the memory of Tangier that Si Yussef constructs for him. Not far
from this, the narrative is condensed by the characters’ soliloquy, monologues, and
stream of consciousness. In these remarks, it appears that the narrative is critical of the
way history is approached in the major narrative, especially its linguistic aspect. To
suggest that the narrator is lamenting his belonging to a Tangier that no longer exists is to
propose a certain sense of legitimacy for the history of Si Yussef. Its existence
77
deterritorializes from the periphery to becoming a minor history: a history that overrides
the present and the past through memory in a deterritorialized language.
It should be noted that Lamin’s criticism of how history is represented, especially in
the point that concerns Tangier in the global era, has been central in bringing the concept
to the fore in this discussion. Following this line of argument, it should be clear that
Lamin does not feel at home while he is in Tangier. However, it is hard to state this
directly, since no such incident is represented until the end of the Chapter 4, entitled
“Not Freedom”. At this point, Lamin describes the way in which he sees Tangier as
follows:
I saw Spain, the seductress, whispering a future I hadn’t imagined yet. And to my
right, tall hotels were rising furiously from the ground. The yellow Express raced
on, emitting dire warnings to the children who drift down the hills of Mghougha
and the new sprawling neighbourhoods which seem to spring into existence from
the earth, without building licences. (Majid 2005, 144)
Four elements overlap in this passage: Spain, hotels, the slum, and the express train. The
first indicates that Lamin’s destiny is already determined by his travel, which the train
symbolizes. The determinacy is represented by the speedy train that Lamin chooses for
his journey. Lamin is placed between two adjacent, though contradictory, spaces: one
marked by arbitrariness (a slum) and the other by engagement with the new
globalization (hotels) that widens the gap between the rich and the poor. In the same
way, he chooses not to comment on Si Yussef’s marriage to Lucia and the latter’s faith,
Lamin decides to make his journey “to the dark blue heart of mystery in the westward
horizon” (Majid 2005, 7). To tighten the link with his homeland, he overturns the
narrative in a magical way.
When we learn that magical realism is significant in the post-colonial narrative,
especially that of Latin America through the work of Gabriel García Márquez, it becomes
a necessity to examine the underlying structure of this novel. The author of Si Yussef tries
to weave his identity into this geographical space, the diaspora, and the mythic Moroccan
culture. Majid’s alignment with the Hispanics is clearly delineated in his We Are All
Moors, in the ways they are represented as victimized in the United States. According to
Majid:
Given that minorities presume the existence of a nation united around a common
heritage […] they are like the Moors of old, both indispensable sacrificial bodies
(burnt offerings) and the target of exclusionary policies raging from expulsion to
genocide. (2009, 9)
This parallel assumes a tension between minor and major cultures in the host countries,
and to use magical realism in this context is to make a call for the cultural artifact to fill
the gap left by the notion of scattering. Whereas magical realism is used in the narrative
to interpret this process, the intersection between history and memory in the post-
colonial space of Tangier is filled by the story of the minoritarian, let alone the
78
engagement of the narrative in a diachronic activity. Warnes notes that diachronic
engagement permits the contextualization of the narrative and locating it within its
“social, literary and cultural trajectories” (2009, 18).
Si Yussef’s multilinguality, transculturality, and re-imagining of space can be
claimed to be aspects of magical realism: “[m]agical realism’s greatest claim of usefulness
is that it enables comparison of texts across periods, languages and regions” (Warnes
2009, 18). The reality that Si Yussef desires to deliver is not imaginary in a literal sense,
but in a real one, whose existence can only be constructed by the minoritarians, those in a
state of becoming. It is a call for the minoritarian to “wake up from the dream” and
engage in a discussion of the past, present, and future in an incommensurable way.
Magical realism as a narrative strategy in Si Yussef does not spring from the vacuum but
from a void, and its existence is to fill in that void which scattering leaves in Lamin’s
identity: it is a cultural product. Thus, affiliation with Latin Americans, through magic
realism, can be seen as a new mode of attack on modernity and borders, and this
narrative can be thought of as a product of globalization, a new wave of
deterritorialization.
***
In sum, Si Yussef engages with prominent issues that are in common in post-colonial
societies. As cited by Warnes, these include “the urge to reclaim what has been stolen or
lost, to critique the assumptions and conventions of the metropolis, to recover and affirm
identities and to assert autonomy in the face of hegemony” (2009, 40). It is a way of
critiquing both the colonial and the post-colonial discourse of hegemony.
Consequently, since place is “uttered into being and maintained by narrative”
(Ashcroft 2009, 75), it becomes pivotal in the narrative of Si Yussef for carving out
opportunities to retell the peculiarities of a history that may not (yet) be told. At the same
time, the textuality of place can also render the very term of place as text in itself. Place,
in this view, is “a network of meaning, a production of discourse that may be read”
(Ashcroft 2009, 76) and is thus reconstructed. Si Yussef’s Tangier is a place that is created
anew, reconstructed by a minor narrative and embedded in the collective culture of
Morocco. Because place in the individual understanding is subject to narration in a
collective assemblage of enunciation, Si Yussef, through memory, invents a Tangier that
has been erased from the history of Morocco, enabling at the same time the flow of
memory to enchant an imagined community of Tangawi dwellers. According to Ashcroft,
[s]ystems of speaking and writing, which are operated through memory, invent, rather
than reflect, the reality of place, and spatial discourse enables observers to imagine
their worlds (including its significant places) as stable, reliable, and certain […]
Places are always in the process of being created, always provisional and uncertain
[…] Just like the place may be ‘created, reproduced and defended’ by the colonizer,
it may also be produced and reproduced by the colonized. (Ashcroft 2009, 77;
emphasis added)
79
Furthermore, magical realism suggests that the notion of place can be brought into
existence even after erasure in re-writing modernity. In saying this, the use of stream of
consciousness as a narrative technique, which aligns the novel with magical realism,
suggests different representations of the place. Si Yussef represents different stories of
Tangier from various points of view. It is, however, noteworthy that magical realism in Si
Yussef remains the narrative’s site of memory that aims at preserving minoritarian history
from the margin.
81
4 Gender and Space in North
Africa: House, Rememory,
and Hospitality in Sabiha Al
Khemir’s Waiting in the
Future for the Past to
Come
Waiting in the Future for the Past to Come is a narrative that delves into questions of voice
and belonging and how these operate contrapuntally with reading the past in a third
language. It tells the story of Amina’s return to her village of Kurba (in Tunisia) and the
way in which her mother, Ommzine, celebrates her return home as a recently graduated
doctor of architecture. The narrative is told through Amina’s voice, and the events move
back and forth in time. Amina depends mostly on her mother’s memory to bridge the
past perfect with her own simple past and present. The narrative also describes the ways
in which cultural politics in Tunisia inscribe the notion of the unspeakable on the female
voice. Through the notion of female imprisonment in the house, the novel engages in a
debate that envisions the discourse of nationalism as a means of preventing the post-
colonial female subject from negotiating a sense of her belonging. The narrative uses the
trope of the house as a symbol of the delineation of a longing to belong on the part of
women in the North African context, where in Tunisia patriarchy seems to be the
dominant discourse. Knitting together different stories in different times, the narrative
offers three readings seeking to release the female body from the anxiety induced by the
tyranny of the four walls of the house.
First, since the house is pictured as a site of confinement of the female voice, it is
precisely through the changing of locations, or “paranational” self-exile, that the post-
colonial identity can start the process of negotiation. The second reading rests on the way
the novel presents the notion of rememory. Its deployment is considered a tool that helps
free the North African woman from the pressure of the past, and offers a re-reading of
identity enabling her to live in the present. However, the two readings may not correlate
with the general atmosphere in North Africa, since both the social and the cultural
82
dynamics governing gender relations affect the process of belonging in the region. Third,
the novel suggests that absolute hospitality can be a site of liberation for the North
African woman, and where identities can communicate, re-read the self, and look for
alternative facets of belonging. With all these in mind, Waiting in the Future for the Past to
Come problematizes the notions of identity and belonging, and suggests that writing in
one’s third language can be regarded as a bridge that connects one’s past with the present
in North Africa.
In this chapter, I aim to delve into these questions and the implications that
language, memory, and hospitality have on North African woman in order to understand
the instability of post-colonial identities in a transcultural context. My intention is to
show how the split of identities may not be a factor of dislocation, but the dislocation
forms a part in the process of reconstructing identities. In addition, I intend to argue that,
since the novel represents the female as successfully transcending her imprisonment
through the act of deterritorialization the notion of the house, it aspires to articulate the
sub-merged, unvoiced subjectivities in a third language and in collective enunciation.
However, this progression locates female characters in a liminal space and, to a certain
degree, shows that they are unable to compensate for the split that this process leaves in
their identities. As I will show in my discussion of the novel, it is hospitality that offers a
medium through which the act of deterritorialization can be achieved. Hospitality
suggests a new horizon for questioning the epistemological aspects of the notion of the
house and problematizing the discourse of nationalism and patriarchy. It also offers a
deconstructive approach to free the self and enable the submerged voice to reach a larger
audience. In addition, through a deterritorialized language, North African woman may
be able to designate her space of enunciation, and writing in English is the tool that
permits the existence of this space in the novel.
With the help of Young’s approach (2005) to the experience of the female body and
Attridge’s notion of “creative inventiveness” (2004), this chapter aims to investigate the
notion of the post-colonial house, rememory, and hospitality in relation to the re-
construction of identity in Al Khemir’s narrative. My purpose in this chapter is threefold:
First, I aim to explore the ways in which the act of “travel” and hospitality stimulate the
process of re-reading history. Second, I will investigate the ways in which the notion of
rememory opens up alternative sites for negotiating identity in a post-colonial space, and
show how this process charts opportunities to reconstruct the past from a minoritarian
perspective. Finally, in negotiating the post-colonial space through the notion of
hospitality, I will show that the act of re-reading stimulates a deterritorialized space for
the unspeakable to become widely spoken about.
4.1 NEGOTIATING SPACE IN THE POST-COLONIAL HOUSE
On her address to the 2009 National Book Festival, Al Khemir explains her choice to write
in English by stating that,
I was born in Tunisia, a small country in North African where Arabic is the first
language, French is the second language. French happened to be the second
83
language because Tunisia was colonized by the French. So, when you grow up in
Tunisia, speaking two languages, being bilingual means that the other is part of you.
But for me to meet the other I crossed to Englishness. The English language is really
foreignness. To actually write in one’s third language it means that you are
constantly on the bridge. And on the bridge is really where I would like to be. (2009,
n.p.)
Al Khemir in this passage rejects to be part of the culture of the colonizer and to choose
English, rather than French, in order to write her first novel is to seek a neutral tool
through which she can re-write her past and her identity. Alterity for Al Khemir lies in
Englishness because English offers her the opportunity to be “on the bridge”. If Al
Khemir has “crossed to Englishness” to meet with foreignness, it is because her identity
construction is problematized in that same foreign language.
Al Khemir’s choice of language shows her desire to be “on the bridge” because
French may carry with it the colonial legacy that she wants to prevent in her writing. This
has also been noticeable in her first novel. Both the notion of language and belonging are
problematized in Al Khemir’s Watiting in the Future for the Past to Come. There are three
alignments that estrange subjectivities in relation to identity: the gendered, the cultural,
and the social. This section aims to interconnect these alignments and link them together
with other key elements in the novel in order to broach the issue of speaking the
unspeakable. The body can be a site for expressing the reconstruction of identity, and the
idea of re-turn (a “U-turn” to the imagined community) is projected through memory.
The notion of re-turn highlights two journeys. It can be a return home or the refusal of a
total return while at the same time emphasizing the act of going back to the original
home. The point of such a re-turn is to view the notion of return as a simple journey to
home, while the idea rests in the return to the host home. The effects of living in diaspora
represent the characters as adrift from stability. To identify the self with the minoritarian
and to emphasize the importance of language in this identification exemplifies a
prototype of a subject who can experience alienation at home. Whereas hospitality can
provide a paranational context for re-visiting the elements of ethics in historical
representation, rememory can play a role in this revision. I use “paranational” in the
sense understood by Seyhan, which refers to the deterritorialized communities that exist
“within national borders or alongside the citizens of the host country but remain
culturally or linguistically distanced from them” or “estranged” from the “home” culture
(2001, 10).
As I will show, Waiting in the Future for the Past to Come can be viewed as a site of
communication between the past and its “post” as understood in Bhabha’s sense (1994, 1-
3), and it is through these communicative frameworks that the renewal of life and
existence appears to take place in the novel. In addition, the novel seems to focus on the
personal memories of Amina in dialogue with other women’s personal memories in the
village of Kurba. In her study of Abuzeid’s The Memoir of a Modern Moroccan Woman, Diya
Abdou points out that personal memory in North Africa can be seen not as memory in
itself but as an image of imagined pasts, because “the things mentioned are not memories
but rather just ‘images’ produced in a collage, recorded by a voice” (2009, 16). The
84
similarity between Abdou’s description and Amina’s flashes or “pictures” is consistent
with Amina’s need to realign with the minoritarian in Tunisia and with her engagement
with them in a dialogue out of which their voice may emerge. Consequently, Amina
seems to be aware of the fact that speaking for the minoritarian may only produce what
Spivak terms “epistemic violence”, and yet presenting personal experiences of history
becomes a strategy that help deconstruct the discourse of nationalism.
The novel opens with a description of the street leading to the house where the
main character, Amina, has grown up. As Amina enters the house, the narrative imagines
the house as one of memory, in which events in the past explain contrapuntally the
present histories of the minoritarians. The effect of the house of memory on the identity
of the narrator is revealed in the following passage:
I passed the rooms which occupied the right side of the courtyard, went down the
corridor and opened the big iron gate into what was originally the entrance hall to
this house. I leaned against the huge wooden doors, closed my eyes and took a deep
breath, a breath from the past. Behind these doors, across the road, was the main
bakery of the village. (Al Khemir 1993, 9-10)
On the basis of this passage, it can be argued that the notion of the house in this narrative
is important for an understanding of the flux of identity in a post-colonial context. The
emphasis placed on the “iron gate” and “the huge wooden doors” suggests that the
female subject in Tunisia is mastered by the male connotations of the words. The fact that
Amina closes her eyes may be interpreted as the need to generate new readings of the
elements of the past. To dwell in a house may entail reading the unconscious of the self,
which would compel readers to believe in its importance for an understanding of identity.
In his Poetics of Space, Bachelard points out that the person or reader who is “reading a
room”, writing a room, or reading a house “leaves off reading and starts to think of some
place in his own past” (1958, 14). The act of memory is important for the unconscious.
According to Bachelard, “by recalling these memories, we add to our store of dreams” all
those elements that help in restoring the unconscious in the process of reconstructing
identity (1958, 6). The argument that Bachelard attempts to emphasize resides in the
importance of the house in causing thoughts and memories to live not only in the past
but also in the present and the future as well (1958, 6). Amina’s identity seems to dwell in
the past, and to understand such a past she starts reading it through the elements that
constitute the house.
When Amina makes her journey back home, her memory of the house where she
has resided deprives her of any sense of belonging. For Amina, the house is a liminal
space in which the spatial and temporal edifices of identity and history remain as
indelible residues of the deferred process of rereading and restructuring her identity. The
events that have taken place inside and outside the house are reminiscent of the
deferment of a potential release from oppressive powers. In the house reside those
elements that tempt the reader to construct an ethical reading of identity. For Amina, the
house is the threshold to the memory of oppression. It is a point from which she starts
(re-)membering her past in order to negotiate her identity in the future.
85
At night, a deep feeling emerges, placing Amina’s identity in a perilous position in
this context. This position is critical when she manages to sleep:
The night stretches becoming longer and longer, colder and colder and you lose
sense of yourself, your physical existence, you can’t relate to your body. you are so
wrapped up that your body becomes a mere layer of the whole bandage and your
head is taken over by ideas, it’s so crammed with thoughts, running, spinning, you
can no longer stop them. You can’t run away […] who are you? You probably don’t
recognize yourself because you’re too frightened. It might be that you haven’t met
yourself for a long time. Maybe you have lost all those sensations and associations
which make you feel it’s you. And here you block everything. You freeze. (Al
Khemir 1993, 21)
This moment of silence, which is symbolized in words such as “night”, “colder”, and
“frightened”, pressurizes Amina to read her present identity in relation to the house of
memory. It is by causing her head to be “taken over by ideas” that every possibility of
deterritorializing home is blocked. This passage, located at the very beginning of the
novel, reveals the extent to which Amina is struggling to position her scattered identity
between the past and the present. Her identity seems to be broken up and dispersed, and
her body is fixed and her mind is “crammed with thoughts”. Spending the first night in
the house of memory stimulates stories from the past to be acted out in the present. This
longing for the self is turned into a search for belonging marked by the question “who are
you?” According to Svetlana Boym, the return to the imagined community is understood
as “a way of patching up the gap of alienation, turning intimate longing into belonging”
(2001, 255). Yet Amina does not seem to search for replacing longing with belonging. On
the contrary, the process of integrating the body into a self-reading of identity leaves
Amina in a state of oblivion. She does not feel any sense of belonging to the imagined
community, which ultimately ends in personal deadlock, or as she says: “You freeze”.
Amina is, to borrow from Martin and Mohanty, “not being home”. Martin and Mohanty
remind us that
‘Being home’ refers to the place where one lives within the familiar, safe, protected
boundaries; ‘not being home’ is a matter of realizing that home was an illusion of
coherence and safety based on the exclusion of specific histories of oppression and
resistance. (1988, 196)
Amina’s negotiation of the elements of silence, fear, and stagnation seem to force
her to create two different constructions of house; in other words, house and home
become two different things. Accordingly, a house could function as the material
structure of a phenomenon called home, consisting simply of daily activities and intimate
relations which make a house become home (Gram-Hanssen and Bech-Danielsen 2004,
25). A house, therefore, stands as the materialization of identity. Young holds this view
when she argues for a two-level paradigm in which the notion of house/home may work.
She points out that
86
There are two levels in the process of the materialization of identity in the home: (1)
my belongings are arranged in a space as an extension of my bodily habits and as
support for my routines, and (2) many of the things in the home, as well as the
space itself, carry sedimented personal meaning as retainers of personal narrative.
(2005, 139)
Objects in the house can become sediments of a particular past, and this can only work
prior to the spaces that “the material belongings of my life” inhabit (Young 2005, 139).
Whereas Amina’s house may be interpreted as the “sediment” of her past, it remains
problematic for her identity construction, especially if one notes that, in North African
terms, a house can hardly become a home. Reflecting on the terms dar (house) and Blad
(hometown/home) in colloquial North African Arabic, it would seem to be impossible to
correlate the significance of dar with that of blad (cf. Harrell and Sobelman 1983). The
interaction between the two does not seem to resonate with the meanings that “home”
inhabits in English. Dar signifies an idea, whereas blad signifies a concept. This aspect is
clearly indicated by Young in distinguishing between the idea of “home that reinforce[s]
oppression and domination from a concept of home as an important materialization of
personal, and sometimes group, identity” (2005, 156). Dar is a place to which people go
back after work and which they consider as a shelter, a safe place. Blad is a concept used
by an émigré of North African origin residing in France. It signifies the notion of
homesickness characteristic of diasporic identity.
People can settle everywhere, but they hardly feel at home. When an immigrant of
North African origin journeys back to her/his home country, the answer one could
receive to the question “where are you going?” is “going to blad”. This answer might not
be repeated while at “home” and returning to Europe, for instance. The probable answer
would be “going back”. Where? It might not be specified. Going to blad, and not dar, is
the key issue here, and the connotations of the two terms part company.
Nevertheless, the notion of house may not emancipate Amina from the feeling of
being at home. The epistemology of “being at home” in a house emanates from the
impact of the memories that a house may bear for Amina; because of the past memories,
Amina decides not to stay at “home”. If the notion of house problematizes Amina’s
identity and silences her, it remains for some the source of this construction. This is
exactly what happens in the novel for a character called Al-Hajj, who refuses to be
compensated for his old house with a new apartment in a new location. “Hajj rejected the
new plan, he sat in his café and refused to leave. ‘This is the café of my great-
grandfather,’ he said, ‘I grew up here as a boy and I spent all my life here. Here is my
heart and my life’” (Al Khemir 1993, 264). The refusal to change location is equal to that
of exile. To be exiled is to bring the past into the labyrinth of the present. Here, the house
as home signifies what Avtar Brah terms the network of “significant others”. House, like
home, connotes “various other ‘significant others’. It signifies the social and the psychic
geography of space that is experienced in terms of a neighborhood or a hometown. That
is, a community ‘imagined’” (1996, 4).
87
The house, as also the café for Al-Hajj, is not merely a symbol of the geographical
location in which people used to reside and interact socially and intimately with each
other, or as merely a place to return into the “nostalgic” past. Rather, there are memories
that “engender […] a healing process” that enforce a re-unification of “the subject’s
disparate parts and the subject’s spiritual reconnection” to the house as the
materialization of identity (Greene 2008, 76). Thus, Al-Hajj does not move with the others
to the new location, and “when the wall collapsed, Al-Hajj collapsed too” (Al Khemir
1993, 264).
Accordingly, the house can also be seen as a site for constructing an imagined
community among the female dwellers because, as the narrative tells us:
There was something that weighed heavily in this enclosed world of women. An
absence rather than a presence. There was an intrinsic feeling of something
understood but never spoken of: that everything around me, everything in this
enclosed world had a feminine sex; every object, chair, cup, mat, everything, except
the walls that contained them. (Al Khemir 1993, 117)
What seems overarching in this passage is that the notion of the house predefines the
female identity in North Africa. The “world of women” is already “enclosed” in the
house. The feminine construct bears a monolithic identity that is subjected by
masculinity. “Understood but never spoken of” may suggest that the issue of gender is a
taboo central to the cultural politics of the region. The woman is there, but scarcely
noticed, and her presence indicates her absence. In either case, the possibility of resisting
the materiality of subversion might end in a split identity. In addition, Young explains
such a relationship within the house between man and woman as a return to “nostalgic”
feelings, where he has the power to put the woman in “her place, so that he can return to
the original maternal home” (2005, 129).
In this construction, the house becomes a symbol of oppression and extravagant
patriarchy, and for Ommzine to move to the new flat, is to liberate her self from the
despotism of the past. Meanwhile, oppression may be governed by tradition to the extent
that the notion of house represented in this narrative links two elements in the threshold.
To use reason in order to explain such a trajectory may not work in this constructive
discourse. Amina is unable to understand, for instance, why the door of her family house
is always locked. Nevertheless, she supposes that “there were things that were not done
for one reason or another but simply because they had to be done, just for themselves”
(Al Khemir 1993, 91). Oppression in this regard is viewed in the novel as a tradition in
Tunisia, where women are relegated to the secondary level below men.
Accordingly, the house is not considered as a mere location but it can also be
considered as a locale for its dwelling identities. What is important for the discussion at
hand is the way these identities demonstrate a nuanced search for one’s self: they
enunciate the potential to re-read the identity and point toward a new alternative
interpretation for the past to live in the future. The old house may carry memories that
are characteristic of post-colonial identity, but it can also signify a trauma that the post-
colonial subject needs to redeem if s/he wants to live in the future. The dream of lodging
88
in the new apartments in the new city of Tunis can be one way to cure psychologically
the wounds of the past. Ommzine sees the modern flats as a passage that traverses and
deterritorializes the agonizing memories, and by changing places and locations a new
space can emerge for Ommzine to enjoy her present and future, one in which forgetting
replaces remembrance. Talking with Amina of how proud a woman could be when
moving to the new houses, the mother recounts:
‘Oh daughter’, she said, ‘if only you’d come with me last night and seen what my
eyes witnessed. May every believer have the same’. His mother was so proud, she
was covered with gold. The modern flat was equipped with everything, washing
machine, electric cooker, modern utensils in “aliminom”. Sets of glasses, you know,
everything the eye desires was there. He even brought with him the “raspiratu” for
the carpet. The whole flat is covered with wall-to-wall carpets. (Al Khemir 1993,
220-1)
For the mother, the house is no longer a site for identity re-construction or an emblem of
re-membrance. The notion of house is transformed from being a place of sanctuary into a
space in which to exile identities. The memory of the house connotes a mixed feeling of
nostalgia and the insecurity of old age (Murray 2009, 438). In this regard, home becomes,
for Ommzine, what Murray terms a critique “of pure origins and national identity” (2009,
26). Of course, there is something more to this insistence on relocating the self, but the
common memory stock that the notion of the house bestows upon the narrative is its
credibility in looking for alternative sites for re-membering the self. It can be argued that
the mother’s dream of moving to the new flats is a part of identity formation, because
moving, as Bhabha suggests, is a new way of reading the self (1996, 199), and the new
house can afford this opportunity.
During this subject formation and identity re-construction that the notion of house
offers in this narrative, intimacy seems to interpolate the ongoing process of negotiating
the polarity of home and abroad. When Amina comes back home to Kurba (blad) she
stays in the house (dar). The house validates this sense of what Boym terms “diasporic
intimacy” (2001, 251). Celebrating the return home in the house with the family members
(in the house and the “other house”) does not postulate the feeling of being at home
because “intimacy”, as Boym argues, might bear the weight to “desire most what we fear
most, and the familiar often comes to us to disguise” (2001, 251). The novel describes this
as follows:
I found myself amidst cousins, aunts and other relatives, thrown into the surprising
world of familiarity. Drums were played and old tunes were sung, gradually
awakening a familiar energy that had long been in hibernation. My feet were
carrying me into another world, or were they carrying someone else, a revived
dummy, an image of me, perhaps in a role I had played for years and found no
difficulty in taking again? This was Amina everybody knew and was happy to
know, the energy, with its powerful quality, was somehow unreal. (Al Khemir 1993,
14)
89
This passage projects the feeling of a scattered identity. It shows that the moment the self
desires certain intimacies, it reaches a conclusion that confuses the construction of the
same identity.
As diasporic subject, Amina is disguised by the “dystopic intimacy […] rooted in
the suspicion of single home, in shared longing without belonging” (Boym 2001, 252).
The warmth of hospitality and memories evoked in this passage no longer connects
characters with their roots; on the contrary, they both split the subjectivity in the process
of re/membering. At certain points, Amina silently starts another process of membering
and remembering, and the moment drums are played, it revives in her “an image” of “a
role” that she played many years ago. And yet this role is no longer suited to her, since
the Amina of the past is different from the Amina that has emerged after she makes her
voyage to Britain. This suggests that memories of the house create a palimpsest of stories
that intensify the polarity of identities. The nurturing of characters’ consciousness begins
at home, but at the moment when location is followed with a movement of relocation, the
idea of rereading begins. In order to understand such a process, Homi Bhabha suggests
that the trajectory of a voyage between different locations implies a desire to think over
those ideas, decisions, and interpretations being held in the first place (1996, 200). To
move to a new place is the same as the way , to borrow from Bhabha, that one has to
“unpack” her/his library. The attempt to “unpack” is relevant to the way one reads a
book in a new place, as Benjamin suggests (1982, 59).
In addition, the act of reading remains a forceful medium to give credentials to
Amina’s past. Many events seem to be interrupted, and Amina’s engagement with
history through memory may not redress the ruptures that occur in her narrative of the
past. As Seyhan reminds us, “[o]ur understanding of the present is invariably predicated
on actual or imagined links to, or ruptures from, a recalled past” (2001, 4). Amina’s
notion of re-reading can be seen in the ways in which she begins to re-imagine her past
through sites of memories such as the house. This act of re-reading might not have been
achieved if Amina had stayed at home and had not traveled to Britain. Amina “unpacks”
her identity the moment she arrives in Korba. She believes that a moment of re-reading is
necessary in order to reconstruct female identity in post-colonial Tunisia, and that is
probably the reason why the narrative starts with a description of Amina’s family house.
However, the events that have occurred in the past seem to be interrupted, and in order
to form a new version of history Amina refers to her mother’s past, to Yassmin’s past,
and to the past of the other women inside the house.
It can be argued that the movements the narrator makes between past and present
are not ways merely to retell Amina’s past. Amina seems to be displaced from her origins
spatially and temporally. The feeling of being “lost” may not be replaced the return to the
origin, because both the self and the other within the imagined community experience
processes of transformation. In the part of Amina, her identity is now being reconstituted,
as if she were a host to Tunisia and not a local inhabitant. Amina’s intention not to stay in
Tunisia is nurtured by two main aspects: patriarchy and colonialism.
Subsequently, the house can be regarded as a site of ambivalence that offers
different meanings attached to the past. The memory of the house recalled by Amina
90
confounds her personal collection of stories with collective memory. While her mother’s
account of “house” varies between colonialism and patriarchy, Amina sees it mainly as a
ritual of patriarchy. Many critics relate the notion of house to either patriarchy or
colonialism, or to both. In analyzing Gunesekera’s The Sandglass (1998) and
Arasanyagam’s “Time the Destroyer” (1995), Murray metaphorizes the colonial house as
a “bounded colonial space” embodying capture and containment (2009, 439-40). In a
similar fashion, Young’s approach to the house is based mainly on feminist critics’
reading of the house as a place of imprisonment (2005, 129). Both approaches to the house
are observed in this narrative as means of gendered seclusion. Abdo points out that
“even before independence the situation of North African women was grim. Not only did
the French colonists do nothing to advance the situation of women, they contributed to
their marginalization” (2009, 4; emphasis added).
Furthermore, the colonial past associated with the authoritative memory of the
house represents an aspect of the past that the mother aims to regenerate. Her
remembrance of the brutality of the colonial authority and how they tortured the
members of the resistant groups in their village Kurba, and the way that her husband
communicates with her (authority mixed with perplexity), suggests what La Capra calls a
process of liberation. It can be said that Amina’s mother follows the trajectories that La
Capra explains as follows: to remember and “actively” forget is to allow “for critical
judgment and a reinvestment in life” (2001, 70). Consequently, the remembrance of the
colonial past in the novel is associated with the memory of the husband. In many parts of
the novel, the father, colonialism, and/or resistance are instances in which the past is
brought into the negotiation of the future. The mother, as she knits, relies on memory and
imagination in order to recount how the colonial power brutally punishes her husband as
a member of the Tunisian resistance. In other words, Ommzine seeks to recall her past,
judge it, and forget it, and when the process is complete she can re-member with her
daughter.
However, in the course of remembering, Ommzine seems to be incapable of
forgetting her past, because different elements intertwine: colonialism and patriarchy.
The story retells the past of colonialism in which the French policemen used to arrive in
the middle of the night and take the active members of resistance groups to prison:
‘we were fast asleep, the doors were suddenly pushed wide open. The courtyard
was surrounded by them, French policemen in black […] I burst into tears… ‘Don’t
cry,’ he said as he folded his prayer mat, ‘have faith. Women in Algeria see their
men off with joyful ululation’. (Al Khemir 1993, 105)
This is not typical only of Tunisia, as he ordered the mother to remain silent; the father
uses Algeria as an allegory for reflecting on similar punishments and colonial brutality
elsewhere in the North African region.
In the post-independence era, the image of the father does not change: “your father
sat in the hall for the whole day. He only came in for his prayers and went back
immediately. Every time I spoke to him, he did not answer” (Al Khemir 1993, 50). A
silent father, who hardly talks to his wife apart from giving orders, makes the disparity
91
bigger between the husband and the wife in the same house. Even though the house is
meant to link the elements of the family in the same space, the contrary seems applicable
in the novel. Nowhere in the novel could the emphasis of the power of such a discourse
(of an authoritative father) be better described than when the mother says that “we were
not allowed to come face to face with a strange man at that time” (Al Khemir 1993, 51),
and at this point, Ommzine becomes the witness. The mother’s invocation of memory of
the past does not intend to refute that past by remembering it differently, and thus
forgetting it. Rather, her aim is to forge an understanding of a certain situation that
happened in the past in order to create a “perspective” on that “experience” in the future.
However, since remembering can be seen as “the pathway to liberation” (Woods 2007,
34), it is through memory that the mother aims at gaining a certain level of liberation.
As for her mother, the house, for Amina, is also haunted by patriarchal power that
endorses the indeterminacy of the discourse of silence and gendered discrimination.
Amina’s childhood has been nurtured by silence: “‘Shsh…your father is asleep’ was the
motto” (Al Khemir 1993, 36). In Amina’s memory, the father, the authority of the house,
is “always asleep. The door to the main room was kept constantly closed and only my
mother was allowed in and out” (Al Khemir 1993, 36). Silence is perceived as a
permanent phenomenon and is symbolically associated with the patriarchal house. For
Amina, as for her mother, the father is the man of the house, and to the family member
his existence means silence.
Even though Amina tries to open up new horizons to liberate herself and the
women in the village of Kurba, it seems that silence, which permeates the narrative
structure, prevents her from fulfilling this process. The narrative is told through Amina’s
voice, and the events are seen through her eyes. Silence becomes the main language for
telling the story of the minoritarian in Tunisia, but, as the novel shows us, it is only
through the act of deterritorialization that the woman can break this silence and
“unpack” their female identity again. The dim light, silent, “frightening” nights, and the
narrative of the house are elements that work together in the narrative to indicate the
impossibility for the North African woman to deterritorialize her position if she still lives
in the house of the family. In addition, confining the female body to the house makes the
woman in North Africa revert to her imagination to demarcate the spaces that she wants
to inhabit, and Amina’s wish to see the sea could be one of these examples.
Amina always hopes to see the sea, but as she is unable to do so she has to imagine
it: “I decided to resort to my imaginary pen. Decided? No, it just happened” (Al Khemir
1993, 71). The role of the women in the house is to imagine the space, but she is not
capable of using it. When Amina’s father dies, her uncles become the authorities in the
family house. This can best be described through the structure of Amina’s house within a
house, called “the other house”, as a way of re-defining the shift of positions of the
patriarchy within the same house. “The other house” refers to a segment of the family
house. The house of the family consists of the main house, and within it there is another
house constructed for Amina’s cousins to inhabit. As a result, two families live within the
same house, and the division inside the house signifies the partition of authority between
the two men (Father and Uncle).
92
Consequently, to imagine sometimes brings a feeling of release from the power that
restrains the movements of the body. In such societies as Tunisia, which are ruled by the
uncanny cultural politics of gender, patriarchy has permeated the social strata, resulting
in control of the female body. To keep the woman, to “tame her” in the social system, the
narrative represents the house in a manner that simulates the notion of the Panopticon as
a model of imprisonment. The desire to liberate the woman from patriarchy is confronted
by the authority in the house, whose role is to authorize imagination indirectly as a way
of gaining contact with the outer world:
And inside me, grew a desire for the sea. To see the sea and die, I thought. Our
house was not far from the sea, it was in fact ten minutes away, I was told; but
Uncle Ali surveyed the road to school and back to our house, or so did many eyes
and mouths which reported to him. So what was near felt thousands of miles away.
The forbidden, the unattainable, is always far, however close it is. (Al Khemir 1993,
49)
The metaphor of the sea in women’s writing is important for identity construction. As
opposed to the soil, the sea or the ocean is not stable but can be viewed as a location of
change, and it is this sense of change that humankind cannot control. For Amina the sea
designates the moment when she can liberate herself, re-construct her identity, and gain
masculine power. It can be viewed as the moment when she renews her thought, and
“unpacks” her identity again. According to Julia Kristeva, the word “sea” is a construct
that connotes an emblem of freedom that may be “larger than the first object of desire”
(2010, n.p.). Kristeva adds: “The word ‘sea’ (mer) is larger than water or larger than
mommy (maman)” (2010, np.; emphasis added). But “[t]o see the sea and die” may
involve a certain sense of risk. In terms of space, Amina, as a child, is aware that she is
unable to use all the space she has; she is unable to surpass the bounded geographical
space that is given to her. That is, to quote Young, “[t]he space, that is physically
available to the feminine body, is frequently of greater radius than the space that she uses
and inhabits” (2005, 40). The notion of the sea can be one possibility for women in North
Africa to deterritorialize themselves. Whereas the passage constructs gender relations
between men and women and points to the disparity that exists in this construction of
binaries in the house, it also suggests that there are at least some possibilities for women
to liberate themselves. But the passage also suggests that, unless women can configure
such possibilities, the case will be the following: it points to the torturing of the body if
the woman does not confine herself to the space demarcated for her.
Pointing out the presence of such encounters in the past, the narrator represents the
female body as an apparatus for resistance, and the breaking of silence anticipates a
certain sense of violence. Such an incident is described at length in the following passage:
He sat down on the chair. We stood up opposite him and silence reigned. Black
coffee with no sugar had been prepared by my eldest sister [...] I stole a look at my
uncle’s face. There was not a single disturbance. There are men who are just human
beings and there are men who are like monuments. Uncle Ali was a monument […]
93
we waited. He took a sip of his coffee and put it down, placed his cigarette in his
mouth and took a puff [...] And full came the slap on my face, making me go dizzy,
and for a second, I thought I was going to land on the other side of the wall. (Al
Khemir 1993, 127-130)
This detailed description of the incident not only points to the disparity of physical
existence and the use of space between the “master” of the house and the female
dwellers, but it also maps the encounter and its side effects on the female body when
breaking the “law of space”. The motto “the man is the center and the woman is the
margin” is the argument maintained by Young. In societies predefined by a patriarchy
endorsed by tradition, the woman is conceptualized as the other: “the inessential
correlate to man” (2005, 31). She is, as Young suggests,
both culturally and socially denied the subjectivity, autonomy, and creativity that
are definitive of being human and that in patriarchal society are accorded the man
[…] The female person who enacts the existence of women in patriarchal society
must therefore live a contradiction: as human she is a free subject who participates
in transcendence, but her situation as a woman denies her that subjectivity and
transcendence. (2005, 31-2)
In addition, we may apply Mills’s view of the spatial relations that guide colonial
subjectivity in order to explain relations in a post-colonial context such as Tunisia. Mills
points out that forms of subjectivity “are closely linked with the forms of spatiality and
movement/restriction which developed in colonial societies” (2005, 44). Such modes have
also been developed in post-colonial societies. Amina’s uncles want to control her
movement through demarcating her space, and, by so doing, they aim to develop an
identity for her, the construction of which she refuses. To redress this situation, to
reconstruct and represent female identity, Marie-Laure Sauty de Chalon, in an interview
in the International Herald Tribune, suggests “that women need to talk and that is the same
everywhere in the world” (2010, 14).
By allowing the feelings of the past to flow into present encounters, Amina is able to
see and discover the imagined space of the sea through travel. Her voyage to continue
her studies in Tunis imbues her identity with the power to transcend the polarity of
gender, and leads her to realize that the sea has a voice. It becomes a surprise for her to
compare her dreams with reality (even though reality could be mere interpretations as
she sees it): “The sea spoke. It uttered different sounds, the waves, the movements […] all
that, I had not taken into account. It spoke in a language I responded to though I did not
understand” (Al Khemir 1993, 215). That distance from the house releases her from
patriarchal authority. The body now has to express inherent sedimentation, using its
unique language. The “sound” of the sea suggests the potential homogeneity that a
female identity would inhabit if she were released from spatial boundaries. The changing
waves of the sea give Amina the sense of power that she lacks to reconstruct her identity
(cf. Cora Kaplan 1986). Furthermore, the passage suggests that Amina’s identity is in the
process of reconstruction, and that the conventions of the patriarchal family are no longer
94
working. Consequently, Amina seeks to liberate herself by contesting the pre-existing
spatial relation in a post-colonial milieu.
To say that Amina responds to the voice of the sea is to suggest that she feels the
ability to move freely in the spaces available to her, and that the move from Kurba to
Tunis provides her with the feeling of belonging to what Seyhan terms the
“paranational” community (2001, 10). The moment Amina sees the sea she starts the
process of re-reading, which drives her to make her first “voyage” and subverts the
male/female praxis. The changing nature of the sea gives the woman the hope and
promise that her identity will be redefined in a new language, the language of change
(Kaplan 1986, 71). Her first voyage, therefore, becomes her first step toward a
transcultural belonging where the post-colonial subject demarcates the notion of home as
a new space of becoming. It is the new language that enables Amina to gain her freedom
from the memory of the past. When the narrative recounts Amina’s journey to the sea, it
presents her as a post-colonial subject looking for a counter-discourse to patriarchy. She
does not go alone to the sea, nor with her roommates, but it is Antoine who surprises her
with the idea of the trip. The narrative does not suggest a total rejection of the past if the
characters want to live up the future. Besides, how can a woman liberate herself from the
notion of an oppressive past? What role does memory play in this context? Can
rememory be considered a possibility for the notion of the “becoming” to take place?
4.2 REMEMORY: LIBERATING THE NORTH AFRICAN WOMAN
In the previous section, I have demonstrated that the house represents a liminal hybridity
that links the past to the present and subject to object, providing the narrative with a new
route to the re-membering of identities. As I will show in this section, the house becomes
a symbolic reference to those conscious structures on two levels: On the first level, the
notion of the house undermines the process of identity construction, while on the second
level it indicates a process of reuniting the memory of the house with the act of
remembering (Amina and her mother). On both levels, rememory emerges as a
contrapuntal regeneration of the self from its other. This dual process of reconfiguration
installs the discursive device so that it can liberate the past and restore it for the needs of
the future. In this respect, the notion of the “beyond” that Bhabha advocates in his
“Introduction” to The Location of Culture, at least to a certain degree, fits into the
discursive strategy of the novel. The fusion of the past with the present in this narrative
provides an essential basis for the present to function, not as a break with the past but, as
a “beyond”, a liminal hybridity that bridges multiple temporalities. As Bhabha indicates,
[t]he present can no longer be simply envisaged as a break or a bonding with the
past and the future, no longer a synchronic presence: our proximate self-presence,
our public image, comes to be revealed for its discontinuities, its inequalities, its
minorities. (1994, 4)
The reunification of temporalities from the geophysical space of the family house is a
succinct feature that inextricably binds subject to object. Dwelling in this intervening
95
space of the house expresses the notion of being “part of a revisionary time, a return to
the present to redescribe our cultural contemporaneity […] to touch the future on its hither
side” (1994, 7; emphasis original). The formation of this epistemological principle brings,
again, to the surface progressive elements of the house of memory in terms of the
language of diaspora. This is so because, according to Bhabha, “the encounter with
‘newness’” (1994, 7) and the process of renewing the past are mere contingent layers of
the temporality that emerges from the notion of the “beyond”: to “turn the present into
the ‘post’” (1994, 18). “Beyond”, however, does not connote merely this temporal
symbiosis. Rather, it also describes how life in the margins happens to be a remnant of
the bodies living in-between.
Rememory, as I will show, brings the individual’s past into the present. It is a
painstaking choice that invites the subject to revise her/his past identities in order to live,
and make sense of, the future. The painstaking element involved in the process of
rememory resides in its power either to allow identities in the past to live in the future or
simply to neglect those identities for a new (rather than renewed) identity construction.
The term has been coined by Toni Morrison and it is explained through the character of
Sethe in the novel Beloved (1988). In addressing Denver, Sethe explains that rememory is
the moment when the subject is incapable of escaping the past. In other words, rememory
remains the remembrance of memory itself, and if, for instance,
a house burns down, it’s gone, but the place – the picture of it – stays, and not just in
my rememory, but out there, in the world. What I remember is a picture floating
around there outside my head. I mean, even if I don’t think about it, even if I die,
the picture of what I did, or knew, or saw is still out there. (1988, 36)
Rememory functions in a way that adds to remembrance the aspect of bringing memory
into the present through imagination, as it is only imagination that grants access to the
“unwritten interior life” of its people (Morrison 1987, 111). Consequently, rememory
concerns the past, the present, and the future, and also the way in which identities can
forge new possibilities for living. Rememory is not only a question of remembrance of the
past but also a question of re-membering selves, identities, and memories of the past in
the present. The interaction of these elements shifts the emphasis from being a single
action of memory onto a web of interactive facets, including memory and re-membering.
In the novel, revisiting memory functions at two levels: re-membering and
dismembering. Amina’s memory of the house equals the process of bringing her past into
the present discussion. This process would not have been achieved if Amina had not
traveled abroad. It can be argued that Amina’s travel to Britain provides her with the
mechanism to “unpack” her identity and the ability to revisit her past, which she sees as
preventing the Tunisian woman from achieving freedom: travel in this sense predates the
notion of revisiting the past (memory).
Furthermore, the “re-meeting” between Amina and her mother reveals Amina’s
bifurcation as a memento of the split that a diasporic identity undergoes. It also forges the
consciousness of a dual process that is taking place: memory and dis-membering.
Memory is described through the novel’s opening: when Amina arrives at her home-
96
town of Kurba, she realizes that her journey is a mere remembrance of a memory, that
Svetlana Boym explains as a process “that no longer has a single anchor in the native city
but unfolds through superimposition of native and foreign land” (2001, 258). Dis-
membering functions in the novel in the impossibility of Amina’s mother rejoining her
daughter.
Although the mother uses Amina as a trace of her past, the process of re-membering
that she needs seems to specify a disunification of both characters. Knitting the strand
while remembering and recounting past stories to Amina, the mother aims at a trace
through which she might be able to deterritorialize her past. The knitting does not seem
to be completed since the aim behind each thread is to re-read memory. Through her
memory, the mother is able to retell her past to Amina, and through this act she seeks to
liberate herself from the authority that oppresses her and to re-member with her
daughter.
In the course of recognizing the need to re-integrate the past, the mother seeks a
total re-membering with her daughter Amina. Thus, the mother’s dream prevails: to re-
member with her daughter: “Now I’ve got you. I’ll start a new life with you. I am
waiting” (Al Khemir 1993, 53). Waiting for the moment “to start a new life” almost
suggests that the things of the past need to remain in the past, as long as they are
discussed in the future. To say this may explain, for instance, that the novel’s title
indicates the impossibility of recalling the past in the future and that it is better not to
wait for the past to arrive in the future. To start a new life might suggest that the present
should remain an aspect of what Bhabha terms the “beyond”, a link between past and
future. The same implication is constantly repeated by the mother in the novel (Al
Khemir 1993, 35; 42; 225; 243): in other words, the future of the mother is replicated
through her re-embodiment with her daughter, and the past is re-created to release the
self from its imprisonment. For the mother, the future is an inextricable knot that
connects her past in the present. She is then said to be “waiting in the future for the past
to come”. In this vein, the mother desires to successfully achieve at least a part of her
rememory, which Greene terms “re-membering” (2008, 79).
The relation that the mother aims to construct through the notion of rememory
suggests that the mother and her daughter aim to speak with a collective voice. However,
rememory seems to fail to thrive in this novel on the first level, because one part of the
process of rememory does not consistently fit into the process of identity reconstruction.
While the mother is using her memory and imagination to re-member with her daughter,
Amina seems to use different temporalities (past perfect, simple past, and future) in order
to re-read her identity, to dis-remember, and therefore she reconstructs the past in an
alternative fashion.
Amina does not seem to be imprisoned in the past as her mother is, but her
articulation of the past means a re-reading of identity and not merely a jettisoning of that
past. It is the notion of selective memory that Amina uses in “uncovering” the past and
reading identity in the future. Thus, the novel does not imagine the past as a mere
instance of memory. Instead, it demonstrates various potential aspects so that the act of
rememory can succeed. These aspects include the notion that subjectivities need to
97
experience a successive process of the “unpacking” identities, which can only be achieved
through constant relocation and dislocation (1996, 200).
It should be noted that the use of rememory as a mechanism for releasing woman
from the notion of imprisonment may suggest that hospitality can function in this
narrative as a way of criticizing the absolutism of the discourse of patriarchy monitored
in the house. Its use as a narrative device gives a voice to the female and releases her
body. It perpetuates the notion of deterritorialization characteristic of minority literature,
as understood in the sense presented by Deleuze and Guatarri. Becoming heard presumes
a certain authority over voice in this narrative. As Amina notes, “It doesn’t matter what
language does the world speak, a scream is a scream is a scream” (Al Khemir 1993, 22).
In Derrida’s sense, hospitality is both an ethic and a cultural construct. As an ethic,
hospitality releases itself from its conditioning structures. Hospitality is regarded as “the
principle of ethics” (Derrida 2000, 50), and as such it can be seen as an interruption of the
self. According to Westmoreland, hospitality as an interruption to the self brings the self
and the other into question (2008, 7-9). Through the notion of hospitality, the act of
creating the other at the threshold illustrates an experience of confrontation between the
host and the guest. On this level, the act of hospitality is perceived as the possibility of
dismantling the notion of the house presented in the novel, in the way (absolute)
hospitality dwells in-between unconditional and conditional hospitality. Attridge points
out that, during the course of action of creating the other as an effect of hospitality, the
self could “be said to be a creation of the other” (2004, 24).
If rememory provides Amina with the mechanism to revisit her past, the notion of
hospitality can be said to be a chasm that enables Amina to monitor her identity
construction. To do this, it can be noted that hospitality is manifested in this novel on two
multifaceted levels: the conditional (factored by transnational travel) and the
unconditional (factored by foreignness). At the conditional level, the journey that Amina
makes from her village Kurba to Tunis inspires her to consider new possibilities of
contesting the predefined identity of her childhood. This national journey stimulates her
to transgress the notion of national oppression and starts a process of transformation and
reformation that will take place on a transnational level. The journey to England is a vivid
experience that stems from the need to explore one’s identity outside the nation. It
postulates the process of being on the outside that imbues identity with the feeling of
liminality, and the “creation of the other”. In such circumstances, Homi Bhabha reminds
us that
the borderline work of culture demands an encounter with ‘newness’ that is not
part of the continuum of past and present. It creates a sense of the new as an
insurgent act of cultural translation. Such art does not merely recall the past as
social cause or aesthetic precedent; it renews that past, refiguring it as a contingent
‘in-between’ space, that innovates and interrupts the performance of the present.
The ‘past-present’ becomes part of the necessity, not the nostalgia, of living. (1994,
7)
98
Amina becomes a liminal hybrid subject because of transnationalism and foreignness.
Her first encounter with the culture of the borderline remains a significant reference to
her identity at home. Her role in a paranational community instigates a feeling of being in
a space of in-betweenness that “interrupts the performance” of her actual Being. It is the
experience of being hosted in the other’s home that promises a considerable alignment
between the transnational and paranational embodiment of displaced subjects standing
as the mediator between the two societies.
Subsequently, displacement cannot be singled out from this process, because this
aspect has already been incorporated in the stories and histories of orphaned people,
marginalized minorities, and disconcerted groups. According to Caren Kaplan, “The
prevalence of metaphors of travel” characterized in estrangement and displacement is the
marker of the contemporary world, although “displacement is not universally available
or desirable for many subjects, nor is it evenly experienced” (1996, 1). For Amina
displacement is not considered as a mere action. Many elements have contributed to the
act of travel that Amina initiates. First, as a post-colonial country, Tunisia experiences a
process of transformation and reconstruction of national identity. In several passages,
Omzzine notes that Tunisia in the past is not Tunisia in its present manifestation.
Previously, she says, “we were not allowed to come face to face with a strange man at
that time. Nowadays, women go out everywhere” (Al Khemir 1993, 51). Second,
education has also been a central concern of successive governments, and to study at
university level, one has to travel to the main cities. Third, there is Amina’s educational
ingenuity in being, as her roommates note, “the best student in the whole of the country,
the one who came first in the whole of the country in the Baccalaureate exams” (Al
Khemir 1993, 156). The fourth element that inspires this travel is linked with Amina’s
position in Tunisian society. She is the daughter of a “martyr”, Saleh Ben ‘Abd Slam, who
fought against the colonial regime in order for Tunisia to become an independent nation
(Al Khemir 1993, 2). These elements work actively together to help Amina re-create her
space in new places.
The first time Amina arrives at the École Normale Supérieure, she has the feeling of
being a “guest in a house”. The emblem of foreignness alienates Amina and deprives her
of her own singularity. Alone in room 346, questions start to flow from her unconscious
considering the essence of her being “at home” while the host is away: “what do I do? Start
to unpack my luggage? What if they come while I am in the middle of all this?” (Al
Khemir 1993, 152). Her feeling of insecurity, of breaking what Derrida calls the “law of
hospitality”, the conditioned practice that “governs the general concept of hospitality”
(2000, 25), is haunting. The feeling of such restriction delays Amina’s process of
unpacking her identity; and she postpones it to a later stage: “I’ll wait. I’ll go out and not
come back” (Al Khemir 1993, 152).
The symbolic construction of both host and guest in this novel is important in the
way in which both parts representing the act of hospitality are significantly transformed.
They are symbols because neither part owns the house, since all are hosted for
educational purposes. In the meantime, hospitality takes place in that the old resident has
to welcome the new and the law of hospitality has to be implemented.
99
The first encounter between the guest (Amina) and the host (her roommates)
represents the first encounter between the self and her other. Amina recognizes this
aspect when she is surrounded by the other dwellers: “Never had my body felt so small”,
until the time comes for her to be hosted in a different house (Al Khemir 1993, 155).
Accordingly, Attridge explains this by stating that in such circumstances the self
“encounters the limits” of her “own powers to think and to judge, her capacities as a
rational agent” (2004, 33; emphasis added). Amina faces, as a consequence of conditional
hospitality, a series of questions from her roommates. This makes Amina’s body shrink,
as her capacity to judge has been put into question. The ethics of hospitality are
impossible in such a situation, since the act of questioning defers any process of intimacy,
but the act of reading self qua the other takes place. This deferment transforms into a
powerful means for the guest to become a host, and Amina is no longer that other who
comes to interfere with the intimacies of the girls. Amina’s unconditional hospitality, in a
change of roles, makes her become what she calls “a secret box” for the girls. The space in
between is filled with something that neither part could openly talk about:
This was the place where I was to spend four years […] it did not take too long
before we became friends…they liked me for reasons they could not understand,
perhaps like a forgotten part of themselves. I soon became the center of complicity
for every one of them, a secret box, or rather a box of secrets. (Al Khemir 1993, 156-
7)
The girls enjoy Amina’s company because of the ethical principles of her hospitality. She
does not invalidate their identities. Rather, she helps them develop a sense of its
meaning. Intimacy does not come on their own initiative, but it is imposed on them. The
imposition of intimacy fosters an exchange of roles between the host and the guest: the
guest becomes the host and the host becomes the guest, and the functional utility of each
part is defined.
Conditional hospitality in this respect, becomes absolute, as described by Derrida:
the hôte who receives (the host), the one who welcomes the invited or received the
hôte (the guest), the welcoming hôte who considers himself the owner of the place, is
in truth a hôte received in his own home. He receives the hospitality that he offers in
his own home; he receives it from his own home—which, in the end does not belong
to him. The hôte as host is a guest. (1999, 41-2; emphasis original)
Transformation of the self is processed from within its structure of power. The girls come
to enter their house, to recognize their selves through Amina, the guest, the outsider. This
is, according to Derrida, an exchange of roles in which “the guest, the invited hostage,
becomes the one who invites the one who invites” (2000, 125).
In order for these shifts in roles to take place, Amina integrates the roles played by
ethics into hospitality. The girls do not understand why they like Amina, but, as Amina
notes, she represents a “forgotten part of themselves”. She is such a good listener that she
is a “secret box” for them. Listening, here, is not understood in its literal sense. It
100
correlates with what Attridge calls “creative reading”. Reading/listening is an activity
and a process at the same time: it is “an attempt to respond to the otherness” (2004, 79).
Amina does not find the girls good readers/listeners. This pact impels Amina to create
other strategies in order to respond creatively to her otherness. Amina does not stay with
her roommates, but she manages to live on her own: “The following year, my room-
mates were surprised and unexpectedly disappointed when I moved elsewhere” (Al
Khemir 1993, 157). She lives in the dormitory. Amina’s decision to live in the dormitory
alone might be interpreted as a process of transition where identity moves from being
static to more flexible where multiplicity is significant for the reformation of that identity.
This is one of the first steps that Amina takes to revisit and re-construct her identity in a
transcultural way.
“Creative inventiveness” resides in performing the past in order to discuss it in the
future. Through the act of performing and performances, Amina instigates a dual
paradigmatic re-constructive self: to re-read minority pasts and to reconstruct future
identity. At this point, it could be meaningful to assume that “the notions of performance
and the performative construction of identity” permit subjectivity to reconstruct identity
in conjunction with the “preexisting cultural scripts and [by] performing them” (Nyman
2009, 97; cf. Butler 1993). Amina’s script is contingent on her recalling of memory, and the
act of performing those events manifests a subconscious process of finding a good
listener to help deconstruct the past of the minoritarian. Amina does not invoke her past
through rememory but it is through performances that she can feel a sense of freedom,
and her body is released from the haunting memory of her past. There seems to be a need
to speak, and to perform, notes Cora Kaplan, so as to present women “with such a
profound split between their social, sexual identity (their ‘human’ identity) and their
artistic practice that the split becomes the insistent subject, sometimes overt, often hidden
or displaced” (1986, 71) of much of their performances.
There seems to be a need for Amina to construct her femininity through
performances, which, to some extent, are not separable from what Nyman calls, the
“preexisting cultural” construction of gender. The past haunts Amina, and in order to
refine that past, she performs it. Her past is acted out before an audience of university
students. At this moment it seems that Amina’s body is haunted by her agonizing
memories and in needing to represent the split in her identity she seeks to perform her
past. This aspect can be understood from the following passage:
This tiny body was haunted as far as they were concerned, though they did not
bring this realization all the way out. This body was inhabited by all sorts of people,
ancient, old and young and by all sorts of beasts, creeping, crawling, flying,
swimming beasts […] And after every performance, my roommates gave me the
space they would give to a considerable number of people. (Al Khemir 1993, 161)
After each performance, Amina’s body seems to be relieved; her identity is in the process
of re-construction: “I felt a sense of relief mixed with perplexity. My body felt lighter and
my mind was perplexed at the show it had witnessed. The lightness of my body often
helped me carry on with life for several weeks” (Al Khemir 1993, 161). Similarly, Amina
101
wants to perform her memories so as to find a good listener for her, and the
minoritarian’s, stories. She aims to tell them to the world. University students are a
significant audience at this stage. They can watch performances with critical eyes and, at
the same time, their reading becomes a re-reading of their own personalities.
One could compare Amina when she first enters the university with her identity
after she arrives home: the difference lies in the sense of freedom that she creates for
herself. The space between Amina, her audience, and her friends becomes a space of
shared intimacies; however, it is left unexplored. Neither part wants to explore that
space, because what matters for Amina is that she makes the world inside her familiar to
those around her: “my room-mates grew familiar with the world within and started
feeling frightened of becoming haunted themselves” (Al Khemir 1993, 163). There seems
to be a sense of contamination in a part of her memory. Amina’s memory is not an
individual aspect of her subjectivity; rather, it is the notion of cultural memory that seems
to overwhelm every female identity in North Africa. The audience is composed of
females and males, but only the females are able to interpret Amina’s past in performing
those memories.
Another action helping Amina’s reading of space and time is the notion of
unconditional hospitality. In order to foster a manifest revision of the Tunisian past,
Amina engages in a relationship with Antoine. The novel does not provide any detail
concerning this character, apart from the fact that his name suggests that he is a French
settler in Tunisia. Antoine comes to know Amina on a rainy Sunday when she goes for a
walk. Enchanted by the weather, she is “taken into a whirl […] an abyss of mud
swallowed” her (Al Khemir 1993, 165). Antoine arrives to rescue her, and this is the
second meeting between the two. Amina is a guest for the second time, and Antoine is
the host. At his home, Amina experiences unconditional hospitality, and it is there that
she feels at home while away. Hospitality can be understood from the following passage:
I got up. Antoine brought breakfast and we ate. We talked about the weather, about
the rain, about my walks. We talked and talked. It was late afternoon when I said
that it was high time to go. He nodded, disappeared into the kitchen and came back
with some tangerines. ‘Take these with you,’ he said, ‘the food must be pretty
miserable in that university canteen of yours. (Al Khemir 1993, 168)
This incident suggests that Tunisia is undergoing a process of transformation, and to
welcome a Tunisian girl in the house of a foreigner can be seen as an impossible gesture
in post-independence Tunisia. This transformation may also suggest that Amina’s
identity undergoes this transformation specifically through the ways in which she
interprets things, and that the split between her sexual and social identities is at work.
Antoine’s unconditional hospitality helps blur the line between the native and the
foreigner or the host and the guest. Derrida reminds us that unconditional hospitality
“requires that I open up my home and that I give not only to the foreigner, but to the
absolute, unknown, anonymous other, and that I give place to them, that I let them come,
that I let them arrive, and take place in the place” (2000, 25). The experience of
unconditional hospitality fosters a sentiment of security that Amina misses while she is at
102
home in Kurba. Amina’s identification with Antoine has more than one implication. It is
a call for an objective approach in narrating the colonial past, in which both the colonizer
and the colonized should be engaged in knitting the threads and fathoming the rupture
in the history of North Africa. An example is provided by Antoine’s invitation to show
Amina around the old town. Ironically, Antoine, a foreigner representing the colonial
regime, knows most of the parts of the old town; however, the history of the places is not
configured as part of his identity. His existence in Tunisia can only be seen from the
position of being a foreigner or a guest in Tunisia. His knowledge of places helps Amina
to realize that those places are sites of memory that contribute to the re-writing of the
history of Tunisia. For instance, the Café That al-Sur “was particularly active in the 1930s
and 40s, where writers, poets, singers and all sorts of artists, many of them involved in
the political movement against the French” (Al Khemir 1993, 249).
Hospitality in this novel can be considered as a way of fixing the ruptures of the
past in order to live in the present, thus reintegrating its elements for future generations.
These sites of memory are invoked as subversive of the history that is provided officially:
“‘I knew the story,’ I said, ‘but I’ve never seen Bab Swiqa before’. He laughed and added,
‘And I knew the place but never knew the story. Now we both know the place and we
both know the story!” (Al Khemir 1993, 250). The passage also suggests a counter-version
to history. It is a paradigm that unpacks the different points of view of the hidden sites of
history, wherein all participate in this medium: male, female, host and guest, and so on.
The unconditional hospitality predicts a nexus for the historical sites of resistance. This
temporal oscillation triggered by the notion of place articulates the frequent absence of
these places from history, and presents a model for releasing this blockage so that the
past can be seen as unbiased.
Nevertheless, moving between the two forms of hospitality, unconditional and
conditional, does not seem to link the notion of memory with the image that the novel
aims to visualize for an alternative past in the present. On the one hand, it is through
conditional hospitality that Amina encounters the reconfiguration of her identity. On the
other hand, the unconditional hospitality provides Amina with the medium to represent
her past, to negotiate the past, and to figure the ruptures as possibilities for rerouting
history. It is between these two forms of hospitality that this minority literature aims at
an absolute deterritorialization in order to enunciate the stories to the world. Because of
her first journey from Kurba to Tunis, Amina experiences a series of interruptions in her
identity. As a guest in two different actions, Amina engages in the act of retelling the
history inscribed in the notion of unconditional hospitality. She also carries the burden of
liberating her imprisoned body, inspired by conditional hospitality and creative
performance. In other words, the conjunction of the two processes and the oscillation
between mind and body in time and place offer liberation from the female imprisonment.
At this specific point, Amina bears the agonies of her mother, sisters, female friends and
all those shadowy corners of the unvoiced, and her aim is to tell the world their story.
103
4.3 RE-DEFINING THE POST-COLONIAL FEMALE SPACE
Oppression stemming from the notion of house in Tunisia pervades every aspect of
Amina’s life. Her struggle to liberate herself through memory and hospitality can be seen
as a metaphor that helps construct the process of liberating the past from tradition:
because “the past, in the form of tradition, acts as an obstacle” to the subject (Woods 2007,
121). This realization correlates with Amina’s intention of telling her mother’s story to the
world. In addition, what the present narrative aims to refute is the role of the idea of
nationalism in perpetuating patriarchal discourse in North Africa. Rememory, memory,
and hospitality are processes of continuity and interruption, of destruction and
reconstruction, and consequently, Amina succeeds on both levels of liberation resulting
in a re-reading of her identity and herself from the trauma of memory. The fluid, hybrid
conjunction of temporalities (past-present) that the narrative invokes sustains the
possibility of an interminable future, reconstructed metaphorically in the marginal space
beyond the house. Success does not take place inside; it originates from the outside (the
house), enabling subjectivities to work out new strategies for liberation.
Since the feeling of liberation is sustained, Amina travels to Britain to study. She has
been overwhelmed by Antoine’s hospitality, released, partially, from the haunting
memories of the house to begin a first reading of identity. However, a total re-reading of
Amina’s self can only be resonated with her re-turn to Kurba, a place where she manages
not to stay. The notion of re-turn is twofold in this narrative: first, it embodies a refusal to
reunite with her mother; second, it seems to tell the world the story of the marginalized.
This rapprochement suggests that the split Amina experiences by the end of the novel is
not an effect of diaspora. Rather, Amina acknowledges that the choice between home and
away is agonizing, placing her own identity in a state of undecidability. She notices that
and says: “As though I were here but over there and as though I were there but over
here” (Al Khemir 1993, 269). This split originates from Amina’s refusal to identify with
her mother, i.e., her nation. In addition, her decision to practise disidentification
crystallizes her engagement in the urgency of voicing the oppressed subjectivities to the
world. The subject of enunciation may not be stated directly in the novel. It is not merely
a question of a voyage out and a return; rather, it is about a collective struggle against
oppressive powers manifested indirectly in the concept of the house.
To speak out, to communicate with the world, the novel uses English as its means of
communication. In this context we can recall Deleuze and Guattari’s notion of minority
literature, in which they note that the individual speaks in a collective voice, and not for
her/himself. A minor literature constructs the notion of solidarity among the members of
a minority group (in this case Tunisian women). To say so, deterritorialization affects the
nation from within its structure of power, leading it “to express another possible
community and to forge the means for another consciousness and another sensibility”
(Deleuze and Guattari 1986, 17). This narrative does not speak for itself even though it
emphasizes the singularity of its character, Amina. However, the narrative technique
seems to problematize the notion of voice itself. The only voice that we encounter is
Amina’s, and the main points of view are represented through her voice. In addition,
there is an inclination toward victimizing woman’s voice in North Africa and this
104
tendency is conveyed by Amina as the only narrator voice. The notion of voice becomes
even more problematic when we come to understand that Amina’s voice is not merely
her own, but one that functions in a collective way. There are, as Deleuze and Guattari
note, “only collective assemblages of enunciation” (1986, 18). In saying this, the narrator
provides certain solutions to override such impossibilities.
Amina’s mother, for example, has “walked out of her clothes” and it is time for the
others (females in Tunisia) to follow a similar path and “walk out of their skins” (Al
Khemir, 21). It seems to be an impossibility for Amina to “carry on living” in her body:
her “heart feels desperate to get out of its rib-cage and scream” (Al Khemir 1993, 21). This
impossibility illustrates one of the three impossibilities facing minority literature: the
impossibility of articulation. However, since English is pivotal to this narrative, Amina
has promised her mother to tell her story to the world (Al Khemir 1993, 21). It is not a
single story, but a meaning of collective enunciation, where participants form the core of
the marginalized female subjectivities (mother, Yassmina, and others). Articulation does
not need a specific language for a shared understanding since, for minorities, it is easy to
decipher a narrative of this kind among themselves: “it doesn’t matter” what language
the world speaks, as Amina confesses to her mother: “a scream is a scream is a scream”
(Al Khemir 1993, 22). Amina emerges, to use her own words, from “darkness into a
strange world” (Al Khemir 1993, 23), a world that has inspired her to tell her stories in a
collective manner. The aspects erased from history, given the impossibility of re-writing
ever restoring the memory of its people, have been replaced by a collective version of
memory. The oscillation of temporalities imposes a different interpretation of events that
ultimately affects the ideology of the interpreter. The narrative of history, the use of
memory, sites of memory, and the notion of rememory may not be able to resolve the
ruptures found in history itself. However, marginal elaboration – narratives that stem
from the margin – may be pivotal in fostering an objective approach to history.
Memory has the power to reveal, but the same power can also be used to conceal.
One might not totally depend on memory. Amina may make sense of her past in relation
to her voyage both into and out of the home. In addition, the notion of collective memory
can also help in sharpening this recognition, where storytelling plays a role in this
process. Images that once appeared smaller, and colors, which were once hardly defined,
now become sharpen: “Images only grew bigger, lines got more distinct and tones of
colours more defined. With time, images multiplied and superimposed in my crammed
head” (Al Khemir 1993, 25). The images that become much clearer can be understood as
an aspect of both the collective memory and her voyage out.
Amina does not have direct access to the past, and her memory may be viewed as
incomplete. To remedy this incompleteness, the novel not only recurs and projects itself
in the memory of the ethnic minorities to retell the past, but it uses memory as a tool to
thread the temporal void that exists in the narrative of history. This notion of memory
becomes part of Amina’s identity and her personal memory intervenes in the memories
of the marginal people around her, including her mother, Yasmina, Aisha, and others.
An explicit indication of such representation can be extracted from the song that
Aisha sings while she helps Ommzine in the process of her knitting work: “Oh my
lamentations on Jaris and its girls, the unbelievers have been and destroyed their
105
honour” (Al Khemir 1993, 120). Aisha is concerned with the honor of the girls, especially
when the nassara (a word that means non-believers, but which also connotes the colonial
regime) “destroyed” the honor of Tunisian girls. This song seems to reverberate with the
brutality of French colonialism in North Africa; such recognition suggests that collective
memory is significant to the construction of national identity. Although the notion of
collective memory seems to glean individual memories in order to echo the voice of the
minoritarian, it suggests the impossibility of making all these individual memories
unified in a collective way. In other words, collectivity may only operate at the level of
collective memory that is attentive to national identity, but not to provide a
countermemory. Such an aspect makes invisible histories intervene in the mainstream
discourse of history, which results in every individual’s memories emerging before
collective memories. As a second option for voice, the narrative proposes storytelling as
the mechanism for maintaining such a process.
Auntie Houria’s story of the three orphan girls brings “listeners […] from both
worlds, that of reality and that of dreams” (Al Khemir 1993, 103). Auntie Houria’s story
becomes an aspect of liberating the female voice from the colonial and post-colonial
mainstream discourse, because the story is “stretching the realities of those who were
awake into a world of dreams and entering the world of the dreamers, to present them
with different realities” (Al Khemir 1993, 103). The novel seems to accept the possibility
of the minoritarian presenting “different realities”, and Yasmina’s marriage at the age of
59 by the end of the novel may suggest such a hope. In this sense, storytelling allows for
multiple reading of collective memories to help in shaping history by refining individual
memories. Abdo notes that the discourse of nationalism “has betrayed women”, and to
overcome such betrayals (2009, 8) Fatima Sadiqi suggests that, “monolingual illiterate
women use folktales, songs, and gossip to express their inner selves and voice dissent
and dissatisfaction in a heavily patriarchal context”: storytelling becomes a tool for
overriding the binary construction of power in North African culture (Sadiqi 2003, 38).
Amina’s symbolic journey from Kurba to Tunis allows her to refine her memory
with the other minoritarian memories and it is then that she begins the process of reading
the self, and encounters herself and her past. The importance of being a transnational
diasporic figure pushes Amina to accept a transcultural identity as it has inspired her to
opt for a paradigm through which minoritarians can dwell with no potential oppression.
The complexity of such intermediacy, living in-between temporalities and places at the
same time, proliferates in the course of identity recognition, which is perplexed by the
collective enunciation of the minoritarian voice.
The journey Amina experiences during the course of her relationship with Antoine
inspires the possibility of reclaiming her past and adapting it to the needs of the
present/future. It has also inspired in her the audacity of hope to voice a minor narrative.
This aspect does not fully permeate the considerable intimacy represented in the
intonation of the mother/daughter. Amina is no longer that same girl who happened to
receive her portion of beatings from her uncles. She is no longer that girl whose living
depends on an imaginative prospectus of life. She is a woman who, like her mother, has
inherited the pains and agonies of her people, but where the two characters part
106
company is that Amina does not want to identify with her mother, or with those like her:
she wants an identity of her own construction, a transcultural identity.
To articulate a voice might presume an awareness of the obstacles that hinder the
insurgence of the subject’s voice, to identify with the subject in question, and to work in a
collective assemblage of enunciation. The problematic of such a paradigm rests in the fact
that Amina’s refusal to identify with this group (Yassmina, her mother, her sisters, etc.)
cannot be attributed to egocentricity. As the novel shows, it is a process of negotiation
and identity transformation that pushes toward this notion of self-identification. In this
context, Amina is unable to discuss this issue with her mother openly. First, Omzzine
depends to a greater extent on Amina because, as the mother says, she is her future.
Second, the cultural politics in Tunisia postpone the act of female travel unless she is
accompanied by a man. Thus, the novel suggests, being a woman in North Africa delays
any such journeys outside her house. In the case of Amina, she only highlights the honor
of her mother the moment she re-turns home to Kurba. However, her decision to leave
after celebrations may only problematize this condition. The third element rests in the
notion of voice itself. To have a voice, to make your voice heard, as a woman in the North
African context, presumes that the subject would propagate all those cultural and social
norms that relegate the woman to a secondary level with regard to the man. All these
elements act together to weave a problematic approach pivotal to communication
between the mother and daughter.
Consequently, Amina is left in a situation of limbo and indecision. Her identity is
split, not as a factor of travel (dislocation), but as one of her re-turn and the possibility of
losing confidence in the act of voicing. This is apparent in the following passage:
What if I pulled the thread and went wherever I wanted to go? Had not the time
come to unknit everything that had been knitted so far? Yes, everything. I had the
feeling that none of the items she had knitted was separate and that if I pulled the
woolen thread as I went away, I would unknit everything. (Al Khemir 1993, 270)
The delicacy of Amina’s identity and the impossibility of articulation are two exemplary
settings that problematize the issue of identity in this novel qua nation. In his
“Nationalism, Gender, and the Narrative of Identity”, Radhakrishnan points out that the
discourse of nationalism articulates the privilege that emerges from woman’s inability “to
produce its own history in response to its inner sense of identity” (1992, 85). In this novel
in imagining “woman as victim […] Woman becomes the allegorical name for a specific
historical failure: the failure to coordinate the political or ontological with the
epistemological within an undivided agency” (Radhakrishnan 1992, 85). It is important to
note that Amina’s refusal to re-member with her mother is set up within this prescribed
framework. To be disunited with the mother bears a salient feature of the rejection of the
nationalist discourse within which the concept of the nation is configured in order to
paralyze women.
This dis-embodiment might also produce a failure to reconstruct identity with the
criteria that Amina chooses. For Amina, the time has come to decide on an alternating
discourse that brings women’s voice to the fore. Her decision to “tell the story to the
107
world” pinpoints those complexities of failure and engages women in the remapping of
their “historical failure”. Her aim to “unknit everything” could be understood as a way to
dismantle the discourse of nationalism in order to rectify the history of the minoritarian.
Amina acknowledges that the discourse of patriarchy is woven into that of nationalism
and colonialism. And to “unknit” is to dismantle this discursive structure of oppression.
This process aims at the deconstruction of the discourse that excludes the woman and
opts instead for a rather more inclusive approach of transculturality. In this vein,
nationalism, patriarchy, and colonialism form a unified body that does not allow for any
partial treatment of each discourse on an individual basis. This is so because, when a
deconstructive process is at work, all of the elements in this discursive body will be
dismantled.
Subsequently, to contest this discourse, Amina’s identity has to face certain
impossibilities: these include the impossibility of detaching herself from her mother and
surroundings, and the impossibility of representing herself ethically. However, the
notion of ethics here does not signify that Amina has any authority (symbolic or actual)
over her own representation. The process of speaking about the minorities in the novel
involves both Amina and the other minoritarians in such representation. Recalling
Nnaemeka’s point that “involvement (proximity) and withdrawal (distance) can evolve
into a workable symbiosis that is fashioned in the crucible of mutually determined
temperance” (1997, 163), it can be suggested that the split persists in Amina’s identity.
The refusal of re-membrance in conjunction with “proximity” and “distance” leaves
Amina split and in a liminal space. Her return home is symbolic in that it engulfs the
notion of turning back to Britain. She travels home only for a celebration, which is clearly
seen when she negotiates with herself whether to tell her mother that she is not in Tunisia
to stay:
Now you will have to tell her, tell her that you have not come back, that you never
came back, that this was an image of you, a dead image from the past which was
temporary revived for the celebration, just for her, that it was not possible to revive
it again, that the dummy feeds off your own blood, that for it to live, you would
have to die. (Al Khemir 1993, 268)
As the passage shows, there is a choice of which single element she will have to give up
by a part of her body. The question here deals with choice, but it is that same choice that
places identity in a position of contradiction with the paradigm of not-to-surrender. This
may be critical for Amina, who notes that “[y]ou choose for yourself to live and somehow
that very same choice means the death of part of you, substantial part of you” (Al Khemir
1993, 268). Not-to-surrender is the only possible solution for Amina. It seems possible “to
sneak out of this body, this prison, and go somewhere where I could be”, because she
feels “strange” as she lives within her body and culture (Al Khemir 1993, 269).
To look for the singularity of the self, Amina needs to travel. As this is not possible
in Tunisia because her being in Tunisia has caused her to come adrift, problematizing her
identity, making her sense of belonging more challenging, the possibility of being
released from the memory of the house offers new alternative strategies to articulate the
108
voices of the disadvantaged for an Anglophone reader. Amina finds out that she has to
speak and “the story has to be told to the world, the story of those who never find out.
They are born, spend time in this world, die and never live, never know themselves. And
there is never anyone to tell the story. I have to speak” (Al Khemir 1993, 271). According
to Trinh, to talk is to bring “the impossible within reach. It contributes to widening the
horizon of one’s imagination; to constantly shifting the frontier between reality and
fantasy” (1997, 24). While this quotation is a prime example of the notion of transnational
minoritarian discourse, it can also point to the process of dialogism in the sense defined
by Bakhtin (1981). The narrator postulates the importance of globalization in releasing the
bodies of “those never know themselves”. The narrative calls for a contribution from the
educated subjectivities to consider the issues of liberation and liberated female subjects in
the general context of modernity rather than in that of tradition. In similar fashion, it also
suggests that the time has come for Amina and others like her to learn “not to regret” (Al
Khemir 1993, 272).
This story is not about regret; rather, it is about how to turn regret into an act of
successful liberation. It is a quest for transforming the female space from the state of
being conditional into an unconditional horizon for creativity and the singular
subjectivities of a collective enunciation. It is for this reason that the particular trajectory
has been chosen. Although this is not clearly defined, it is situated in the middle, in a
space of in-betweenness. Amina invokes the story of the orphaned girls and decides to
take the third road, which is left untaken in the novel, and this is clearly indicated in the
following passage:
Disguised as knights, they rode until they reached the outskirts of the village. The
road forked into three. ‘I’ll take the first road’, said the eldest, ‘and I’ll take the
second road,’ said the other. At the beginning of the third road, the untraveled road,
lay a jet black feather on which was written in Arabic calligraphy, with silver ink,
‘Take me, you regret, leave me, you regret.’ (Al Khemir 1993, 258)
The story of the orphaned girls clarifies Al Khemir’s notion of the “bridge” that she
mentions in her address to the 2009 National Book Festival, in which she explains that
she chooses to write in English, a third language in Tunisia, because she wants to be “on
the bridge”. English offers her the possibility to encounter foreignness and that “to
actually write in one’s third language it means that you are constantly on the bridge”
(2009, n.p.). Al Khemir believes that the English she is using to write her novels is not
“English English, because it is English with a different spirit that comes from the outside”
(2009, n.p; emphasis added). Yet it is this difference, or the culture of difference, that
enables the disadvantaged to attain their voice: a transcultural English.
This aspect is also characteristic of Amina who chooses the third road as a position
that allows her to be “on the bridge”: neither French nor Arabic. In addition, the passage
postulates a formula that links the identity reconstruction of the female subject with its
ability to open up sites of freedom. The site proposes that woman should unify her
identity with other subjectivities, to engage in a process of confidence, and take the risk of
travel. It is through the notion of travel that the third road could be explored: “Up the
109
third road I went, in my lifetime disguise. I went looking for my destiny, for the real self”
(Al Khemir 1993, 258). In this regard, it is possible for the female identity to create the
notion of the “included middle” (Deleuze and Guattari 1987, 519), through which the
identity would deterritorialize her space. Morrison reminds us that the impossibility for
the woman to restore the past experiences generates in her the need to forge other means
to access collective memory, and to do this Morrison suggests that woman needs to
“trust” her memory and link it with “the recollections of others” (1987, 111). Amina links
her memories with the memories of the women in the house and her university friends.
At the same time Amina seems to differ significantly as she chooses to construct her
identity in the ways that she does. The cultural space she is given cannot behold the
notion of identity that she seeks, and to travel is to choose for her a transcultural identity
that demands a process of destruction followed by reconstruction of all that is cultural,
social, and religious.
***
To seek the self through (in)direct encounters with the other (cf. Huttunen et al. 2008),
and to refuse to speak as a victim (cf. Olaussen 2009), are considered two formalities
through which the subject aims at a complete or partial deconstructive approach to the
discourse of silence. The attribution of such formalities proffers alternative meanings for
the singularity of the subject and thereby offers different (con)textual interpretations of
historical events. In this narrative many elements are intertwined to explore the
problematic of gender and language with respect to voice and silence. The house is
represented in the novel as the silent aspect of the woman. Huttunen et al. point out that
“[i]n a text, silence performs in a different way from that which is narrated or uttered in
language and therefore needs reading strategies of its own” (2008, хv). The narrative not
only tries to interpret the language of silence but also contributes to the process of
“negotiation between the self and the nation, making the question of identity relevant in
a social context” (Huttunen et al. 2008, хvіі). It implies an economy in which the act of
reading/writing is considered, as Amina notes, as “the work of a witness” (Al Khemir
1993, 271). This aspect brings the question of the (un)acceptable to the heart of discussion
as it concerns identity and interpretation (Huttunen et al. 2008, хvіі). What makes it
significant for this narrative is the way in which it provides alternative meanings for the
aforementioned formalities, and how it decodes the subverting discourse of patriarchy.
The narrative, therefore, recognizes the notion of the “third road” as the impetus for
liberating the discourse from patriarchy. As Amina notes at the end of the novel, it is at
the end of the third road that the “sun rose” (Al Khemir 1993, 272). This is the sun of
hope: the female voice that aims at establishing new meaning to contest the male
discursive structures and release the female subject from that authority.
Amina’s refusal to re-member with her mother and her own reminiscences of the
past, often represented as performances, suggests two interpretations. First, the refusal to
re-member with the mother is a refusal to be identified with the nation: the nation in the
African context is symbolically constructed using the hope of the mother. The notion of
the nation that the novel represents is imperative for the notion of patriarchy, and to
110
refuse such identification is to refuse the discourse of patriarchy. Yuval-Davis reminds us
that, “a figure of a woman, often a mother, symbolizes in many cultures the spirit of the
collectivity […] she is constructed as the symbolic bearer of collectivity’s identity and
honour” (1997, 45; emphasis added). In the novel, Ommzine seems to represent such a
construction. Second, as a consequence of this refusal, the novel suggests that it is
through a deconstructive approach to the discourse of patriarchy and nationalism that
women can voice their agonies. This epistemology inscribes voice in the construction of
female identity by means of deterritorialization, and further elaborates on the intersection
in which the discourse of the nation and gender tend to construct each other (Yuval-
Davis 1997, 4).
The novel is deeply critical of the way in which the female body is confined in a
patriarchal discourse of which the notion of the house remains an emblem. The ways in
which history is told by men, and the exclusion of the female voice from the re-narration
of the past are also criticized in the novel. This criticism suggests that creative expression
is the only means available to present a literature of a minority as rhetoric unavailable to
those in the majority. This novel is about minoritarians, and how they voice and “rethink
marginality by insisting that he/she listens carefully to ‘marginal discourses’ as
manifested by the silences and other patterns of articulation of the marginalized” (Yuval-
Davis 1997, 1-2). As illustrated through Amina’s voice, recognition of her transculturality
becomes a possibility, because Amina in Kurba is not Amina after she travels. The
recognition of transformation evokes a different persona whose identity construction is
no longer a factor of national identity, but a consequence of liberation and the process of
re-reading this identity. As Amina notes “[y]ou probably doesn’t recognize yourself […]
Maybe you have lost all those sensations and associations which make you feel it’s you”
(Al Khemir 1993, 21). Amina is no longer associated with the cultural memories of the
majority. Her singularity becomes part of the minoritarian whose objective is to
deterritorialize the oppressive elements “knitted” within their culture and, therefore,
within their psyche.
111
5 Escaping Postcoloniality,
Reconstructing Identities:
Towards a Transcultural
Belonging in Laila Lalami’s
Secret Son
In Chapter 3 I have demonstrated that the act of writing back is inseparable from the
notion of re-constructing space and identity in post-colonial North Africa: both processes
seem to work together to locate the minority voice vis-à-vis the majority. I have also
shown that in order to write back one needs to question the position of the memory of the
minoritarian in the mainstream notion of history. The conclusion that the North African
subject seems to originate is to stress the notion of memory in the margin as a possibility
for a more inclusive version of history. I have also demonstrated that the act of writing
back requires a revision of the history that the mainstream represents through various
experimental devices. In order to implement such a possibility, I have argued that
thinking transculturally can be an aspect of the way in which the North African subject
writes back through re-writing North Africa. Chapter 4 also engages in the question of
history but places greater emphasis more on the notion of space and memory and how
the North African woman needs to negotiate her space in order to voice her agonies. In
doing so, Chapter 4 shows that travel and hospitality can be viewed as ways of re-
defining space in post-colonial North Africa. In addition, the present chapter aims to
explore how transculturality can be employed and suggested as the mechanism that
drives the North African subject to liberate the self. This chapter also seeks to show the
way this notion of liberation intersects with language and the ability to forge alternative
modernities for the minoritarian in re-writing North Africa.
Since its publication in 2009, Lalami’s Secret Son has attracted a number of readers,
largely American, who have written reviews and commented on its plot, structure, and
language, thereby providing a different reading of the narrative. Many reviewers criticize
the novel for its scant usage of the English language. In his “Review”, John Lingan, for
instance, argues that the narrative’s language is “earnest” (2009, n.p.), meanwhile Nan
Goldberg in “Betrayals expose fragility of family and faith”, regards the language as
“distinctly pedestrian, almost tone-deaf”(2009, n.p.). Such critiques as these either warn
112
the American reader to avoid reading the text or indirectly hint at the other’s misuse of
the American native language. In either case, longing for a voice in a deterritorialized
language is critical to Secret Son. Whereas the critiques enlisted above allude indirectly to
the role of translation in multilingual narratives, they also highlight the importance of
authenticity in minority literature in the global space.
Secret Son is about a young Moroccan named Youssef, the son of an orphaned
mother who had fallen, culturally, victim to a taboo relationship with an upper class man.
The sexual relations result in a child, Youssef, and his mother, Rachida, is alienated and
desperate. At the age of seventeen, Youssef discovers that his father is still alive, and that
he is not the orphan that Youssef has thought himself to be. Youssef lives with his mother
in a slum in metropolitan Casablanca; he hardly knows anything about the city apart
from the slum and its surroundings. In pursuit of his father, he discovers that he has a
sister who is studying in the United States of America to become a future director of the
AmraCo.
The novel follows Youssef from poverty to the status of being the son of a rich man,
Nabil Amrani. It also follows his return to the slum and adoption of the role of a terrorist.
However, the novel does not simply unfold the story of Youssef and his familial
relationships. More specifically, the narrative delves into questions of post-coloniality,
neo-liberalism, belonging, and the ways in which the characters’ longing for belonging is
replaced by the notion of unbelonging. The narrative also maps out the importance of
language and class as sites of reterritorialization and deterritorialization, pointing out
that access to a deterritorialized space can only thrive if the characters are supported by
transcultural belonging. Language and translation are the means by which the process of
deterritorialization takes place. Moreover, deterritorialized language is the mechanism to
enable communication and dialogue, and hence yearning for alternative forms of
modernity can be assured.
Subsequently, to move beyond the mother tongue, a vernacular, and its culture
brings the emotional belonging into question. In addressing the issue of language and
authenticity, this chapter aims to contribute to a theoretical standpoint on transcultural
belonging. As I will show, the translational narrative in English, one that uses aspects of a
local culture mixed with those of the host culture contrapuntally in order to create a
unique belonging, rests in the idea of unbelonging. Unbelonging is not necessarily a
refusal to belong to the local culture, neither is it considered a full acceptance of the host
culture: it is a process that works in both directions. Hence, the aim of this chapter is
threefold.
First, it seeks to address the role of authenticity through unmediated translation
(translation with no third party), and the mechanisms used in the novel to represent the
submerged ethically. Second, it seeks to understand the ways the novel emphasizes the
relationship between gender, class, voice, and belonging in post-colonial Morocco, and
the means of achieving deterritorialization. The third aim is to emphasize the importance
of transculturality in minority narratives; that is, in order to deconstruct the condition of
postcoloniality, the post-colonial subject needs to ascribe her/his free space to a
transcultural belonging. In short, the following sections will carve out the potential
elements that Sissy Helff invokes to distinguish what she calls the transcultural novel,
113
namely, the domination of uncertainty, individualized realities, and an unreliable
narrator (2009, 81-2). Although, to a greater extent, Secret Son follows the prescribed
patterns of a transcultural narrative, I would like first to begin with questions of language,
authenticity, and translation.
5.1 A MULTILINGUAL TEXT: BETWEEN LANGUAGE AND TRANSLATION
It may appear truculent to doubt the sincerity of minority literature struggling over the
years for a position in post-colonial scholarship. To give a voice to the marginalized in the
margin of post-colonialism also appears to be of much concern to the newly established
mode of narratives in North Africa. Nevertheless, the attempt to voice minority
narratives may be delayed in the post-colonial condition. Dirlik reminds us that
postcoloniality designates the process by which Third World scholars traverse into first
world academia (1997, 25). And yet minority literature goes beyond the assimilative
dimension of that travel to become “a powerful ingredient […] that attacks Eurocentric
stronghold” (Morisson 1988, 129; emphasis added). In addition to such dialogical
struggle, the connection between voice and authenticity is hardly an abstract conclusion
of the First/Third World realization, but one in which authenticity attracts critical
judgment with regard to minority literature. The very idea of advocating and labeling
such a narrative as minoritarian attempts to exclude minority narratives from world
scholarship by using the accusation of being inauthentic. As I demonstrated in Chapter 2,
the term minority that I invoke here does not correlate with the construct “minor” versus
“major”.
Becoming minor does not indicate the absence of articulation, since silence may
provide a monologue, and absence does not necessarily imply void. Guignery, in
referring to Midsummer Night’s Dream, argues that Pyramus’s claim “I see a voice” reflects
his experience of the Other through his ability to see “voices on the page but cannot hear
them” (2009, 1). The point that I aim to illustrate here is that the literatures of the minority
have always been present, but it is only the language (be it Arabic, Swahili, Berber or
others) that fails to transmit the message, because the narrative is not written in English
or in French, for example: it is in the process of becoming. The breaking of this silence
through a deterritorialized language such as English is an attempt to discover, rather
than to evaluate, the complexity of such work. A breaking of silence takes a “collective
assemblage of enunciation” wherein the subject shares with the minority a voice of the
collective without necessarily losing her/his singularity.
The use of the English language in Secret Son can be seen as an act of liberation that
opens up opportunities to transcend cultural, social, and/or political constraints. It also
attempts to leave the territoriality of the post/colonial space in which the act of writing is
questioned (Lamming 1984, 27). Yet English (the novel’s language) is not a local but an
alien language, one that is hardly understood by the majority in Morocco. One could
even assume that it is the language of the neo-liberalists or a means of communication
amongst students of English Studies at Moroccan universities. In the meantime, it is
argued, reliance on the English language is an attempt to speak out about the deficiency
of certain complexities within Moroccan society in a major language. Lalami’s choice to
114
write in English has been affected by a double mode of disentanglement. Her refusal to
write in French is not a question of ability, since her studies were primarily conducted in
French (2009b, 19-20). Rather, it is the notions of identity and class that steer her away
from writing in French. As Lalami does not want to identify with the “new aristocrats” in
Morocco (whose first language is French and not Arabic), she points out that
French was not just a prominent language in Morocco. It was the language of power;
an indicator of social class; a means to include or exclude people. The education I
had received had emphasized the importance of French to the detriment of Arabic
[…] Writing in French came at a cost; it inevitably brought with it a colonial
baggage that I no longer wanted to carry. (Lalami 2009b, 20)
Lalami’s identity seems to be burdened by the cultural baggage “inherent in the use of
French” (2009b, 20). For Lalami, self-realization should no longer be constructed as part
of her “Frenchness”. This “linguistic imprisonment” remains a constitutive part of many
post-colonial writers who aim at creating alternative possibilities for a voice.
Nevertheless, it is undeniably a congruent aspect of colonialism, the colonial language
bearing with it the power to promote the colonial plans after the colonial invasion, and
this is exactly what Secret Son attempts to emphasize as an aspect of North Africa.
Looking, for instance, at the linguistic structure pertaining in Morocco, Arabic is
accepted as Morocco’s official language along with Berber (in Algeria and Tunisia Arabic
is the official language), whereas French is used as the first foreign language. In practice,
French can be found in the most sensitive structures of society: it is used in the media and
in governmental speeches, for instance, and it is regarded as the language of economics
and communication. Its use is primarily meant to exclude a great proportion of the
population who have not mastered the Arabic language, for how could they afford
learning in French (Boukous 2008, 139). Lalami’s concern with the colonial language does
not merely indicate it as problematic in the post-colonial North Africa, but, as Ashcroft
reminds us, “for the postcolonial people the language is deeply inflected with the
troubling questions littering that liminal space where identity and culture mingle and
scrape against one another” (2009, 101). Lalami’s experience with French has left her in a
space of liminality and, to borrow from McGuire, she is “suffering, schizophrenic,
treacherous, alienated, hybrid, separated from the mother” (1994, 107) and believes that
she is “not good enough […] to produce a novel” (Lalami 2009b, 20).
Lalami demonstrates that it is impossible to imagine a world that is beyond the
language that one masters. In studying with French as the medium of instruction,
growing up in French schools, and reading books that draw on French culture, Lalami’s
world becomes part of that linguistic world, and part of Paris rather than Rabat. The
images and photographs of her childhood, Lalami points out, have “invaded her
imaginary world to such an extent that she never thought they came from an alien place”
(2009b, 19, emphasis added). The statement here expresses a liminal space that the
language has inscribed in Lalami’s identity. Language shapes identity, and the longing
for belonging highlights the urgency to find a space that marks the limits of the colonial
language and inaugurates the birth of a new one.
115
Many critics, especially African and Caribbean, demonstrate the need for a
language that imbues the flow of their voice aside from the colonial language. Achebe,
for instance, sees the use of colonial language as an opportunity to “carry the weight” of
the African experience. The language, however, needs to be different (1975, 62). The
difference that embodies social and cultural aspects of the imagined community is
important for claiming a new belonging. In this respect, the orientation of writing in a
transformed language can be comprehended differently. Deleuze and Guattari remind us
that in order to form a community of minoritarians, one which shares similarities in its
use of such a language in a rather “different” way, one needs to deterritorialize the major
language (1986, 28-30) and go beyond the vernacular and/or the colonial language with
appropriation, transformation, and translation.
Lalami may be expected to follow such a path, and Secret Son does, indeed, become
an instance of such appropriation. The author is keen to allude to her cultural origins in
the use of untranslated words in the novel such as “a-mmi” (Lalami 2009a, 5);
“Hshouma” (Lalami 2009a, 9); “Qalt el-hya hadi” (Lalami 2009a, 36); “Was’i Khatrek”
(Lalami 2009a, 261); “Mbarek u mess’ud” (Lalami 2009a, 44), and so on. Bill Ashcroft
points out that the technique of leaving some vernacular words untranslated in the text is
more widely used and a more politically canny device for conveying the sense of
“cultural distinctiveness” (2009, 176). The “cultural distinctiveness” is not only associated
with the author. The aspect is subtly emphasized, especially when the conversation
between characters is held in French, to highlight the social status of certain characters.
This is described at length when the narrator comments on the Amrani family:
“Ordinarily, Amal’s parents spoke French to each other and to her, using Darija Arabic
only with the maid or the driver” (Lalami 2009a, 162). French is the language of power in
Moroccan society; it is the language of the elite, of the new comprador. Darija – a
Moroccan dialect of the Arabic language – is used only to communicate with servants.
The narrative stresses the relations between language and power in Moroccan society.
When Youssef meets Alia, for instance, he generally uses French words to talk with her,
in hopes that he could belong to her community. The following passage describes this
aspect in details when Youssef meets with Alia’s father:
“Bonjour,” he said.
“Bonjour,” Youssef replied, getting up and stretching out his hand.
“Papa, this is Youssef, a copain de classe,” Alia said by way of introduction.
“Youssef comment?”
“El Mekki”. (Lalami 2009a, 67)
In an incident such as this, conversing using French almost inevitably leads to asking the
other for her/his family name. The role of language and the family name might grant
legitimacy to the person in order to gain access to the upper class. Episodes where the
family name and class coalesce are numerous in the novel, and to associate French with
the neo-liberalists is also apparent. Examples of such an association can be cited, such as
when Alia addresses Yussef: “Je suis désolée” (Lalami 2009a, 31); “Salut” (Lalami 2009a, 31);
between Yussef and Alia’s father, as indicated in the passage above; between Yussef and
116
his first encounter with his father: “Je vais très bien, merci” (Lalami 2009a, 86), and so on.
But the startling moment in which the power of language is linked to class can be
glimpsed from the following passage, when Amin meets Yussef’s father:
“Amin comment?” Nabil asked as they shook hands.
“Chebana.”
“Are you in the same class as Yussef?”
“No. I’m majoring in law.”
“Oh. What year?”
“Douzième,” Amin said, when of course he meant deuxième. (Lalami 2009a, 121)
To understand such a process in North Africa, Bourdieu concludes that
“legitimacy” is defined as a means of selection that defines upper class people as
speakers or writers of the elite language (1993, 331), which in the case of North Africa is
French. The power of the French language in Moroccan society becomes “symbolic”, and
Bourdieu describes such power as something invisible, “which can be exercised only with
the complicity of those who do not want to know that they are subject to it, or even that
they themselves exercise it” (1991, 164). Youssef seems to be happy to master French and
“[h]e felt a surge of gratitude to his mother, because without her tutoring, his diction in
French would not have been flawless. To listen to him, one would never have known he
lived in Hay An Najat” (Lalami 2009a, 31). Lalami may be aware of such symbolic power
in which language is deployed to mediate between the neo-liberalists and their interest in
society. The power of French is also reflected in the author’s psyche and childhood,
where French is the means of communication with the world inside (school), and the
need to appropriate the language in post-colonial societies is confirmed.
In effect, the appropriation of language through the insertion of untranslated words
can have two contradictory but connected consequences. First, the untranslatability
creates the third space of enunciation, a space that the writer inhabits between her/his
language and the target language (Ashcroft 2009, 161). Saying this is to assume that the
new language offers a new space from which to articulate and construct a new mode of
representation, and engenders new frontiers for belonging beyond one’s own culture. It
also generates a “metonymic gap” that pushes the reader to consider the culture of the
other, yet sometimes it leads to misinterpretation as a consequence of such newness
(Ashcroft 2009, 175; Ashcroft 2001, 75).
However interesting it might be, the “metonymic gap” is perceived as a negative
aspect of translation. In his reading of Secret Son, John Lingan points out that “this may be
the most poorly written novel I’ve read in five years”, because, as he notes, the “writing
here is nothing but earnest” (2009, n.p.). The untranslated words and the direct
translation of sentence structure from Arabic and/or French into English leave the reader
unaware of the transition made from one level to another. The effect of the direct
translation on the American reader, for instance, highlights the deterritorialization of
language, in other words, its transformation. Through this process, the language in Secret
Son has been affected “with a strong coefficient of deterritorialization” (Deleuze and
Guattari 1986, 29), a notion in which that narrative is in a position of Becoming. The
117
semantic errors in Secret Son, as Lingan points out, can be considered to be part of a
process that sustains deterritorialization. To make semantic errors in this context is to
deterritorialize the language from its structure of power, and to seek another, yet
different community. Deleuze and Guattari remind us that, when the writer
is in the margins or completely outside his or her fragile community, this situation
allows the writer all the more the possibility to express another possible community
and to forge the means for another consciousness and another sensibility. (1986, 17)
The search for other communities makes the minority novel such as Secret Son
problematic. What makes critics such as Lingan fail to interpret the narrative as a global
novel rests in the notion of multilinguality that makes Secret Son “the other other
literature” in the sense described by Lennon (2010, 144). The language of the novel does
not merely emphasize translation as a “particle aspect” of the language, but it becomes a
practice in its own right (Lennon 2010, 8). In other words, the narrative does not aim to
make a direct translation of the social, cultural, and political issues of the North African
into the English language, but the purpose is to speak of “multiple languages” so as to
place the reader globally. It is this notion of multilinguality that speaks of the
minoritarian in North Africa and not only “speaking in translation” (Lennon 2010, 8).
Nevertheless, when the meaning between the major and the minor collapses, the
terms authenticity and readership retain their currency and remain significant for a
discussion of Secret Son. The issues of the translatability of cultural forms and social
struggles in post-colonial societies for a transcultural reader attract considerable attention
in multilingual novels. As such, authenticity and the ethics of reading permit the
awareness of this position. Ashcroft reminds us that, in order to reach a level of
authenticity and to limit the language defects inherent in the use of an imported language
(such as English or French, for instance), the chosen language “must be one that is itself
syncretic, dynamic, and constantly changing” (2009, 105). Syncretism is an indication of
transculturation, which can be seen in the characters’ attempt to reconcile their cultural
tradition with alternative sites of belonging. The constant shifts in a character’s
perception and the dynamic of the narrative itself might indicate another epistemology
for this belonging.
The narrative depends mostly on the characters’ soliloquy and the interference and
interruptions of the narrator. In either case, the characters cannot be trusted. The reader
becomes aware of the fact that a single event can be repeated and only revealed to the
reader as the true story in the end. A significant part of the novel is told through the
third-person narrator, who “knows everything”, but in fact hardly knows anything about
its characters. This feature can also be seen when the characters hide themselves behind
invented personalities until they are revealed. Although the boundaries of such realities
do unfold in the voice of the narrator as collective, the singularity of characters, and the
unreliability and uncertainty of the narrative seem to reproduce alternative realities in
this context. An example of this can be clearly observed in the story of Youssef’s mother
Rachida. Initially, the reader knows Rachida’s story through the following passage:
118
His mother spoke very tersely about her life. The Franciscan nuns at the Bab Ziyyat
orphanage had sent her to train as a nurse in a hospital. She had been there a few
months when a young lawyer by the name of Nabil Amrani came in for a minor
check up. He had been involved in a scuffle with the police at a political rally. They
started to see each other, and she quickly became pregnant. They planned to get
married. The weekend before their wedding, Nabil went to Casablanca to pick up
his brother from the airport, but in the morning fog, his car collided with a truck
and he died. Madam Amrani, Nabil’s mother, had never approved of the marriage,
and when she was told about the pregnancy, she accused Youssef’s mother of
sleeping with one of the doctors at work. Youssef’s mother could not complete her
training and went to live with a friend from the orphanage until after the birth.
Then she left Fes and settled in Casablanca. (Lalami 2009a, 23)
Concisely, the passage tells us that Rachida is an orphaned woman, who has not been
granted her natural position as a wife with her child in the Amrani family. The death of
Nabil Amrani causes drastic social and cultural sufferings for Rachida and her child. We
become suspicious about the invocation of the adverb “tersely”. Why does Rachida talk
in such an effective concise way about her life story? Such reality will be blurred and the
trust in the character no longer operates with the same level of efficiency when another
“reality” emerges, as we discover that Nabil Amrani does not manage to marry Rachida
at all: giving her the money for an abortion is enough for him to forget her and to erase
her from his entire life:
He had given Rachida the money for the abortion, and she had disappeared from
the house almost overnight. Of course, he had never asked his mother about it—it
was not something you talk about—and Malika had no idea; she was on bed rest. In
this way, Nabil had willed himself to forget about this pregnancy, relegating it to a
deep, dark corner of his mind. (Lalami 2009a, 87)
That is not the end of this story. The first reality is the mother’s, whereas the second is
revealed through Nabil Amrani (the father). The narrative, therefore, positions itself in a
state of untruthfulness. Which of the realities is authentic as far as Secret Son is concerned?
We cannot predict the level of authenticity until the end of the novel when each character
is engaged in serious negotiations with the self, with the local culture, and with their
social relations, and it is at this moment that the narrator interferes.
The interference of the narrator helps in blurring this suspicion in the way the
narrative suggests that the only authentic reality is the narrator’s, who functions in
dialogical relation with the implied author. The multiplicity of voices induces the sense of
a decentering of the self. In other words, the narrative implies a multiplicity of voices in
which the singularity of the narrator dwells in the multiplicity of the following voices: the
implied author’s, the narrator’s, and the characters’. These events function in the manner
of a single voice that which points to the characters’ own life. Hermans et al. point out
that “[t]he different voices relate to one another as interacting characters in a story […]
resulting in a complex, narratively structured self […] The dialogical self is composed of a
119
multiplicity of motivational voices” (1993, 215-216). This dialogical exchange charts the
character’s life in the social web, because the sociocultural dimensions of this storytelling
rest on the capacity of each character to resist certain anxieties. Consequently, it attempts
to suggest that the only authentic reality can be voiced through the narrator as the voice
representing the implied author. By the end of the novel, Rachida’s “real” story is
revealed through the narrator’s voice:
Many years ago, when Rachida had arrived in the Amrani family home near Fes,
she, too, had been ignorant and innocent. She had let herself believe that Nabil
Amrani was in love with her. Love was new. Love was intoxicating. Love gave
license to the ultimate of taboos: sleeping with a married man, a married man
whose pregnant wife was on bed rest. When Rachida herself became pregnant and
Nabil Amrani’s mother ordered her to get an abortion, Rachida had refused and
had returned to the orphanage with nothing but her dashed dreams and a baby
growing inside her. (Lalami 2009a, 236)
The narrative in this way represents a single event from a different perspective, and this
engagement refers to the modernist technique of experimentation. It is not by accident
that the author, Laila Lalami, speaks of authenticity with the aim of providing an
authentic voice for the American reader from a variety of perspectives. According to
Hermans et al., “a novel where different voices, often of a markedly different character
and representing a multiplicity of relatively independent worlds, interact to create a self-
narrative” (1993, 9) aims at foregrounding aspects of authenticity. Authenticity is what
Lalami seeks through her decision to write in English, in order to represent the multiple
voices and to mark her singularity. To write in English remains a way of liberating the
marginalized voices and to speak, to use Bahadur’s words, “directly to Americans, who
[…] urgently need authentic maps to those parts of the world where inequality has
electroshocked the terrorist id into being” (2009, n.p.).
But why does authenticity matter? It has been argued that authenticity is noticeably
an associative marker in minority literature and post-colonial studies (Erichsen 2000, 193),
and the claim of “pure origin” in imagined communities demands that one has to belong
in order to compensate for one’s alienated identity (Richter 2009, 60). The latter argument
deliberately foregrounds a counterargument maintained by post-structuralists such as
Derrida, specifically at the point concerning the relation between text and context.
Nevertheless, Homi Bhabha maintains that the question more concerns the receiving
audience, because, “[t]he ‘image’ must be measured against the ‘essential’ or ‘original’ in
order to establish its degree of representativeness, the correctness of the image” (1984,
100).
In this vein, the affiliation with a certain culture or nation does not necessarily grant
a certain text, author, or narrative an authentic voice, and thus, Lalami’s claim to provide
an authentic Moroccan voice for American readers might be problematic. On another
level, if authenticity is perceived as a category of reference to representation and as a
claim of national identity, it will gesture towards its failure or, rather, the impossibility of
its existence in the post-colonial condition. Belonging to a certain nation or culture does
120
not imply that authenticity is at work. Accordingly, Huggan reminds us that an authentic
voice aims at finding an international audience through which the possibility of reading
identity emerges (2001, 176). Huggan continues that “[t]he search for authenticity […]
involves the reaching out to alternative readerships, including the people one regards as
being one’s own” (2001, 176). Such a process presumes self-engagement in acquainting
the reader with the transcultural codes of representations, and being part of a
transcultural, rather than monoculture, audience. What is at stake in this debate is that
the search for an authentic voice is part of an ongoing process that aims at, on the one
hand, a full engagement in retaining “essentialist notions of culture and identity”
(Erichsen 2000, 202), and, on the other hand, support for the speaking subject and
identification with the minority group. In this vein, the discourse of language is deployed
in this narrative to suggest that translation without mediators facilitates a transcultural
reading of the self and the other, and points to the importance of the language in
multilingual texts.
Subsequently, the question of authenticity for Lalami designates a liminal space in
which the author feels enmeshed. Lalami’s “urgency” to find an authentic voice to speak
directly to Americans can be interpreted in relation to the above approach. In the mean
time, there are certain functionalities that need elaboration. First, there seems to be a
problem of identification and belonging in Secret Son. Belonging is mainly reflected through
the character Amal, who favors living with her “poor”, Brazilian-American boy friend
rather than living with her rich parents in Morocco. Belonging for Amal rests in her
unbelonging and her singularity, which empower her choice with respect to the notion of
home. Lalami sees that she identifies more with Youssef than with any other character in
the novel, for several reasons:
Youssef studies English at a university in Morocco, as did I; his mother is an orphan
who was raised in a French institution in Fès, as was mine; he is gullible, as,
unfortunately, am I; he speaks French fluently, as do I; yet he never quite feels at
home with the French-educated elite, and neither do I. (2009c, n.p.)
Such compatibilities that the author establishes with one of the characters in the novel
impose further questions on the issue of authenticity, to which we will return later in the
course of this analysis. Second, the author sees in Secret Son a transcultural agent that
traverses the cultural boundaries of the nation in order to present a social reality and
represent a voice of the marginalized in Morocco within a rather transcultural
framework. Fadia Faqir sees that works such as this aim largely at threading the division
between cultures by cutting out “the middleman” – the translator (2004, 168). To write in
English, Lalami does not fully submit to its rules, especially the semantic dimensions of
the language, because the source language and culture still have their effects in such
transition/translation. In interview, Lalami points out:
I tend to pay very close attention to language because, although I am writing in
English, my characters interact with one another in Arabic or French, and
121
sometimes both at the same time, so I try to keep the nuances that come with
speaking in each language. (Lalami and Otas 2010, n.p.)
Cultural permeation exists and upholds the narrative’s structure, and to shift languages
is to shift the emphasis between cultures, perceptions, and belongings as part of
transcultural movements. Similarly, Hechmi Trabelsi concisely points out that the
position of such writing in a globalized world is critical, because the aspect of
displacement (living in between two worlds) urges transcultural writers to revisit
their culture of origin by the essential questioning of their relationships with their
body, faiths, rites, languages. Their bi-culturalism makes them more sensitive to the
falsity of labels and references and more prone to crossing of cultures. (Trabelsi 2003,
n.p.)
However, authenticity seems to coalesce with the second epigraph of the novel saying
that “the fact that she is writing in English already falsifies what she wanted to tell”9 to the
reader. The existence of such an epigraph in the novel is conspicuous and might suggest
a contradiction between the author’s aim to give voice and the social representations of
gender, voice, and class. How can English, for instance, transmit/translate the trauma and
agonies of people, which she has already hinted at in the language’s inability to do so
(since it already falsifies) before the act of writing takes place? In what follows I would
like to present one such an example of social representation of gender and class and to
discuss the ways in which the novel suggests liberation and voice through the notion of
transculturality.
5.2 GENDER AND TRANSCULTURALITY
In this section, I aim to delve into the questions of gender, representation, and class in
Secret Son, and by doing so I aim to show how transculturality can disentangle the
Moroccan woman from the gendered space created by society. Consequently, Secret Son
invokes a certain level of disentanglement between what is and what is not socially
acceptable in a society that defines itself as Muslim; an issue that may evoke the dispute
discussed by African post-colonial theorists over the years (cf. Ashcroft 2009). It can be
argued that the attempt to represent does not mean that one should choose between two
seemingly antagonistic issues: good or bad. As the narrative shows, when society
privileges the “liberated”, “modern” woman over the “traditional” Moroccan woman, it
points to the conclusion that post-colonial Morocco, for an adequate relation to the
colonial discourse, positions the traditional Moroccan woman in the limited space of
silence. Nevertheless, such representation may not be acceptable to the minority, and
efforts are being made to look for the alternative sites for belonging that transculturality
can offer.
9 Originally it is written as follows: “The fact that I/am writing to you/in English /already falsifies
what I/wanted/to tell you. /My subject:/how to explain to you that I /don't belong to English /though
I belong nowhere else” by Gustavo Perez Firmat.
122
To begin with, Youssef is introduced to the reader as a secret in the sense that
legitimacy is a cultural phenomenon that can only be broken through a deterritorialized
language. In addition, the paradox lies in the rhetoric of silence itself in relation to the
text. Nevertheless, the subliminal spirit of Lalami’s Secret Son is the space in which the
tradition makes the Moroccan woman silent, and the act of speaking made “unspoken”
once more. The first epigraph of the novel marks the tone of the novel: breaking the
silence:
Silence is death
And you, if you speak, you die
If you are silent you die
So, speak and die.10
This suggests that nothing can prevent the post-colonial subject from giving a voice.
Initially, it is the act of speaking that seems to hold the spirit of the novel. To speak means
to perform an act of liberation on behalf of the unspeaking self and for the collective.
Lalami reflects on this aspect when she speaks about the reason behind her decision to
write: “I had always told stories, but now I wanted to be heard” (2009b, 20). In her
struggle for voice, Lalami seems to ascribe multilinguality to the text in order to thrive in
her struggle, and we can see such a process clearly in the way in which she makes a
comparison between two women in the text, with respect to language and to belonging.
In this respect, the novel suggests that, despite the prescribed presence of the
radicalism/tolerance binary, the transition of the characters as a result of class seems to
predominate in the novel; meanwhile, disparity between the high and low classes is
ostensibly significant for the novel’s structure. Underlying the silent class-encounter, the
incessant absence of the Moroccan woman’s voice poses certain questions, given that her
presence is noticeably denoted through her silence. The increasing dislocation of the
Moroccan woman in the space of marginality is the topic that Secret Son aims to
investigate, which I would like to discuss in this section.
There are at least two modes of representation in which the Moroccan woman is
introduced in Secret Son. She is either the silenced hardworking woman or the high-class
open-minded woman. What unites both representations are space and body. Youssef’s
mother is a typical example of the first type. When the narrative refers to Rachida, silence
imbues the characteristic atmosphere in which she is made to suffer:
And yet at night, when he lay down in the dark, in the terrible silence of that empty
apartment, he thought of his mother, alone in her little house in Hay An Najat. She
would be watching TV, knitting a sweater or folding laundry or shelling sunflower
seeds or mending a sock or peeling the skins of boiled chickpeas—she could never
stay still. (Lalami 2009a, 135)
10 This epigraph is quoted from the work of the Algerian Novelist and journalist Tahar Djaout. It is
set as the first epigraph to the novel. Originally written in French as “Le silence, c'est la mort / Et toi,
si tu parles, tu meurs / Si tu te tais, tu meurs / Alors, parle et meurs”.
123
Youssef’s mother expresses emotions throughout the events of this general description.
In this passage, night symbolizes silence. In addition, it is a metaphor that stands for the
suffering and hopelessness. Ironically, it is only after it is dark and quiet that Youssef
thinks of his mother, Rachida. This contradiction sustains the general description allotted
to the woman that only “tears prove what is true” (Cixous and Clement 1986, 35). Cixous
and Clement argue that for the woman
to escape the misfortune of her economic and familial exploitation, she chose to
suffer spectacularly before an audience of men: it is an attack of spectacle, a crisis of
suffering. And an attack is also a festival, a celebration of her guilt used as a
weapon”. (1986, 10; emphasis added)
The hardworking Moroccan woman is silenced because her fate and “the cultural
demarcation beyond which she will find herself excluded” (Cixous and Clement 1986, 33)
impose such a role upon her in this society. She is also naïve: “she would be watching
TV”, which is all that she is left. The media, in this sense, becomes a relief from anxiety.
The sole way to communicate is to be extracted from the actual reality and to rejoice in a
fictional deterritorialization through Egyptian movies or Mexican series.
The novel offers certain alternatives for the silent woman to speak, and these she
can find mainly in transculturality. Rachida’s addiction to watching the Mexican
television series can be interpreted as a variety of the transcultural aspect of belonging
that she could not find at home. The novel, in this respect, attempts to convey the notion
that the silent woman is a hardworking woman who “never stays still”. For Rachida to
smile, for instance, is an expression that never appears on her face, because “[l]aughter
breaks up, breaks out, splashes over […] it is the moment at which the woman crosses a
dangerous line […] not to cry: refuse jouissance, refuse to emit the precious secretions
that are partial objects for the other desire” (Cixous and Clement 1986, 33-5).
In addition, there seems a way out of this impasse. For a silent Moroccan woman to
step up the ladder, she has to have an aristocratic outlook. Although Youssef’s mother
(and this is the title she is given throughout the novel to signify this single mother) “was
a woman who valued work over pleasure, utility over beauty […] she was beautiful”
(Lalami 2009a, 5), yet she is deemed “unvoiced”. The role of her body allows her at least
to meet the criteria of “aristocracy”. She indulges in the rhetoric of self-negotiation, and
since “appearances are deceiving, Rachida had understood this simple fact long ago, so
she was often surprised to come across people who fell for artifice and good looks, for
sweet words and appealing facades—for lie”( Lalami 2009a, 233).
In order to overcome submissiveness, the Moroccan woman needs, in this sense, to
exist in an overt space of “appealing facades”. While seeking identification through “lies”
problematizes identity, it is assumed to be the only possible way for the Moroccan
woman to negotiate her position within such a society. That is not a working solution. In
this manner, the narrative illustrates that this kind of metaphorical construction of a
desirable space – of an included middle – might for the silent woman be only an illusion.
Whereas the novel’s aim is to “speak the unspeakable”, the social construction of binaries
renders it unspoken in its own right. Meanwhile the effects and continuity of the events
124
in the novel act as a threshold for the current situation: “tears prove what is true”, as
Cixous and Clement put it (1986, 33-6).
Rather than victimizing her, Secret Son translates the ways in which the novel’s
Moroccan society describes the high-class woman as a more liberated, decision-making
woman. This territorial binary persuades the reader to adopt a more subjective stance in
relation to one representation at the expense of the other. The contrast between Rachida
and Malika, for instance, emphasizes that the fixedness of identities and the promises of
change are already blurred. Because of the drive to deterritorialize her position, the
woman needs to perform a false identity:
Rachida had worn her best clothes—a navy blue jacket with matching pants, her
only pair of gold earrings—and had come to the door of the Amrani house […]
Malika Amrani recognized her immediately, kissed her cheeks, welcomed her in,
and ordered tea to be served outside. She looked at Rachid with patient eyes,
waiting for a favor to be asked. Why should she think otherwise? Favors were
commonly asked of a woman of her situation. Although Malika was older than
Rachida, she looked younger. Her hair was expertly cut, her face was carefully
made up, her nails were manicured, and she seemed at ease with all comforts
around her. (Lalami 2009a, 237)
This passage is built upon the territorial binary center/margin relation that is
characterized by Malika and Rachida respectively. Regardless of her “appealing facades”,
Rachida is seen as marginal for Malika. Hard work and agony have made the former
appear much older than the latter, which is not the case, as the novel demonstrates. In a
society differentiated by class division, the marginal cannot stand the process of
transition from Being-minor into Becoming-minor in the sense described by Deleuze and
Guattari. The difference is apparent: Becoming-minor is to place a voice in-between the
marginal and the central – it is a way of deterritorializing the social strata (Deleuze and
Guattari 1986, 25-8). When the process fails, it pushes the characters to resume their old
position: to territorialize once more (reterritorialization). The emphasis on the outlook of
both characters aims at appropriating each to a certain social stratum. Youssef’s mother’s
inability to deterritorialize such a position is apparent. The momentary departure from
her territory is not permanent, because her aim is not deterritorialization itself but to
secure her territory. The failure to compete at global level results in closing all available
entrances for her son, which ends in his capture as a terrorist. Malika, on the other hand,
feels safe with her position so that even Rachid’s arrival in her home is considered
beneficial to her.
Secret Son encloses representations of the Moroccan woman within the territorial
binary voice/silence in relation to social class. In this analysis, we can see that resistance
through silence postpones the process of deterritorialization. This case is made apparent
when Youssef’s mother wears the best of her clothes and golden earrings, and converses
with Mrs. Amrani in her house (territory). This is another suggestion the novel provides
for the woman to accomplish her partial deterritorialization, which takes place not
through silence but through a voice.
125
In the meantime, Lalami elaborates more on how society represents woman in
relation to class. The proportion of Rachida’s presence in the novel amounts to 60 percent
of the novel’s chapters, while Mrs. Amrani occupies only around 40 percent. Whereas
Rachida is described as a silenced woman, Mrs. Amrani engages in serious negotiations
with her husband and indulges in discussion of the family future. In addition, the
narrative repeatedly stresses Rachida’s background as an adult orphan woman, and as a
single mother, an insistence that becomes problematic for the general representation of
the silenced Moroccan woman. Subsequently, the narrative portrays the gendered
inability to speak as a defect related to class hierarchy and to the borders of culture. In
each case, Secret Son describes the void in communication between the classes as a
vacuum, rather than emptiness. The difference, as Morrison argues, is crucial in that
emptiness may be filled by things, whereas a vacuum cannot (1988, 136).
Even though Rachida’s presence in Moroccan society is marked by silence, there are
instances in which the novel describes her ability to merge into a transcultural, hybrid
singularity as a process of constructing new identities. Rachida’s silence cannot be
interpreted as a defect, but rather as wisdom, in the sense that she can read and speak
French fluently, and raise her child until he becomes an adult. The psychological
“wound” that she has suffered from as a consequence of her relation with Nabil Amrani
has been repaired by her transcultural journey from the Atlas to Casablanca. As a Berber,
she is able to hide part of her identity from her son and from the surroundings, and in the
end it is Youssef that realizes his mother’s mastery of the Berber language. Rachid, at this
specific point, understands that she is “no longer Rachida bent Hammou ben Abdeslam
ben Abdelkader Ouchak”, but she has become only “Rachida Ouchak” (Lalami 2009a,
280), a transcultural subject who recognizes her individual reality as such and not as part
of her imagined community. This version of transculturality is also significant for
Rachida in accommodating all her social defects and the ability to transform them into
points of strength so as to confront Malika and negotiate with her from a position of
power. Based on this, I would argue that transculturality cannot be deemed a solution for
every post-colonial subjectivity. The social and cultural transformation that Rachid
undergoes only limits the construction of her identity to a specific model, i.e., protecting
her son from his father. Rachida’s social and cultural transformation may only refer to the
limits of the notion of transculturality.
Class, as the narrative tries to emphasize, remains the mechanism that silences the
post-colonial subject. The post-colonial elite seems to silence marginal post-colonial
voices. However, based on such binaries as silence/voice, Casablanca/slum, and
home/away, transculturality might offer new meanings and possibilities for post-colonial
deterritorialization, although such possibilities may not be fully achieved and sometimes
may result in failure. Positive reactions to transculturality can be seen in the ways in
which Youssef and Amal refuse to accentuate their current positions. Youssef does not
want to live in the slum, and his willingness to move with his mother to his father’s
apartment is a case in point. Amal’s refusal to stay with her father also problematizes the
issue of identity. She does not want to identify with a social milieu that exemplifies
corruption and power. In what follows, I will illustrate these points in more detail, and
discuss social injustice as an aspect of the aggressive form of modernity in North Africa.
126
5.3 AGGRESSIVE MODERNITY: COMPRADORS AND POST-COLONIAL
MINORITIES
I use the term “aggressive modernity” in the sense that David Attwell defines in his
Rewriting Modernity: Studies in Black South African Literary History to describe a historical
condition that accounts “for every aspect of South Africa’s cultural history” (2005, 20).
Even though Attwell employs the term to explain a specifically local phenomenon (2005,
20-1), I find it similarly useful to account for the post-colonial transformation of the
cultural, social, and political aspects of life in Morocco as Secret Son charts it. In other
words, this section will attempt to reiterate the notion of postcoloniality that Bhabha has
advocated: in order to become modern, the cultural tenets of the individual are torn from
the ideology of modern states where inequality in the colonial condition has seeped into
the post-colonial condition (Bhabha and Comaroff 2002, 24). While this description seems
accurate for concluding that the post-colonial condition in Morocco is marked by a stark
domination by the neo-liberalists, the novel explicitly distinguishes this mode of neo-
liberalism as merely an outcome of the comprador intelligentsia. Although the period
after the independence of Morocco in 1956 was marked by a void in the transition of
power between the local authorities and the colonizing power, the new government was
entirely Francophone in its structure. The novel does not elaborate on this transition, but
it is indirectly installed in the characters’ psyches.
The aims of this section are threefold. First, in an attempt to link class to gender, it
seeks to understand the relation between what Bourdieu terms “symbolic power” and
the temptation to limit participation in the neo-liberal grouping to the children of
independence, the fathers of secret sons. Second, it will emphasize how the narrative
links this relation with a decline in social justice, thereby enunciating a new phase of
what I call the post-colony. Third, this section will show that, when the post-colonial
subject is being robbed of her or his belongings as an outcome of this injustice, s/he will
strives for belonging beyond the cultural and social groupings of her/his nation. While
the latter point will only be discussed in a general sense, I aim to conclude with it in
order to prepare a foreground for the novel’s premise on the notion of unbelonging,
which suggests a discussion of new forms of modernity as an aspect of Helff’s typology
of the transcultural novel (2009).
Through the theme of inequality, Secret Son aims to reinscribe the history of
Morocco differently. The narrative is a representation of the children of 1956 (the date of
Moroccan independence) as budding compradors. Central to my reading of Secret Son is
the point that the cohesive power and class relationship in Morocco is a matter of social
as well as cultural capital. This information is eventually introduced in metropolitan
Casablanca, where the family Amrani carries on its business. At the political level, there
is tension between lower-class people and the political figures who, predominantly from
the city of Fez, have taken full control of the country’s economy in the post-independence
era.
The narrative reiterates this relationship, especially when the question concerns
Youssef’s identity:
127
You would expect his eyes on a Fassi, a descendant of the Moors, one of those
pedigreed men who had for generations controlled the destiny of the nation […]
you would not expect those eyes in the melting pot of misery and poverty that was
Hay An Najat. (Lalami 2009a, 11-2)
This episode explains that the division is an inextricably Moroccan characterization of
society, where people are divided in terms of their family names, and on the basis of
which the novel insistently claims its contemporaneity. When Youssef sees a photograph
of the man to be his father, the narrative tells us that “there was only one biographical
detail Youssef could glean from the piece: that Amrani was a Fassi. But with a name like
Amrani, of course, he would have to be from Fes” (Lalami 2009a, 38). To be from Fez
does not necessarily denote living in the city of Fez, since only the family name can
guarantee inclusion within a certain social class.
A few family names, mostly from the city of Fez and either descendants of the
Moors or the Shurfa (descendants of the prophet’s family), sway the politics and the
economy in Morocco. Among these names can be found, El Fassi and Amrani, for
instance, as characters in the novel. As I have demonstrated, the family name is
important in North African societies, and the novel describes this at length especially in
relation to Youssef. When Youssef introduces himself to Alia’s father, the father asks for
Youssef’s family name: “Youssef comment?” (Lalami 2009a, 67). When he says El Mekki
the father continues with no further conversation with him. Bourdieu explains this
division as the principle of classification in social class, whereby “the meaning of the
social world is power over the classificatory schemes […] which are the basis of the
representations of the groups and therefore of their mobilization and demobilization”
(1984, 479).
Division based on social class seems to be the principal logic of social relations in
Morocco, but what is significant in this division is its existence as a condition of
postcoloniality that is endorsed in the term comprador. Kwame Anthony Appiah
describes this contemporaneity
as a condition of what we might ungenerously call a comprador intelligentsia: a
relatively small, Western style, Western-trained group of writers and thinkers, who
mediate the trade in cultural commodities of world capitalism at the periphery. In
the West they are known through the Africa they offer; their compatriots know
them through an Africa they have invented for the world, for each other, and for
Africa. (1991, 348)
Ashcroft et al. define postcoloniality as the mechanism through which a “comprador
intelligentsia”, including academics, artists and writers, forges its notions of
independence through their “reliance on, and identification with, colonial power” (2001,
55). Linked with this definition, class is an important variable in the notion of the
comprador. Ashcroft et al. point out that
128
The notion of a comprador class, whether of capitalists or intellectuals, assumes the
existence of a clear hierarchical structure of cultural and material relations, for it is
arguable that nobody in a colonized society can ever fully avoid the effects of
colonial and neo-colonial cultural power. In post-colonial societies it is by no means
the bourgeoisie alone who have gained ‘access to’ popular cultural media such as
television or consumables such as Coca-Cola. The assumption that a comprador
class is necessarily and identifiably distinct from the rest of the society is therefore
somewhat questionable. (2001, 55)
The novel is conscious of the relationship between inequality and postcoloniality, which
the persona of Amrani manifestly represents. In the post-independent era, Amrani is an
active political figure “preoccupied with his political work, with the petitions he and
Rafael were drafting, the cases they wanted to bring to court, the articles on worker’s
rights that they were trying to publish” (Lalami 2009a, 87). However, this fact is
systematically changed for two reasons: first, as the narrator informs us, he is a son of a
well-known family in Morocco; and, second, he is required to take care of the family
business. This change brings with it frustration for the new generation who cannot afford
to pay extra bills to secure their living, since those who were seen as the defendants of
liberty and freedom have become symbols of oppression.
As the owner of a bus company in Casablanca, Amrani raises the bus fares, which
leads to a protest staged by university students. Amrani, as he confesses near the end of
the novel, is no longer able to “take the risk of wanting change. He started working for
his father in the family business, like his father before him […] Whatever happened in the
nation or the world was not his concern any longer” (2009, 273). His main uneasiness
resides in raising the benefits of his business, which contributes to the disparity between
the social classes in Morocco. This structural inequality is similar to the inequality
maintained by the colonial regimes in Morocco, and the novel compares the nationalist
project in Morocco with those of the colonial period. Thus, Bhabha and Comaroff
maintain that
being colonial or post-colonial is a way of ‘becoming modern’, of surviving
modernity […] that is so central a tenet of liberal individualism […] The disciplinary
and temporal orders of Progress, Rule, Rationality, and the state become corrupted
in the colonial and the postcolonial conditions, where they play a double, aporetic
role: as norms of value they make emancipatory claims, crucial to the definition of
modern citizenship; however, as part of the power practices of the colonial state
they create inequality, injustice, and indignity. (Bhabha and Comaroff 2002, 24)
As the narrative postulates, inequality, injustice, and indignity beguile post-colonial
Morocco, and the narrative critically addresses the ways in which the notion of colonial
oppression is forged in the post-colonial condition in North Africa. The Amrani family, as
a symbol of the comprador, is keen to maintain the social and cultural disparities among
the class fractions, suggesting that the aggressive form of modernity is structural in post-
colonial societies such as those of North Africa. The end limits of each class fraction are
129
clearly observed in the novel in the structuring of Moroccan universities. Universities in
Secret Son are perceived as “jobless factories” (Lalami 2009a, 210), and to have a
university degree may result in their becoming Chômeurs diplômés (unemployed
graduates). The novel demonstrates this aspect in detail when it follows Youssef’s career
as a university student.
Youssef’s university is typical: we meet the offspring of the elite called the Marlboro
and Mercedes group of university students, the Partisans, the Marx-and-Lenin group, the
Berber Student Alliance, and the Sahrawi students (Lalami 2009a, 27-8). When the
protests begin, four groups engage in the events (the Partisans, the Marx-and-Lenins, the
Berbers, and the Sahraouis), while the first group can hardly be seen at events such as
these. Attendance at a university does not necessarily result in the compromise of a
higher education degree. As Alia points out, her attendance is just for fun. She is engaged,
and she is only waiting for her husband to graduate in order to marry him (Lalami 2009a,
68-70). The children of the upper class do not attend national universities. Amal,
Youssef’s sister and Amrani’s legitimate daughter, studies in the United States. Amrani
insistently asks Youssef to think of a better degree because “a degree in English isn’t
going to lead you anywhere” (2009, 138). Lamrani’s request for Youssef to study for a
degree that may “lead” him “somewhere” in his career can be similar to those
compradors who exalt the national education while sending their students to private
schools or abroad for a “better” study. Shapiro explains such an incident as follows:
[i]t has been ironic that those […] who have often been the loudest in their
condemnation of the decline of community and the need for an ethic of social
responsibility, have pursued agendas […] to exert even more dominance in our
social, economic and cultural lives. (2006, 69)
To clarify this aspect, the upper-class families in Morocco prefer to educate their children
at private institutes and colleges: some prefer to send them abroad (Sabour 2003, 165).
The novel represents the university in Morocco as a space denoting the negative aspect of
education. Hence, the presence of policemen at universities becomes part of the
normative discourse. Whenever there is a protest, the police interfere. When, for instance,
the government raises bus fares, all the groups join in the protest against it, and Youssef,
feeling the pleasure of the moment that he belongs with these students, is overjoyed: “he
joined the protestors, letting the excitement of the moment course through him, giving
him the intoxicating feeling that he belonged” (Lalami 2009a, 48). Immediately the police
arrive to break up this group, and many students are injured.
The necessity to unearth inequality factored by postcoloniality is aptly expressed
throughout the narrative. What has originally been simply a resistance group who fought
against inequality and for social justice in the post-independence era are now a group
that enforce social injustice in post-colonial Morocco. There has been a drastic
transformation: members of the post-colonial elite who sought national prosperity now
seek only personal success. It is in no way possible to engage in negotiation after the post-
colonial is transformed into a post-colonial figure: the colonial and the post-colonial are
the same in the context of Secret Son.
130
Farid Benaboud, a journalist and a dear friend of Amrani’s, arrives at Amrani’s
apartment. Benaboud’s meeting with Amrani spells out an example of the post-colonial
transformation. Benaboud writes an article accusing a Moroccan minister of gambling but
without mentioning his/her name, and the result is that the “dossier is already with the
prosecutor”, with the minister asking for five hundred thousand Dirhams compensation
because “his reputation has suffered a blow” (Lalami 2009a, 148). In order to put pressure
on the government, Benaboud’s coeditor suggests that they “put together an open letter”
that “academics, intellectuals, human rights activist” should sign in order to indicate
support for the newspaper (Lalami 2009a, 148). Benaboud’s request for Amrani’s
signature is partly inspired by Amrani’s past role as a political activist who used to sign
petitions against the government. Amrani, however, refuses to sign any letter.
Addressing Benaboud, Amrani points out that Farid is “asking for too much”
(Lalami 2009a, 149). At this point, free speech and calls for change become signs of the
past and of impossible responsibilities: Amrani offers instead to merely help pay part of
the fine. There seems to be a juxtaposition of moral values in this meeting: Benaboud’s
aim does not rest on money, because, as he says “it’s not a question of money. We can
always ask for donations” (Lalami 2009a, 149). Amrani understands that to put his name
to the letter is to risk his career and achievement as a businessman. Thus, it is not
surprising that Benaboud reminds Amrani about his engagement in the past:
Journalists in my generation, we all grew up looking up to people like Nabil
Amrani, like Rafael Levy, like Fatima Bourqia, like Hamid Senhaji—all those who
dared to speak up during the Years of Lead. You wrote so many articles for
opposition newspapers when you were my age. And to have your support now
would make all the difference. (Lalami 2009a, 149)
The issue for Amrani is to avoid risking his social rank in society, because political
engagement would only classify and position him at the center of the conflict. The
nation’s problems are no longer his concern: the motto “to change” does not have any
relevance in his new dictionary. Everything becomes part of history, a history that he
invokes only to secure his interests and position in the Moroccan society as a comprador.
Reflecting on the role of this specific, neo-liberalist group in restructuring social
relations in post-colonial spaces such as Morocco, Lalami’s narrative constantly questions
the notion of the realities on which individuals can base their decision to belong. Nabil
Amrani chooses not to risk the career that has taken him years to achieve as a
businessman and well-established figure in Moroccan society. Identification with the neo-
liberalists – the new bourgeoisie, a class or a category of Moroccans that is a born and
bred part of a resistance group and part of the post-independent movement, indicates a
different perspective to belonging. This is a blatantly attractive example of the space that
a post-colonial elite could inhabit if they were to relegate their national allegiances and
struggles for a minority voice to a secondary level of prioritization. This is not to say that
all the post-colonial elites are in the same mold. However, the novel does not offer any
example of those who might refuse to join the will of the new bourgeoisie cult and
concentrate instead on their struggle for change. The only instance one could draw on
131
relates to the journalist Benaboud who, because of his writing on Islamist groups in
Casablanca, is assassinated by a young university student from the slum of Hay An Najat.
Consequently, the narrative suggests another means of transcendence in which the
notion of unbelonging can suggest alternative possibilities for overriding the aggressive
notion of modernity. Amrani takes a risk in leaving his son Youssef on behalf of his
daughter, but only to secure his territoriality. In the end, he has neither a son nor a
daughter, and in a passage echoing the disillusionment evident in some post-colonial
literature, he thinks it is too late to acknowledge that something has gone wrong:
When did things fall apart? Men of his generation were children of ’56, children of
the independence. Like them, he had signed petitions for the release of Saida
Mnebhi, written articles for Lamalif, spent hours in Rafael Levey’s smoky living
room discussing Frantz Fanon or Mehdi Ben Barka, closed down his law office
during general strikes, denounced the imposition by the World Bank and the IMF of
a structural adjustment plan, called these institutions “tools of neocolonialism par
excellence”, collected money for the families of those killed during the bread riots of
1981. Those were years when he still dared to dream, when he was still full of love
for his country. (Lalami 2009a, 272-3)
This passage is a chronicle of the outrageous death of political activists such as Saida
Mnebhi: a human rights activist during the 1970s in Morocco, a member of the “union
nationale des étudiants du Maroc” (student union), and a member of the “union
marocaine du travail” (labor union). During the Years of Lead between 1970s and 1980s,
in 1976 she was sentenced to 6 years in jail. She died in prison after pursuing a hunger
strike with other prisoners for 40 days in 1977 (Orlando 2010, 279). Ben Barka was a
politician, socialist, and mathematics teacher of King Hassan the Second, who was his
principle opponent. Ben Barka, a leader of the “tiers-mondiste et panafricaniste
movements” and the secretary of the “Union Nationale des Forces Populaires (UNFP)”,
disappeared in Paris in 1965. Lamalif was a newspaper that formed a new way of protest
against corruption in Morocco.
In her essay “The Lamalif Years”, Lalami tells the story of a newspaper that was
published for 22 years:
The magazine was a form of challenge (the title comes from the Arabic letters lam
and ‘alif, which together spell out the word “No”). It was the expression of a
homegrown movement. It had amazing art covers. It was ours […] it published
high-quality articles on politics, art, and culture. Its contributors were seasoned
journalists, intellectuals, and, more often than not, university professors. It was
informed and informative, and I have often wondered what it would be like today if
it had survived as a publication. (Constant pressures by the government forced the
magazine to shut down in 1988). (2007, n.p.)
The passage apparently elaborates on a fundamental characteristic that defines minority
literature and its political nature, and corroborates what Deleuze and Guattari postulate:
132
its cramped space forces each individual intrigue to connect immediately to politics.
The individual concern thus becomes all the more necessary, indispensable,
magnified, because a whole other story is vibrating within it. In this way, the family
triangle connects to other triangles – commercial, economic, bureaucratic, juridical –
that determine its values. (Deleuze and Guattari 1986, 17)
The narrative represents the situation between the 1970s and early 1990s in this
geographical space as critical. The more that corruption and injustice is entrenched in the
society, the more the narrative alludes to the collective voices to enunciate their
politically connected perspective. Here the political is amalgamated with the concerns of
the individual in a much larger web of enunciations referring to the power structure of
minority literature. The figures that the narrative names are real, their sacrifice was for
the nation, and their sufferings were for a voice. But what if these historical figures had
survived postcoloniality? They might have become, as the novel tells us, people like
Nabil Amrani, who revolts against the groups’ moral values and indulges, instead, in his
own business. Lamalif chronicles the post-colonial history and the suffering of a group of
people who sacrifice their life for the prosperity of the nation. This might be a reminder
of the narrative for those intellectuals to reconsider their status in the post-colonial
condition in order to accentuate a rather different position in this society.
In a significant way, the narrative techniques and style that Lalami employs
underline two simultaneous processes: re-writing and writing back. In the passage where
Amrani asks the question “When did things fall apart?” is an intertextual reference to the
work of the post-colonial writer Chinua Achebe and his Things Fall Apart. There are
numerous instances in which Lalami aims to re-write the history of Morocco and write
back through intertextuality. The idea of home and homelands is also central to the
structure of the novel; Rushdie’s Imaginary Homelands has been considered partly a
bibliography that points to the post-colonial transformation (Lalami 2009a, 260). The title
of Chapter 7 “Son and Lover” is yet another intertextual reference to D. H. Lawrence’s
Sons and Lovers, through which the author aims at comparing the social status of, on the
one hand, Yussef and his mother, and Amrani, his wife and daughter, and, on the other
hand, Gertrude Coppard, Walter Morel, and their family in Sons and Lovers. “Heir to the
Past”, the title of Chapter 8, refers to the Moroccan Francophone writer Driss Chraibi’s
novel Heirs to the Past. In the same way that Driss Chraibi attempts to describe the society
of Morocco after independence in 1956, Laila Lalami tries to make the reader aware of
such a narrative and further explains that Secret Son can contribute to such pre-existing
representations, but only in another tongue. Joseph Conrad’s The Secret Agent is referred
to in the opening of Part 4 in order to foreground the theme of terrorism that the author
claims to be the concern of globalism.
In this regard, it is possible to assume that Secret Son claims to make new forms of
writing back and re-writing modernity accessible to the new generation to negotiate
belonging in post-colonial Morocco. This will be discussed in the following section. While
the novel charts these possibilities, it voices the assumption that the comprador has
already lost his/her grip in the novel’s new Morocco and that belonging itself is no longer
133
a matter of fixity but one of the ubiquity of the notion of unbelonging over post-colonial
subjectivities. The “prosecution” of the Lamalif newspaper indicates the close of a chapter
in Moroccan history and the opening of a new one. This chapter or moment dwells
primarily on the importance of the period of transformation that exists between post-
independence and post-colonialism. Lamalif, as the narrative indicates, is one such
possibility for sustaining the notion of re-writing, dating back as it does to the Years of
Lead in the novel’s Morocco.
To understand this transformation in the post-colonial space and the shift that
transforms identities from belonging into unbelonging, it is necessary to trace the
transition by following the character of Amal, in particular. Amal, Amrani’s daughter,
longs for alternative forms of belonging. These she finds in America first, and secondly in
her Brazilian-American boyfriend, Fernando. Her refusal to belong to the comprador
class and her decision to travel back to the United States to live with Fernando may incur
more than a single interpretation. First, it shows that such an escape is an escape from the
past, which signals a form of refusing to live with her father. This refusal can also be
interpreted as a rejection of the form of modernity introduced by the compradors. Second,
transculturality can offer a new milieu for cross-cultural reading beyond the boundaries
of culture itself. Third, it is the urgency to forge a new sense of belonging that may
position post-colonial identity in the center of transcultural belonging. Nevertheless, the
novel shows that anyone who fails to deterritorialize the post-colonial space also fails to
figure out her/his belonging, and ultimately s/he will also fail to reterritorialize her/his
“old” positions. It is this point – transcultural belonging – on which I would like to
elaborate next.
5.4 TOWARDS A TRANSCULTURAL UN/BELONGING
The colonial legacy of Morocco is remarkably present in the novel in the neo-liberalist
“prospectus” for the nation. But to be part of this general representation might not be a
choice for the new generation. The narrative attempts to reroute postcoloniality in
Morocco in order to carve out possibilities for living beyond the social and cultural
matrix that obstructs the voice of minorities. To shape the contour of the modern
Morocco, the narrative explores the lives of those who choose to live in the margin, like
Amal, whose unbelonging remains an aspect of her identity construction. The novel also
suggests that living transculturally can foster the medium to reroute post-coloniality,
enabling identity to verge on the singularity of the postcolonial subject. In negotiating
globalization, the novel suggests, that to succeed one needs to become a transcultural,
post-colonial subject.
Amal and her brother Youssef each in her/his own way are concrete examples of
this process. On the one hand, Youssef does not want to live in the slums and his mastery
of both French and English is one example of an alternative path to a better life in
Morocco. These facts, coupled with rejuvenation of a paternal relationship (on the part of
his father), inspire Youssef to limit the possibilities of a new form of modernity to class.
In other words, Youssef sees that, in order to reconstruct his identity, he should live with
his father and do what his father asks him to do. Amal, on the other hand, does not rely
134
on class to liberate herself from the condition of postcoloniality that her father represents.
Instead, she sees that her belonging dwells in the liminal space of unbelonging. Even
though Amal chooses to live in the diaspora, she refuses to identify with the locals. Yet
her choice to live with a hybrid American generates the understanding that
transculturality is perceived as the ultimate solution for post-colonial belonging.
In addition, it can be noted that Helff’s typology (2009) on the transcultural novel
operates on three levels. On the first level, globalization is noticeable in Yussef’s failure to
negotiate the two main global flows: being recruited by the Party or by the Hotel. His
failure is represented by the end of the novel, when he relents and joins the Party to
become a terrorist. On the second level, the novel focuses on certain individualized
realities to provide the reader with different points of view of the characters and their
identities. On the third level, the narrator is an unreliable source of information. In order
to clarify the processes underlying this typology, I will refer to the characters Yussef and
Amal and the ways in which they negotiate their belonging within global transculturality.
The subliminal aspects in Youssef direct him to consider other sources in order to
overcome the pressures of living in the slums with no relatives, apart from his mother.
These are explicitly featured when Youssef answers the teacher’s question about the
meaning of Daisy in The Great Gatsby: “She is the Dream – Gatsby’s dream” (Lalami 2009a,
31). Precisely, it is also Youssef’s dream to find his path out of the social injustice that is
entrenched in many aspects of Morocco. In reading The Great Gatsby in the atmosphere of
the Moroccan universities, the narrative attempts to connect the local with the global, in
which the new emerges from cultural permeation. Gatsby’s dream is to revive his relation
with Daisy, while for Youssef the apogee of success rests in his climbing out of the slum.
Seeing a photograph of a man whom he later discovers to be his father may be similar to
Nick’s meeting with Gatsby, yet the similarity could only be viewed in terms of the
father’s reunification with the son (old friends, in the case of Gatsby).
Youssef needs urgently to find his identity and his belonging, and the novel
describes this action in respect to his ability to accept the first option available to him.
When he joins the protestors, for instance, he is sure that he will be treated severely by
the university guards (police). The feeling of belonging that he misses may be found in
the university students, and this has overridden his fear: “he joined the protestors, letting
the excitement of the moment course through him, giving him the intoxicating feeling
that he belonged” (Lalami 2009a, 48).
With Alia in her family’s house, Youssef claims an identity that is not his, as he is
careful not to make a single mistake in order not to be identified. Youssef thinks that
intimacy with these people implies conduct that will correlate with their standards. As a
result, when Alia looks at Youssef, he thinks that “something in her expression made him
wonder whether she had recognized him for who he was. He straightened his back and
drank carefully, afraid to make one false move and reveal himself” (Lalami 2009a, 68).
Performing false identities is not a permanent act, but one that saves him from the
demeaning gestures involved in the process of giving his family name.
Thus, it may be useful to consider the instances on which Secret Son represents the
dreams of the new generations in Morocco. At the age of seventeen, Youssef finds his
father, who initially agrees to introduce him to his family. The paternal relation becomes
135
significant for Youssef, and the feeling of belonging once again seizes his thought: “He
walked slowly up in the street toward the bus station, wondering what it would be like to
live here, in Anfa, with people like the Alaouis, the Filalis, the El Fassis – and the
Amranis. He could be one of them” (Lalami 2009a, 70). Even though Youssef openly
admires the way of life of the upper-middle class, he does not want to deny totally his
belonging to his mother. This can be seen when Amrani and Youssef discuss the latter’s
future and what he wants to be. Youssef seems not to ask for too much, since he only
wants to be himself and not imitate anyone else (Lalami 2009a, 91).
In effect, Youssef’s decision to live with his father ends in tears. Youssef is placed in
a situation in which he needs to decide between his past and future (mother and father),
resulting in his disguising and concluding his past. At first, the decision is very hard to
take. The father wants him to “make a clean break. Start fresh” (Lalami 2009, 124). But
Youssef is not aware of this choice, because the essential aspect of such a choice dwells in
the ability to replace the old part with the new. He has not also wanted to make a “clean
break” with his friends at all; they have been a part of his life, part of who he has been.
Yet he is tempted by the promise inherent in his father’s words: “a new beginning with
his father, a chance to rewrite his life” (Lalami 2009, 124). Ultimately, an old part of
Youssef’s life has been cleared and replaced with the new, and the past no longer exists in
Youssef’s present. At this point, it is important to ask why it is The Great Gatsby that the
narrative introduces and not any other narrative from the same era, such as Ernest
Hemingway’s, for instance? The Gatsby character recreates his own history in The Great
Gatsby by entirely erasing his real past when he moves to West Egg. No one knows him
in the place, or where he comes from, except for the lavish parties he organizes every
Saturday. Youssef El Mekki wants to do the same: he wants to create a new past, a new
identity, and cut any connection with the history of Hay An Najat.
This aspect may partly explain why Youssef uses the name “Amrani”, rather than
“El Mekki”, when he meets with El Filali (Lalami 2009a, 134). But does this return to the
father and the break with the past (his mother) signify what Chinua Achebe calls “an act
of atonement with the past, the ritual return and homage of a prodigal son"? (1995, 193
emphasis added). If the answer is positive, a return to a copied system of colonization in
post-colonial Morocco is “a dreadful betrayal and produces a guilty feeling” (Achebe
1975, 62). Even though Achebe points here to language, I assume that the mother tongue
is relevant to the notion of the past (mother). Consequently, the rejection of the past in
order to identify with the neo-liberalist comprador is what the narrative attempts to
criticize.
At the very moment that Youssef indulges in the act of forgetting his past, he
foregrounds a new one where past and present no longer formulate the notion of the
“post” that Bhabha advocates. While Youssef can be said to encounter “newness” (cf.
Bhabha 1994, 7-18), such an encounter operates only on the national level. The continuity
of the past in the future through the present does not function here, and the ability to
remain hybrid, to live in-between, is blurred at the moment when Youssef chooses to part
company with his mother and friends in Hay An Najat. Instead of deterritorialization, he
merely reiterates the notion of reterritorialization. As Youssef is unable to negotiate his
past in the present when his father leaves him for the sake of his sister, he starts to look
136
for alternative forms of belonging, which he finds, as the narrative explains, in the
fundamentalists’ idea of betrayals and brainwashing. Though the narrative elaborates
only cursorily on this aspect, it shows that the past is an important aspect for identity to
be reconstructed in the present.
Youssef’s failure to deterritorialize his territory can be seen as a failure to
accommodate to his own identity and to negotiate global transformation. The novel
explains this failure on at least three levels. The first level concerns scholarship and how
Yussef fails to earn his college degree. As a student of English, Youssef insistently desires
to be a member of the Marlboro and Mercedes group, and if English symbolizes
globalization, both “Marlboro” and “Mercedes” suggest global trademarks. At some
point Youssef believes that his relationship with Alia can help him to access this global
atmosphere. In breaking with Alia and with his inability to complete his education,
Youssef is forced to look for alternatives. On a second level, Youssef works for his father
in the hotel, but only for a short period. Due to the interference of his mother the
international business does not work for him, resulting in his expulsion from the hotel.
Youssef’s desire for a Green Card becomes the last level on which he is unable to
accommodate his identity with the global transformation that his society undergoes.
When Youssef no longer works in the hotel and after his chance to continue his studies
has been restricted, he intends to apply for a Green Card Lottery through a local agent.
The novel then tells us that the local agent escapes with all the money that he collects
from Youssef and others like him. Such a trajectory forces the mother to imagine travel
for her son when she says, addressing his sister Amal, that Youssef “left for Tangier three
weeks ago. He’s going to start over in Europe” (Lalami 2009a, 264). This imaginary status
does not endorse Youssef’s ambition to become a global subject, and ultimately forces
him to join the Party and indulge in terrorist acts. Youssef fails to become part of the
global system and, as the novel suggests, he is placed in-between two alternative global
flows, i.e., the Party and the Grand Hotel, the mother and the father.
If Yussef fails to negotiate globalization, Amal seems to represent the other form of
transitive belonging. She does not refer to imagination but operates within the system,
and at the moment when she feels that globalization fails in her society Amal manages to
travel to a place where she can re-create her own home. Amal cannot bear inhabiting only
parts of the post-colonial space given to her. This rejection is the result of a long process
of negotiation between the self and the social and cultural aspects of life in Morocco. It is
important to note that the filiations of Amal – to differentiate herself from the
pressurizing milieu of family and class – cannot be excluded from the transcultural
configurations of belonging and the notion of home. There is a contrapuntal process at
work here: cultural identities are replaced by transcultural belonging, and the meaning of
home, from a diasporic perspective, is redefined by the singularity of the subject. Part 3 of
Secret Son begins with an epigraph from James Baldwin’s Giovanni’s Room to the effect
that “[p]erhaps home is not a place but simply an irrevocable condition” (Lalami 2009a,
155). This epigraph is, perhaps, the narrative device through which the notions of
belonging, home, and identity are revisited and reconstructed in various ways.
Amal’s first encounter with Fernando is reminiscent of the discussion on Imaginary
Homelands, and her devotion to “the part about growing up kissing books and bread”
137
(Lalami 2009a, 260) is significant for the new meaning of Amal’s home. The allusion to
such work as Salman Rushdie’s implies more than a single interpretation. First, the
notion of home for Amal has been deconstructed, and belonging does not necessarily
emphasize place but the interweaving of locations and the permeation of cultures across
borders. This definition seems to carve out the potential elements that a home could
inhabit. Second, Amal prominently acknowledges the importance of this notion of
unbelonging the first time that she travels to the United States. When Amal wants to sell
her car, she has to confront racist perceptions of her cultural and ethnic origins;
something in her is “telling her she did not belong. So she knew. She knew what it felt
like” (Lalami 2009a, 266). In relation to this constructed notion of home, Salman
Rushdie’s home dwells in his past. To grow up “kissing books and bread” may suggests
that Amal’s present becomes what Salman Rushdie calls “foreign, and that the past is
home” (1991, 9). This tendency to draw comparisons between Rushdie’s home and
Amal’s may emphasize the notion of “mobile homes”, where the past becomes the static
construction of home, while the notion of home in the present remains an example of
mobility.
Third, not to belong does not necessarily imply cancellation of the sense of identity,
but it is a way to renew and reconfigure new sites of belonging. This case is explicit when
Amal indulges in self-negotiation of the new meanings that she wishes to bestow on the
notion of home as part of the process of identity construction. But her preference for
studying at an American university assumes her decision to reconstruct a global identity.
Amal has experience of being both at home and away: “She had known both; found good
in both; loved and hated both. She did not want to have to choose one or another,
because in every choice something is gained but something is also lost” (Lalami 2009a,
266). To understand the act of identity transformation in Amal, it is important to turn to
Beck, who reminds us in his The Cosmopolitan Vision that the life and body of the subject’s
“‘individual existence’ become part of another world, of foreign cultures, religions,
histories and global interdependencies” without the intention of expressing this sense of
belonging (2006, 19).
It is not surprising to encounter the demand for an explicitly deconstructivist notion
of home on the part of the post-colonial subjects in the novel. Amal asks rhetorically
“why home is thought of as a place? What if it were something else?” (Lalami 2009a, 266).
Sabina Brancato justifiably points out that, in such circumstances, when the focus is
shifted from the group identity onto its individual construction, “[t]he focus is often
placed on the concept of home, no longer to be identified as a country but, rather, as a
private space, no matter where it is, where one feels comfortable” (2009, 244).
Moreover, reliance on the singularity of the post-colonial subject is what defines the
notion of unbelonging and describes the process of identity construction from the post-
colonial to the transcultural. Amal rejects her mother’s pleas for her to return home, her
father’s representation of the comprador’s life, and the cultural definition of voice. Her
mother insistently reminds Amal that she belongs in Morocco: “in your country, with
your family. What will you do there?” (Lalami 2009a, 269). Although Amal understands
the risks involved in her choice, her transcultural belonging is thought of as the only way
to liberate the self from the limited notion of culture. To refuse to belong to her nation
138
and to her culture is illuminating. First, the understanding that cultural inheritance is
deeply entrenched in the construction of one’s self has been acknowledged by Amal,
especially when she reveals her understanding of such a cultural inheritance to her
mother. This means that rejection is not understood as obliteration, but merely as
transition and translation onto a much larger level where cultures are defined by the
notion of ubiquity and permeation. Second, the importance of anchoring the self as the
source of belonging emphasizes the singularity of subjectivity as an important element in
effectuating such transition/translation from being pos-tcolonial to being transcultural:
home becomes the space where one feels at home.
Another element that is pertinent to this discussion is the importance of the
character Fernando. Half Brazilian and half American, he inspires Amal to revolt against
all the cultural and social aspects that predefine her identity. Early in the novel, Nabil
Amrani’s encounter with Fernando aims at demeaning Fernando’s ethnic background, in
the sense that he does not fit in with “us”, and this is explicitly shown when Amrani tells
his daughter “I thought you said he was American” (Lalami 2009a, 164). The narrator
further describes this incident in a meeting between Fernando and Amal’s parents: “Her
parents were carefully picking Fernando apart, Amal knew, demonstrating to each other
and to her that he did not fit in their world” (Lalami 2009a, 184). This description is an
attempt to make Amal part company with Fernando. For Amal, however, Fernando
represents more than a lover. He is a transcultural figure and a minoritarian in the United
States, and her identification with him seems to offer her consolidation against the
burden of postcoloniality at home. Even though her parents succeed at least, partially, in
convincing her that her essential belonging lies in her home country, such a realization
resides in her search for alternative sites of belonging while in Casablanca.
Home is now Morocco, and America is away, and the smells of her home only
problematize her identity. Guided by similar concerns, Amal decides to look for her
brother Youssef. This has been viewed as the only way to re-identify with those whom
she feels she shares similarities. The failure to reach Youssef rapidly sustains Amal’s
identity reconstruction. The narrative describes this at length:
It was over before it had even begun. There would be no relationship with Youssef,
and life in Casablanca would continue in the same way it had before. Sometimes,
Amal felt like a fish that had been taken out of water and put back; she was finding
it difficult to breath […] In a city of five million, she felt unaccountably, incredibly
alone. What was left? Who was left? (Lalami 2009a, 264; emphasis original)
Amal’s identity is set in a liminal space; she is unable to decide exactly what belonging
would mean for her in Morocco. Though she has to choose between Fernando and her
home, Amal’s choice of Morocco destabilizes her identity. In this vein, Amal
acknowledges that her belonging dwells in the very moment of transculturality and
difference. Thus, the intersection of the notion of belonging with the essential home is not
an aspect of living in a global world. Difference – the main aspect upon which Amal’s
parents have built their decision and force her to choose their home – “no longer emerges
between different kinds of monolithic identities, but between identity configurations that
139
have some elements in common while differing in other elements, in their arrangement
as a whole, and often in their complexity” (Welsch 2009, 9).
A certain level of changed realities and life can be understood from this discussion:
the traditional definition of belonging vis-à-vis home is renewed, and identity is tied to
singularity more than it is to the collective. “[T]he idea of cultural origin and home” has
already transformed as an effect of transculturality (Wilfried and Isensee 2008, 3).
However illuminating, this intention does not imply that the present narrative does not
speak in a collective enunciation. Quite the contrary, the singularity of the subject is an
important stage predating minority voices. In other words, in order to tell the stories of
the minoritarians, rather than speaking on their behalf, the character needs to operate
her/his singularity. As a result, silence, as it is argued, is not a matter of absence; rather it
is a yearning to engage with the other, and the incommensurability of living with the
other through the singularity of that individual (McLeod 2010, n.p.).
Subsequently, this argument seems to explain Amal’s longing for an alternative
belonging: “She left him [Fernando] behind, trading his love for the love of father and
mother, the love of country, the love of home. She had been told to make a choice, and
though she still had no idea why, she had chosen” (Lalami 2009a, 260). The notion of
living like the other dismantles the notion of post-colonialism in Amal, and drives her to
start another process of identity construction. She decides to construct another meaning
for her home that goes beyond the imperatives of family and the nation. In other words, a
moment of conversation, as McLeod (2010) calls it, means a yearning for a renewed
notion of transcultural identity. In order for Amal to “renew” her identity, she leaves
behind her father “for the sake of that man, just as he had left Youssef behind for her
sake” (Lalami 2009a, 271), and as Raussert and Isensee remind us, “[y]ou do not have to
live in the same place in order to live together. On the other hand, existence in the same
place does not necessarily mean living together” (2008, 2). It is clear that Amal does not
feel at home either in the United States or in Morocco, and to compare the locations is
essentially not a choice in its own right. It is the notion of engagement with the other
(Fernando) that substantiates the singularity of Amal’s identity in order to communicate
the minoritarian’s struggle at home and overseas.
It is hard, though, to estimate the accuracy of transcultural belonging in
postcolonial Morocco. In the meantime, the novel suggests that being tied to the ordinary
notion of home may not result in a deterritorialized space of enunciation. Instead, it
blocks any notion of liberation and advances the subject to a remote past existing in the
memory. The narrative directs the reader to think of this assumption, and what happens
to Youssef could illuminate such a premise. Taking him as an example, the narrative
implies that Youssef is not capable of transcending the notion of home, which is
represented in his mother. As I mentioned in the previous sections, the silent Moroccan
woman (Rachida) is unable to express her identity beyond the space she is offered, but
she does so when she is commited to the transcultural pardigm of belonging. This
conclusion projects on Youssef’s inability to construct an identity beyond his motherland.
Youssef’s belonging dwells in his mother/home, and meanwhile Youssef remains his
mother’s reason d’être: “In the end, she was his only home” (Lalami 2009a, 283). The
narrative, in a subtle way, assumes that deterritorialization and voice can only succeed
140
when the postcolonial subject is able to transform and belong transculturally. Youssef
cannot gain access to this medium, because he fails to negotiate globalization and limits
his belonging to his mother. In contrast, belonging, for Amal, is something different,
going beyond the normative labels of home (mother, country, or family). The novel, in
this regard, suggests that it is only through transculturality that the postcolonial subject
can voice the agonies of the minoritarian in North Africa. In so doing, it points to new
voices that are emerging in the margins of postcolonialism, and which can be heard
through the “other, other literature”.
***
In this chapter, I have sought to demonstrate how the notions of identity and home are
not fixed constructions. Secret Son illustrates that the importance of belonging rests in the
singularity of the post-colonial subject, and that neither Yussef nor Amal is in position to
define what belonging or home mean for the post-colonial subject. Secret Son also
confirms the desire to engage with others without necessarily comparing the self with the
other probable stories. The narrative is critical of postcoloniality in the ways in which the
comprador substitutes the colonial system of oppression with a post-colonial one.
Corruption and domination assume the subordination and submission of the weaker
parts in society. If the weaker part pretends not to break silence against these models,
s/he will only territorialize an earlier position, and she may therefore think of violent
rebuke, as in the case of Amin, who “stuck the knife in Benaboud’s neck” (Lalami 2009a,
288), and Youssef, who is arrested for this murder.
To engage in a “moment of conversation” and to transmit a voice from the margin
of post-colonial North Africa means to deterritorialize language, forming new sites of
belonging and seeking a transcultural identity. These can be exemplified, as the narrative
suggests, in the transformation of the English language, using words from the local
Moroccan language and in self-translating the oppression of post-colonial subjectivities.
Seeking a cosmopolitan readership may assume a certain level of authenticity, an aspect
to which Laila Lalami addresses herself, which the novel has to be a multilingual genre.
Not all translations are perceived as accurate, and not every instance made in
transforming the language can be transcultural. It is, however, worth considering that
Laila Lalami, as a Moroccan/American who lives, teaches, and writes in the United States,
can at least account for and sustain Deleuze and Guattari’s views on minority literature.
Taking, for instance, a review by Bahdur, we can see that appropriating such a narrative
in the American context might lead to an act of deterritorialization:
But something has been lost in her attempt to bypass translation: perhaps it’s the
cadences of the inner courtyards of her upbringing. Her English prose, although
clean and closely observed, lacks music, and her similes can be predictable. (Bahdur
2009, n.p.)
The importance of transcultural belonging emerges in relation to all these aspects, which
the narrative attempts to chart. The only opportunity for the post-colonial minoritarian
141
subject to liberate her/his self from the oppression of postcoloniality seems to take place
through seeking refuge in transcultural belonging within a global space. One clue to such
belonging is not-to-bind to the notion of home as a place to return to, which ultimately
means to reterritorialize and submit to the prevalent identity conflict. Nevertheless,
deterritorialization can induce ways out of this impasse and help to transform
subjectivity from being post-colonial to being transcultural, with particular emphasis on
the singularity of the subject.
As Lalami is part of a minority group in the United States, the interweaving of her
cultural aspects into the majority language could be seen as a defect by the majority
groups. This defect has twofold results: first, Deleuze and Guattari remind us that this
defect can be acceptable, since it may be the only route leading to deterritorialization.
Second, when the aspect of deterritorialization occurs, transculturality remains the space
of negotiation within which the singularity of subjectivities is sustained. With her self-
transition/translation of Secret Son, Lalami seeks to find the route to liberate herself from
the nostalgia inherent in the French language and the post-colonial condition of Morocco.
Nevertheless, Bahdur’s critique does not necessarily imply desertion; rather, it postulates
that Lalami’s identity is suffering from dislocation and suggests that she might be lost in
translation. Provided that her narrative is an exemplary novel in which authenticity is
problematized, being lost in translation would only further her unbelonging.
The narrative also suggests that Helff’s typology may explain the constant changes
within identities of the characters in the novel. The narrative structure in which
uncertainty dominates the thoughts of Youssef and his mother, for instance, cultivates
identities in a constant flux. The novel also ïlluminates individualized realities as aspects
of the global identities, where subjectivities dwell in their incommensurability.
Another issue that is relevant to my discussion of Secret Son develops with the role
played by politics. It is important to note that the narrative’s structure is not linear, even
though there are instances where the events can be predictable. This is probably because
of the novel’s dependence on political issues as prominent elements in its structure.
Politics is discussed in this narrative as a tool that pushes characters to seek alternative
modes of modernity. Political inscriptions are either extremist liberalist or radical
Islamists, and in both ways society still suffers from corruption.
The novel also shows that Americanization is begining to permeate the novel’s
Moroccan society. The emphasis on trademarks such as Marlboro represents yet another
process of Americanization of the mind. Such a process is already underway, and to
study in American colleges or to teach American literature such as The Great Gatsby in
English departments may be another example. Ultimately, it should be noted that
transculturality is a significant denominator for the North African novel in English. It
suggests that in order to escape postcoloniality and to long for alternative forms of
modernity, the North African needs to consider alternative sites of belonging, which this
novel suggests can be found in transculturality.
143
6 Conclusion
In an attempt to re-imagine the field of North African literary studies, I have focused my
analysis on novels written in the English language by writers from North Africa. I have
initiated my hypothesis by contesting the notion of writing back advocated in The Empire
Writes Back, suggesting that transculturality is a discourse of the major minorities that can
help locate the emerging North African novel in English.
I began my study by examining the novels chronologically: Si Yussef focuses on the
questions of place and history, and the ways in which the past can be deployed to inform
the present and demarcate the post-colonial place. Waiting in the Future for the Past to
Come contributes to the debates on gender, space, and identity. It negotiates the space of
minoritarians in both the colonial and the post-colonial eras, and contributes by
suggesting the means to demarctae the space occupied by the post-colonial woman. Secret
Son mainly discusses postcoloniality and ways to re-route post-colonialism in order to
create a transcultural belonging. The study has explained that the narratives emphasize
location as a way to make deterritorialization absolute in the sense introduced by
Deleuze and Guattari. In order to clarify these aspects, this study has revealed that the
North African Anglophone novel demonstrates that it is able to flourish as a post-colonial
Anglophone narrative: its location as a North African narrative in English
deterritorializes both the French colonial discourse and also the theories that sustain its
power as the main discursive structure in the region. In other words, to argue that French
discourse maintains power over its former colony in North Africa, or that Britain still
haunts, for instance, the Indian discursive structure, may no longer be the case in the era
of cultural globalization. The North African Anglophone writer begins writing in English
because s/he needs to deconstruct the colonial legacy in North Africa away from the
power of its structure. To do so, the North African novel in English creates new
epistemologies that focus mainly on the narrative in the margin of post-colonialism.
These discursive shifts in North African literature have resulted in various
theoretical and methodological challenges that further problematize the process of
generating new approaches and tools so as to locate the emerging literature in English.
This study has attempted to demonstrate that, since the discourse of post-colonialism has
become an aspect of theoretical contestation, post-colonial theory seems to challenge any
possibility of the post-colonial subject starting a process of writing back. This study has
observed that, to regard the post-colonial text as a minoritarian textual bricolage in which
the lines of the binary minor/major are becoming blurred, can be seen as a sign of
theoretical “inventiveness” in the sense introduced by Attridge (cf. 2004). Working
towards achieving this goal, this study has emphasized the notion of transculturality and
suggested that the North African novel needs to contribute to the notion of translation,
where the focus is placed mainly on the multiplicity of languages rather than on the
meaning of translation.
144
As a result, translation becomes a significant reference to the spatial and temporal
differences of the post-colonial subject and takes into consideration the variations that
exist across cultures and between the text and its context. The post-colonial
writer/translator may need to redefine the space of translation, because translation as a
mode of writing back remains the means to demarcate the spaces of post-colonial,
imagined communities. This suggestion emerges partly from the weight that the notion
of space has placed on post-colonial writing, especially in the aspect that concerns
translating the original into its Becoming original.
I have also attempted to explain how important the idea of space is for the North
African writer, especially in writing back. Even though I have contested the notion of
writing back established in the study by Ashcroft et al., the present study has confirmed
that the North African does initiate the act of writing in order to justify the existence of
space. Her/his aims reside firstly in redefining the minority discourse and then re-writing
it so as to establish a firm foundation for ways that s/he can engage in debating
alternative forms of modernity.
The North African Anglophone novel is a narrative of the minoritarian in the ways
in which Deleuze and Guattari define the term. This kind of writing represents a
revolutionary notion of a narrative that breaks with all that is cultural, social, and
historical. It also appears to foreground a new history that springs mainly from the
notion of a countermemory emerging as part of the minority novel. In addition, these
minority narratives seem to create different meanings for the notion of place and space.
In Chapter 3, for instance, home becomes the past that the North African subject can refer
to as her/his origin. In this respect, the past that the North African minoritarian attempts
to re-write is not included in the post-colonial archive. Instead, it has been neglected, and
it is because of this neglect that the North African Anglophone writer begins the process
of writing and re-writing spaces that may no longer exist, such as that of Tangier. In
order to reveal the success of this process, this study has explained that the North African
Anglophone novel evokes the notions of lieux de mémoire and magical realism in order to
formulate a counter-version of memory.
The notion of home has also been viewed differently, and sometimes the act of
writing itself becomes the essential home for the writer. The language, the English
language, in which the North African writes her/his text becomes his/her own home that
s/he seeks to refine according to her/his cultural, historical, and political ideals. The text
has become a site of belonging in which identities negotiate their space of belonging
through the insertion of untranslated words, long sentences, and speeches, and in order
to direct the attention of the reader to the origin of the text itself, the language undergoes
transformation. In so doing, the text remains a context for the act of writing back.
Moreover, the notion of home that this present study has offered does not correlate with
the meanings that define home as a fixed construct. On the contrary, Chapter 3 has
elaborated that home can suggest away, and to use the notion of magical realism is to
argue that the North African aims to align rather with post-colonial minorities in a global
context than with canonized post-colonial local subjects. Accordingly, the study has
noted that the use of magical realism suggests a deconstruction of the Euro-American
notions of truth, for instance, and in so doing, it has claimed that the new meanings may
145
ever re-route post-colonialism. No one has a total claim on truth and reality, and to claim
that the colonial discourse has shaped the colonies, or that the post-colonial already re-
writes the history of natives, can be contested, because magical realism accentuates a
certain sense of oblivion.
On this level, all of the elements that signify new routes in post-colonialism seem to
deconstruct themselves, and among them we can find the notion of space. Chapter 4 has
presented a different perspective on the notion of space as it signifies diaspora. The
character of Amina, for instance, does not make her return from Britain to stay in Tunisia.
Her return becomes a mere re-turn where the two syllables in the word are emphasized.
The North African does not feel at home either when s/he is in North Africa or when s/he
is away, but the complexities of the cultural politics of the notion of space give it a sense
of mobility suggesting that the North African needs to adapt the self to it. Because home
signifies imprisonment for the woman in North Africa, to make this re-turn is as if one is
forced to confirm the trajectory of diaspora when s/he is separated from home.
Consequently, this study has shown that the notion of space in North Africa can
connote two aspects. The first aspect concerns the space occupied by gender in North
Africa. This study has showed that the North African Anglophone novel is critical of the
notion of space when it is dominated by men, and it has explained that if a woman wants
to act in her space, she needs to deterritorialize the space within which she is embedded.
It seems to be impossible to reiterate such a process in North Africa, especially when the
woman is not educated. As demonstrated in Chapters 4 and 5, only the educated woman
can succeed in deterritorializing her position in society, either by choosing to be
diasporan (the case of Amina) or by becoming a transcultural (the case of Rachid and
Amal) respectively. The second aspect of space concerns the act of writing. This study has
revealed that space in the North African novel is significant to the minority narrative, and
in order to write the history of the native, the palimpsestic aspects of space must be
retained so that a countermemory can be written. Space is important to the North African
subject because it is from space that place can be defined, and history can be written
anew.
In stressing the acts of defining space, writing back, and re-constructing identities in
North Africa, this study has demonstrated that the North African Anglophone novel
engages in yet another process of re-writing modernity. To assume that the novel
emerging from North Africa needs to be approached differently, thus stressing the notion
of bricolage, is to conclude that post-colonialism has lost its grip on cultural globalism
without denying “the wisdom of [the] postcolonial” in “advocacy of new vocabularies”
(McLeod 2011, 1). Chapter 5, for instance, proposes that the model of post-coloniality that
prevails in North Africa only contributes to the replacement of a colonial system and its
figures by a post-colonial model of oppression. In the end, this leads merely to the
fabrication of a new term of Post-Colony. Secret Son explains this in two ways: first, it
demonstrates that, sometimes, not to belong may be the ultimate choice that the North
African has to make. This suggestion runs the risk casting everything that is cultural,
familial, and historical aside while engaging in new processes involving the
reconstruction of a transcultural identity based mainly on global incommensurability.
Such aspects are crucial for Amal, who finds in transcultural hybridity the mechanisms to
146
negotiate her place in spatial globalization. Second, in order to contest such a
formulation, it has been explained that the new language, and, especially the holders of
this language, its students, should be aware of the transition to be made in North Africa.
The protagonists in the three novels I have studied in this dissertation either study
English as their major or travel to an Anglophone country where English becomes, not
only a “nightmare”, as the novel Si Yussef suggests, but a liberating tool in North Africa.
The English language becomes the mechanism through which the North African can
negotiate globalization, and if the process fails (with process of re-writing modernity), the
future may also become grim, as has been suggested in Secret Son. The authors
themselves have been exposed to English either through their profession (as teachers of
English) or through scholarship (as students), and this aspect may confirm the
explanation that this study has offered. Furthermore, this study suggests that the North
African Anglophone narrative contributes to the notion of imagining the North African
community, where students of English remain the new possibility to build such an
imagined community.
What this study has not sought to demonstrate, however, is an analysis of the effect
of diaspora on the authors and their novels all together. As I have explained, the three
authors live abroad and their writing springs from their experience of their living outside
the imagined community. Al Khemir now lives in Britain, and Majid and Lalami are
based in the United States. Because I have focused more on the narrative than the author
of that narrative, I have not addressed this point. Nevertheless, as I have pointed out, my
study has taken into consideration some of its important aspects, and I have referred to
these mainly in Chapters 3 and 5. Meanwhile, my study has concluded that politics plays
an important role in these narratives. In spite of the fact that Deleuze and Guattari’s
approach on minority literature is applicable to the North African novel in English, my
study has also revealed that such an approach lacks solidity as an epistemology to locate
the North African novel in English as a minoritarian narrative per se. Concerning politics
and what Deleuze and Guattari emphasize as one of the main characteristics of the
literature of the minoritarian, it is suggested that the North African novel in English
seems to focus more on questions of identity, history, place and space, and location than
on politics. Politics remains a minor tool in the characterization of this emerging
narrative, albeit an important one, because the issues of refining the discourse of post-
colonialism and delimiting its borders – in the way the narratives aim to re-write
modernity – construe the nuanced aspects that define the North African narrative in
English. In saying this, I assume that the availability of diversified case studies in the
future may suggest a variety of aspects concerning politics and minority narratives in
North Africa.
In addition, a comparative study may provide an interesting project for future
research. The notions of minority literature, transculturality, and cultural globalizations
are aspects that affect the use of language. The focus of this dissertation has been on the
English language and how the notion of translation is approached differently in my
study of the novels. To compare these results with an analysis of narratives written in
French and/or Arabic may demonstrate further the influence of those elements on the
notion of re-writing North Africa, which in turn may help in developing this approach.
147
Frequently, as the novels studied show, there is a tendency to demonstrate the effects of
the global flow and Americanization in North Africa. This theme extends beyond the
scope of the present study, but some of its aspects have already been taken into
consideration.
My study has thus concluded that there may be no minority narrative, nor a
postcolonial one, but a Becoming: one that elucidates the transparency of becoming in-
between, as an included middle. North African literary and cultural studies cannot be
viewed only in terms of either Arab or Francophone narratives. Nevertheless, French
especially remains significant in the shaping of North African literary and cultural
studies. English is therefore a new tool and a new paradigm, and in order for the North
African to re-imagine her/his community, s/he aims to belong to transculturality. In
consequence, it may be assumed that English is becoming another possibility through
which specialists in North African literary studies can imagine this field and contribute to
it in a way that is different from the models that already exist. This hypothesis calls for
recognition of the new voices that are emerging from the margin of post-colonialism so
that spaces can be defined and borders can become more hybridized in the era of global
incommensurability.
149
Works Cited
Primary Sources
Al Khemir, Sabiha. Waiting in the Future for the Past to Come. London: Quartet Books, 1993.
Print.
Lalami, Laila. Secret Son. North Carolina: Algonquin Books of Chapel Hill, 2009a. Print.
Majid, Anouar. Si Yussef. 1992. Massachusetts: Interlink Books, 2005. Print.
Secondary Sources
Abdo, Diya M. “Textual Migration: Self-Translation and Translation of the Self in Leila
Abouzeid’s Return to Childhood: The Memoir of a Modern Moroccan Woman and
Ruju’ ’Ila Al-Tufulah.” Frontiers: A Journal of Women Studies 30.2 (2009): 1-42. Print.
Achebe, Chinua. Morning Yet on Creation Day. London: Heinemann, 1975. Print.
---. “Named for Victoria, Queen of England.” The Post-Colonial Studies Reader. Eds. Bill
Ashcroft, Gareth Griffiths, and Helen Tiffin. London: Routledge, 1995. 190-93.
Print.
Ahmad, Aijaz. “The Politics of Literary Postcoloniality.” Race and Class 36.3 (1995): 1-20.
Print.
Aldea, Eva. Magic Realism and Deleuze: The Indiscernibility of Difference in Postcolonial
Literature. London: Continuum, 2011. Print.
Al Jabri, Abed Mohammed and Hassan Hanafi. Dialogue of the Mashreq and Maghreb.
Amman: Dar al Faris Publisher, 1990. (Arabic). Print.
Al Khemir, Sabiha. “Speech to the 2009 National Book Festival.” YouTube, Oct. 2009.
Web. 10 Sept. 2011.
Allende, Isabel. “The Shaman and the Infidel.” New Perspectives Quarterly 8.1 (1991): 54-58.
Print.
Al Maleh, Layla. “Anglophone Arab Literature: An Overview.” Arab Voices in Diaspora:
Critical Perspectives on Anglophone Arab Literature. Ed. Layla Al Maleh. Amsterdam:
Rodopi, 2009. 1-64. Print.
Anderson, Benedict. Imagined Communities. New York: Verso, 1991. Print.
Appiah, Anthony Kwame. “Is the Post – in Postmodernism the Post – in Postcolonial?”
Critical Inquiry 17.2 (1991): 336-57. Print.
Arasanyagam, Jean. 1995. “Time the Destroyer.” All is Burning. New Delhi: Penguin. 53-
83. Print.
Ashcroft, Bill. Caliban’s Voice: The Transformation of English in Post-Colonial Literature.
London: Routledge, 2009. Print.
---. Post-colonial Transformation. New York: Routledge, 2001. Print.
150
---, Gareth Griffiths, and Helen Tiffin. The Empire Writes Back: Theory and Practice in Post-
colonial Literatures. London: Routledge, 2002. Print.
---. Key Concepts in Post-Colonial Studies. London: Routledge, 2001. Print.
---, eds. The Post-Colonial Studies Reader. London: Routledge, 1995. Print.
Ash, Amin. “Multi-ethnicity and the Idea of Europe.” Theory, Culture and Society 21.2
(2004): 1-24. Print.
Attridge, Derek. The Singularity of Literature. London: Routledge, 2004. Print.
Attwell, David. Re-Writing Modernity: Studies in Black South African Literary History.
Scottsville: University of KwaZulu-Natal Press, 2005. Print.
Bachelard, Gaston. The Poetics of Space. Trans. Maria Jolas. Boston: Beacon, 1958. Print.
Bahdur, Gaiutra. “Vulnerable in Morocco.” New York Times, 15 June 2009. Web. 22 Feb.
2010.
Bakhtin, M. Mikhail. The Dialogic Imagination: Four Essays. Ed. Michael Holquist. Austin:
University of Texas Press, 1981. Print.
Bamberg, Michael. “Identity and Narration.” Handbook of Narratology. Eds. Peter Hühn et
al. New York: Walter de Gruyter, 2009. 132-43. Print.
Baronian, Marie-Aude, Stephan Besser, and Yolande Jansen, eds. “Introduction: Diaspora
and Memory: Figures of Displacement in Contemporary Literature, Arts and
Politics.” Diaspora and Memory. Eds. Marie-Aude Baronian et al. Amsterdam:
Rodopi, 2007. 9-16. Print.
Bartels, Emily C. Speaking of the Moor: From Alcazar to Othello. Philadelphia: University of
Pennsylvania Press, 2008. Print.
Beck, Ulrich. The Cosmopolitan Vision. Trans. Ciaran Cronin. Cambridge: Polity, 2006.
Print.
Benjamin, Walter. “Unpacking My Library: A Talk about Book Collecting.” Illuminations.
Ed. Hannah Arendt. Trans. Harry Zohn. New York: Schoken Books, 1982. 59-67.
Print.
Bhabha, Homi K. and John Comaroff. “Speaking of Postcoloniality, in the Continuous
Present: A Conversation between Homi Bhabha and John Comaroff.” Relocating
Postcolonialism. Eds. David Goldberg and Ato Quayson. Oxford: Blackwell, 2002.
15-47. Print.
Bhabha, Homi K. The Location of Culture. London: Routledge, 1994. Print.
---. “Representation and the Colonial Text: Some Forms of Mimeticism.” The Theory of
Reading. Ed. Frank Gloversmith. Brighton: Harvester, 1984. 93-122. Print.
---. “Unpacking My Library… Again.” The Post-Colonial Question: Common Skies, Divided
Horizons. Eds. Iain Chambers and Lidia Curti. New York: Routledge, 1996. 199-212.
Print.
---. “Difference, Discrimination, and the Discourse of Colonialism.” The Politics of Theory:
Proceedings of the Essex Conference on the Sociology of Literature, July 1982. Eds.
Francis Barker, et al. Colchester: University of Essex, 1983: 194-211. Print.
---. “Signs Taken for Wonders: Questions of Ambivalence and Authority under a Tree
Outside Delhi May 1817.”’Race’, Writing and Difference. Eds. Henry Louis Gates, Jr.
Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1986: 163-84. Print.
151
---. “On Minorities: Cultural Rights.” Radical Philosophy 100 (March/April, 2000). Web. 03
June 2010.
---. “On Writing Rights.” In Globalizing Rights: The Oxford Amnesty Lectures 1999. Ed.
Matthew J. Gibney Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2003. 162-83. Print.
Blustein, Jeffrey. The Moral Demands of Memory. New York: Cambridge University Press,
2008. Print.
Bogue, Ronald. “Minor Writing and Minor Literature.” Symplokē 5.1 (1997): 99-118. Print.
---. Deleuze and Guattari. New York: 1989. Print.
Bottomore, Tom et al., eds. A Dictionary of Marxist Thought. Oxford: Blackwell Publishing,
1983. Print.
Boukous, Ahmed. “Globalization and Sociolinguistic Stratification in North Africa: The
Case of Morocco.” Globalization and Language Vitality: Perspectives from Africa. Eds.
Cécile B. Vigouroux and Salikoko S. Mufwene. New York: Continuum, 2008. 126-
141. Print.
Boum, Aomar. “From Little Jerusalems to the Promised Land: Zionism, Moroccan
Nationalism, and Rural Jewish Emigration.” The Journal of North African Studies
15.1 (2009): 51-69. Print.
Bourdieu, Pierre. Language and Symbolic Power. Trans. G. Raymond and M. Adamson.
Cambridge: Polity, 1991. Print.
---. The Field of Cultural Production: Essays on Art and Literature. New York: Columbia
University Press, 1993. Print.
Boym, Svetlana. The Future of Nostalgia. New York: Basic Books, 2001. Print.
Brah, Avtar. Cartographies of Diaspora: Contesting Identities. London: Routledge, 1996. Print.
Brancato, Sabina. “Transcultural Perspectives in Caribbean Poetry.” Transcultural English
Studies: Theories, Fictions, Realities. Eds. Frank Schulze-Engler and Sissy Helff.
Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2009. 233-247. Print.
Butler, Judith. Bodies that Matter: On the Discursive Limits of “Sex”. New York: Routledge,
1993. Print.
Butler, Kim D. “Defining Diaspora, Refining a Discourse.” Diaspora 10.2 (2001): 189-219.
Print.
Carter Dale Erwin. Magical Realism in Contemporary Argentine Fiction. Ann Arbor: U
Microfilms, 1969. Print.
Chambers, Iain. Mediterranean Crossings: The Politics of an Interrupted Modernity. Durham:
Duke University Press, 2008. Print.
---. “Signs of Silences, Lines of Listening.” In The Post-colonial Question: Common Skies,
Divided Horizons. Eds. Ian Chambers and Lidia Curti. London: Routledge, 2001. 47-
64. Print.
Chamberlin, Edward J. “Naming the World.” Major Minorities: English Literature in
Transit. Ed. Raoul Granqvist. Amsterdam: Rodopi, 1993. 187-96. Print.
Childs, Peter, et al. Postcolonial Theory and Literature: African, Caribbean and South Asia.
Trier: WVT, 2006. Print.
Cixous, Hélène and Catherine Clement. The Newly Born Woman. Manchester: Manchester
University Press, 1986. Print.
152
Coste, Didier and John Pier. “Narrative Levels.” Handbook of Narratology. Eds. Peter Hühn
et al. Berlin: Walter de Gruyter, 2009. 295-308. Print.
Crane, Susan A. “Writing the Individual Back into the Collective Memory.” The American
Historical Review 102.5 (1997): 1372-1385. Print.
Dainotto, Roberto M. Europe (In Theory). Durham: Duke University Press, 2007. Print.
Das, Kamala. Kamala Das: A Selection, With Essays on Her Works. Ed. S. Harrex and V.
O’Sullivan. Adelaide: CRNLE, 1986. Print.
Deleuze, Gilles and Felix Guattari. Kafka: Toward a Minor Literature. Trans. Dana Poland.
Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1986. Print.
---. A Thousand Plateaus: Capitalism and Schizophrenia. 1987. Minnesota: University of
Minnesota Press, 2004. Print.
---. Critique et Clinique. Paris: Minuit, 1993. Print.
Derrida, Jacques. Writing and Difference. 1967. Trans. Alan Bass. London: Routledge, 2005.
Print.
---. Of Grammatology. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1976. Print.
---. Adieu to Emmanuel Levinas. Trans. Pascale-Anne Brault and Micheal Naas. Stanford:
Stanford University Press, 1999. Print.
---. Of Hospitality. Trans. Rachel Bowlby. Stanford: Stanford University Press, 2000. Print.
Dirlik, Arif. The Postcolonial Aura: Third World Criticism in the Age of Globalism. Boulder:
Westview Press, 1997. Print.
Djiar, Kahina A. “Symbolism and Memory in Architecture: Algerian Anti-Colonial
Resistence and the Algiers Casbah.” The Journal of North African Studies 14.5 (2009):
185-202.
Elkhouche, Mohamed. “Picturing the Interzone: Tangier in P. Bowles' Let It Come
Down and A. Majid's Si Yussef.” Space and Place Blog. 1 Mar. 2008. Web. 11 Feb.
2011.
Ella, Shohat. “Notes on the Postcolonial.” Social Text 31/32 (1992): 99-113. Print.
Erichsen, Ulrike . “A ‘True-True’ Voice” The Problem of Authenticity.” Being/s in Transit:
Traveling, Migration, Dislocation. Ed. Liselotte Glage. Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2000.
193-204. Print.
Fakir, Fadia. “Lost in Translation.” Index 33.2 (2004): 166-70. Print.
Faris, Wendy B. “The Question of the Other: Cultural Critique of Magical Realism.”Janus
Head 5.2 (2002): 101-119. Print.
Foucault, Michel. “Nietzsche, Genealogy, History.” Language, Countermemory, Practice. Ed.
Donald F. Bouchard. New York: Cornell University Press, 1977. 139-164. Print.
Gana, Nouri. “In Search of Andalusia: Reconfiguring Arabness in Diana Abu-Jaber’s
Crescent.” Comparative Literature Studies 45.2 (2008): 228-246.
---. "Everyday Arabness: The Poetics of Arab Canadian Literature and Culture." CR: The
New Centennial Review 9.2 (2009): 21-44.
Gates, Louis Henry Jr. “Critical Fanonism.” Critical Inquiry 17.3 (1991): 457-70. Print.
Geoffrey, Nash. The Arab Writer in English: Arab themes in a Metropolitan Language, 1908-
1958. Sussex: Sussex Academic Press, 1998. Print.
Gerald, Martin. “On ‘Magical’ and Social Realism in Garcia Marquez.” Garcia Marquez.
Ed. Robin Fiddian. London: Longman, 1995. 100-120. Print.
153
Giddens, Anthony. The Consequences of Modernity. Cambridge: Polity Press, 1990. Print.
Goldberg, Nan. “Betrayals Expose Fragility of Family and Faith.” The Boston Globe. 3 Aug.
2009. Web. 01 Oct. 2010.
Graiouid, Said. “A Place on the Terrace: Café Culture and the Public Sphere in Morocco.”
The Journal of North African Studies 12.4 (2007): 531-550. Print.
Gram-Hanssen, Kirsten and Claus Bech-Danielsen. “House, Home and Identity from a
Consumption Perspective.” Housing, Theory and Society 21.1 (2004): 17-26. Print.
Greene, Lee J. The Diasporan Self: Unbreaking the Circle in Western Black Novels.
Charlottesville: University of Virginia Press, 2008. Print.
Grossberg, Lawrence. “The Space of Culture, the Power of Space.” The Post-colonial
Question: Common Skies, Divided Horizons. Eds. Ian Chambers and Lidia Curti.
London: Routledge, 2001. 169-188. Print.
Guignery, Vanessa. Voices and Silence in the Contemporary Novel in English. Newcastle:
Cambridge Scholars Publishing, 2009. Print.
Gunesekera, Romesh. The Sunglass. London: Granta, 1998. Print.
Gunther, Richard. “Morocco’s Last Jews.” Judaism Fall, 1997. Web. 14 Mar. 2011.
Gupta, Suman. Globalization and Literature. Cambridge: Polity Press, 2009.
Hakkarainen, Marja-Leena. “German Home and Hybridity: Reclaiming New Cultural
Identities in Selected German Migrant Narratives From the 1990s.” Cultural
Identities in Transition: Contemporary Conditions, Practices and Politics of A Global
Phenomenon. Eds. Jari Kupiainen, Erkki Sevänen, and John A. Stotesbury. New
Delhi: Atlantic Publishers and Distributors, 2004. 191-204. Print.
Halbwachs, Maurice. The Collective Memory. 1951. Trans. Francis J. Ditter, Jr. and Vida
Yazdi Ditter. New York: Harper and Row, 1980. Print.
Hall, Stuart. “When was ‘the Post-colonial’? Thinking at the Limit.” The Post-Colonial
Question: Common Skies, Divided Horizons. Eds. Iain Chambers and Lidia Curti.
New York: Routledge, 1996. 242-260.
Harrell, Richard S. and Sobelman Harvey, eds. A Dictionary of Moroccan Arabic: Moroccan-
English, English-Moroccan. Georgetown: Georgetown University Press, 1983. Print.
Heidegger, Martin. Poetry, Language, and Thought. Trans. Albert Hofstadter. New York:
Harper and Row, 1971. Print.
Heise, Ursula K. “Deterritorialization and Eco-Cosmopolitanism.” Literature and
Globalization: A Reader. Eds. Liam Connell and Nicky Marsh. London: Routledge,
2011. 157-170. Print.
Hermans, H. J. M. et al. “Imaginal Dialogues in the Self: Theory and Method.” Journal of
Personality 61.2 (1993): 207-236. Print.
Helff, Sissy. “Shifting Perspectives: The Transcultural Novel.” Transcultural English
Studies: Theories, Fictions, Realities. Eds. Frank Schulze-Engler and Sissy Helff.
Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2009. 75-90. Print.
Hoffman, Eva. Lost in Translation. London: Vintage, 1998. Print.
Huggan, Graham. “Postcolonialism, Globalization, and the Rise of (Trans) Cultural
Studies.” Towards a Transcultural Future: Literature and Society in a ’Post’-Colonial
World. Eds. Geoffrey V. Davis et al. Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2004. 27-35. Print.
---. The Postcolonial Exotic: Marketing the Margins. London: Routledge, 2001. Print.
154
Hulme, Peter. Colonial Encounters: Europe and the Native Caribbean 1492-1797. New York:
Routledge, 1992.
Huntington, Samuel P. “The Clash of Civilizations?” Foreign Affairs 72.3 (1993): 22-4.
Print.
Huttunen, Tuomas et al. “Introduction.” Seeking the Self—Encountering the Other: Diasporic
Narrative and the Ethics of Representation. Eds. Tuomas Huttunen et al. Newcastle:
Cambridge Scholars Publishing, 2008. хі-ххіі. Print.
Israel, Nico. Outlandish. California: Stanford UP, 2000. Print.
Jay, Paul. Global Matters: The Transnational Turn in Literary Studies. New York: Cornell
University Press, 2010. Print.
Jelinek, M. Hena. “Postcolonial Criticism at the Crossroads: Subjective Questionings of
an Old-Timer.” Towards a Transcultural Future: Literature and Society in a ’Post’-
Colonial World. Eds. Geoffrey V. Davis et al. Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2004. 1-19. Print.
Jondot, Jacqueline. Les Ecrivains d'Expression Anglaise au Proche Orient Arabe. Diss.
Université Lyon II Lumière. Limag: Littératures du Maghreb, 2003. Web. 01 Dec.
2009.
Kaplan, Caren. Questions of Travel: Postmodern Discourse of Displacement. Durham and
London: Duke University Press, 1996. Print.
---. “Deterritorialization: The Rewriting of Home and Exile in Western Feminist
Discourse.” Cultural Critique 6 (Spring 1987): 187-98. Print.
Kaplan, Cora. Sea Changes: Essays on Culture and Feminism. London: Verso, 1986. Print.
Klor De Alva, Jorge. “The Postcolonialization of the (Latin) American Experience: A
Reconsideration of ‘Colonialism,’ ‘Postcolonialism,’ and ‘Mestizaje.’” After
Colonialism, Imperial Histories and Postcolonial Displacements. Ed. Gyan Paraksh.
Princeton: Princeton University Press, 1995. 241-78. Print.
Koelb, Clayton. “Kafka: Toward a Minor Literature (review).” MFS Modern Fiction
Studies 33.2 (1987): 376-78. Print.
Kristeva, Julia. “The Impudence of Uttering: The Mother Tongue.” Trans. Anne
Marsella. Julia Kristeva. Web. 10 Mar. 2010.
Kuortti, Joel and Jopi Nyman. “Introduction: Hybridity Today.” Reconstructing Hybridity:
Post-Colonial Studies in Transition. Eds. Joel Kuortti and Jopi Nyman. Amsterdam:
Rodopi, 2007. 1-18. Print.
Laamiri, Mohammed. “Writing North Africa: Maghrebi Literature in English: A General
Introduction and Bibliography.” British Council, 2008. Web. 12 Apr. 2010.
---. “Tangier’s City Space: Between Colonial History, Tourist Geography, and Modern
Urban Development.” Tangier at the Crossroads. Eds. Barry Tharaud, Jose M. G.
Perez M. and George F. Robertson . Tangier: ICPS, 2009. 11-26. Print.
La Capra, Dominick. Writing History, Writing Trauma. Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins
University Press, 2001. Print.
Lalami, Laila and Belinda, Otas. “In Conversation: Laila Lalami.” Belinda Otas: Telling it
like it is! belindaotas.com. 11 Oct. 2010. Web. 23 Dec. 2010.
Lalami, Laila. “So To Speak.” World Literature Today: Essays. (Sep.-Oct. 2009b): 18-20. Web.
1 Jan. 2011. Print.
---. “Secret Son: About the Book.” LailaLalami.com. May 2009c. Web. 10 Feb. 2010.
155
---. “The Lamalif Years.” Blog Archive. LailaLalami.com. 15 Feb. 2007. Web. 10 Jan. 2011.
Lamming, George. The Pleasure of Exile. London: Alison and Busby, 1984. Print.
Lauret, Maria. Alice Walker. New York: Macmillan Press, 2000. Print.
Lennon, Brian. In Babel’s Shadow: Multicultural Literatures, Monolingual States. Minnesota:
University of Minnesota Press, 2010. Print.
Lévi-Strauss, Claude. The Savage Mind. Trans. John and Doreen Weightman. Chicago:
University of Chicago University.1966. Print.
Lingan, John. “Secret Son by Laila Lalami: Review.” The Quarterly Conversation 16 (2009).
N.pag. Web. 14 June 2010.
Loomba, Ania. Colonialism/Postcolonialism. New York: Routledge, 2005. Print.
Majid, Anouar. We Are All Moors: Ending Centuries of Crusades against Muslims and Other
Minorities. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 2009. Print.
---. “Interview with Mokhtar Ghambou.” Wafin: Moroccan Connections in America. Feb.
2002. Web. 14 Feb. 2011.
Malak, Amin. Muslim Narrative and the Discourse of English. New York: State University of
New York Press, 2005. Print.
Manferlotti, Stefano. “Writers from Elsewhere.” The Post-Colonial Question: Common Skies,
Divided Horizons. Eds. Ian Chambers and Lidia Curti. London: Routledge, 2001.
189-98. Print.
Marie Law, Jane. “Introduction: Cultural Memory, the Past and the Static of the Present.”
Acta Orientalia Vilnesia 7.2 (2006): 7-12. Print.
Martin, Biddy and Chandra Talpade Mohanty. “Feminist Politics: What’s Home Got to
Do with It?” Feminist Studies/Critical Studies. Ed. Teresa de Lauretis. London:
Macmillan, 1988. 191-211.
McGuire, James. “Forked Tongues, Marginal Bodies: Writing as Translation in Khatibi
(Moroccan Bilingual Writer Abdelkebir Khatibi).” Research in African Literatures
23.1 (1991): 107-10. Print.
McLeod, John. “Sounding Silence: Thresholds of Transculturation.” Post/Colonial and
Transcultural: Contending Modernities, Presaging Globalisation. Conference
presentation, Riga, Latvia 10-12 Sep. 2010.
---. “Sounding Silence: Transculturation and its Thresholds.” Transnational Literature 4.1
(2011): 1-13. Web. 1 Dec. 2012.
Melyani, Mohemmed. “Mémoire collective et transmission symbolique : ‘J’ai vu, moi,
Mohammed V sur la lune !’” The 3rd International Conference- Narrations: the Paths
of Life, the Paths of History. Web. 14-15 Sep. 2007, Academy of Humanities and
Economics in Lodz. 10 Aug. 2011.
Mills, Sara. Gender and Colonial Space. Manchester: Manchester University Press, 2005.
Print.
Minh-ha, Trinh. “Mothers Talk.” Politics of Mothering: Womanhood, Identity and Resistance
in African Literature. Ed. Obioma Nnaemeka. London: Routledge, 1997. 26-32.
Print.
Mirzoeff, Nicolas. “Transculture: From Kongo to the Congo.” An Introduction to Visual
Culture. Ed. Nicolas Mirzoeff. London: Routledge, 1999. 129-61. Print.
156
Morrison, Toni. “Unspeakable Things Unspoken: The Afro-American Presence in
American Literature.” Tanner Lectures. October 7 Oct.1988. Web. 10 Oct. 2009.
---. “The Site of Memory.” Inventing in the Truth: The Art and Craft of Memoire. Ed. William
Zinsser. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1987. 101-124. Print.
---. Beloved. New York: Penguin Books, 1988. Print.
Mullins, Greg. Colonial Affairs: Bowles, Burroughs, and Chester Write Tangier. London:
University of Wisconsin Press, 2002. Print.
Murray, Melanie A. “Empire and the House in Postcolonial Fiction: Lawrence Scott’s
Witchbroom, Romesh Gunesekera’s The Sandglass and Jean Arasanyagam’s ‘Time
the Destroyer.’” Journal of Postcolonial Writing 45.4 (2009): 438-448. Print.
Nasri, Chourouq. “Tangier: A Place Reinvented, Made and Unmade by Anouar Majid in
Si Yussef.” Representing Minorities: Studies in Literature and Criticism. Eds. Larbi
Touaf and Soumia Boukhtil. Newcastle: Cambridge Scholars Press, 2005. 27-37.
Print.
Njubi, Francis, N. “African Intellectuals in the Belly of the Beast: Migration, Identity and
the Politics of Exile.” 2002. Web. 6 Nov. 2008.
Nora, Pierre. “Between Memory and History: Les Lieux de Mémoire.” Representations 26
(1989): 7-24. Print.
Nnaemeka, Obioma. “Urban Spaces, Women’s Places: Polygamy as Sign in Mariama Bâ's
Novels.” Politics of Mothering: Womanhood, Identity & Resistance in African Literature.
Ed. Obioma Nnaemeka. London: Routledge, 1997: 162-191. Print.
Nyman, Jopi. Home, Identity, and Mobility in Contemporary Diasporic Fiction. Amsterdam:
Rodopi, 2009. Print.
Olaussen, Maria. “Refusing to Speak as a Victim: Agency and the Arrivant in Abdulraza
Gurnah’s By the Sea.”Africa Writing Europe: Opposition, Juxtaposition, Entanglement.
Eds. Maria Olaussen and Christina Angelfors. Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2009. 217-44.
O’Riley, Michael F. “Place, Position, and Postcolonial Haunting in Assia Djebar’s La
Femme Sans Sepulture.” Research in African Literatures 35.1 (2004): 66-86. Print.
Orlando, Valérie K. “Feminine Spaces and Places in the Dark Recesses of Morocco's Past:
the Prison Testimonials in Poetry and Prose of Saïda Menebhi and Fatna El
Bouih.” Journal of North African Studies 15.3 (2010): 273-88. Print.
Ortiz, Fernando. Cuban Counterpoint: Tobacco and Sugar. Trans. Harriet de Onís. Durham:
Duke University Press. 1995. Print.
Pfanner, Eric. “AuFeminin Looks to Expand Its Reach”. International Herald Tribune. 8
Nov. 2010: 14
Pohen, Karen. Playing the Cosmic Game: Exploring Play’s Archetypal Aspects Through the
Kaleidoscope of Culture. 2003. Web 2003. 17 May 2010.
Pratt, Mary Louise. Imperial Eyes: Travel Writing and Transculturation. London: Routledge,
1995. Print.
Radhakrishnan, R. “Nationalism, Gender, and the Narrative of Identity”. Nationalisms
and Sexualities. Eds. Andrew Parker et al. New York: Routledge, 1992. 77-95. Print.
Raphael, Dallo. “Emplotting Post-Coloniality: Usable Pasts, Possible Futures, and the
Relentless Present.” Diaspora: A Journal of Transnational Studies 13.1 (2004): 129-40.
Print.
157
Raussert, Wilfried and Reinhard Isensee. “Transcultural Visions of Identities in Images
and Texts—Transatlantic American Studies.” Transcultural Visions of Identities in
Images and Texts—Transatlantic American Studies. Eds. Raussert Wilfried and
Isensee Reinhard. Heidelberg: Universitätsverlag Winter Press, 2008. 1-12. Print.
Renza, Lewis A. A White Heron and the Question of Minor Literature. Wisconsin: University
of Wisconsin, 1984. Print.
Richter, Virginia. “Authenticity: Why We Still Need It Although It Doesn’t Exist.”
Transcultural English Studies: Theories, Fictions, Realities. Eds. Frank Schulze-Engler
and Sissy Helff. Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2009. 59-74. Print.
Rushdie, Salman. Imaginary Homelands. London: Granta Books, 1991. Print.
Sabour, M’hammed. “Contradictions within Higher Education: An Assessment of the
Vocations and Prospects of Moroccan Universities.” International Journal of
Contemporary Sociology 40.1 (2003): 153-173. Print.
Sadiqi, Fatima. “Women and Linguistic Space in Morocco.” Women and Language 26.1
(Spring 2003): 35-43. Print.
Safran, William. “Deconstructing and Comparing Diaspora.” Diaspora, Identity and
Religion: New Directions in Theory and Research. Eds. Waltraud Kokot, Khachig
Tölölyan, and Carolin Alfonso. London: Routledge, 2004. 9-30. Print.
Said, Edward. Orientalism. New York: Vintage Books, 1979. Print.
---. The World, the Text, and the Critic. Massachusetts: Harvard University Press, 1983.
Print.
Salaita, Steven. Arab American Literary Fictions, Cultures, and Politics. New York: Palgrave
Macmillan, 2007. Print.
Schulze-Engler, Frank. “Introduction.” Transcultural English Studies: Theories, Fictions,
Realities. Eds. Frank Schulze-Engler and Sissy Helff. Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2009. ix-
xvi. Print.
---. “From Postcolonial to Preglobal: Transnational Culture and the Resurgent Project of
Modernity.” Towards a Transcultural Future: Literature and Society in a ’Post’-Colonial
World. Eds. Geoffrey V. Davis et al. Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2004. 49-64. Print.
Seyhan, Azade. Writing Outside the Nation. Oxford: Princeton University Press, 2001.
Print.
Shapiro, S. H. Losing Heart: The Moral and Spiritual Miseducation of America's Children. New
Jersey: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates, 2006. Print.
Shear, Adam. “Reading by Sabhia Al Khemir”. Ex Cathedra. 20 Oct. 2008. Web. 11 Sept.
2011.
Simon-López, Alexandra. Hypersurrealism: Surrealist Literary Hypertexts. Joensuu:
University of Eastern Finland, 2010. Print.
Slemon, Stephen. “Modernism’s Last Post”. In Past the Last Post: Theorizing Postcolonialism
and Postmodernism. Eds. Adan Ian and Helen Tiffin. Hemel Hempstead: Harvester,
1991. 1-11. Print.
Spivak, Gayatri C. “Can the Subaltern Speak?” Marxism and the Interpretation of Culture.
Eds. Cary Nelson and Lawrence Grossberg. London: Macmillan, 1988. 271-313.
Print.
158
Stein, Mark. “The Location of Transculture.” Transcultural English Studies: Theories,
Fictions, Realities. Eds. Frank Schulze-Engler and Sissy Helff. Amsterdam: Rodopi,
2009. 251-266. Print.
Suhr, Heidrun. “Ausländerliteratur: Minority Literature in Federal Republic of
Germany.” New German Critique 46 (1989): 71-103. Print.
Thieme, John. Postcolonial Con-Texts: Writing Back to the Canon. London and New York:
Continuum, 2001. Print.
Tomlinson, John. Globalization and Culture. Cambridge: Polity, 1999. Print.
Touaf, Larbi. “Memory, History, and Narrative Ethics in the Writing of Edmund Amran
El Maleh.” Representing Minorities: Studies in Literature and Criticism. Eds. Larbi
Touaf and Soumia Boukhtil. Newcastle: Cambridge Scholars Publishing, 2005.
150-59. Print.
Trebelsi, Hechmi. “Transcultural Writing: Ahdaf Soueif's Aisha.” Jouvert 2.7 (2003). N.p.
Web. 12 Dec. 2010.
Turner, Victor. Dramas, Fields, and Metaphors: Symbolic Action in Human Society. London:
Cornell University Press, 1974. Print.
Walcott, Derek. The Castway and Other Poems. London: Cape, 1965. Print.
Warnes, Christopher. Magic Realism and the Postcolonial Novel: Between Faith and
Irreverence. New York: Palgrave Macmillan, 2009. Print
Weber, Samuel. “The Vaulted Eye: Remarks on Knowledge and Professionalism.” Yale
French Studies 77 (1990): 44-60. Print.
Welsch, Wolfgang. “Transculturality – The Puzzling Form of Cultures Today.” 1999.
Web. University of Jena. 10 Sep. 2010.
---. “On the Acquisition and Procession of Commonalities”. Transcultural English Studies:
Theories, Fictions, Realities. Eds. Frank Schulze-Engler and Sissy Helff. Amsterdam:
Rodopi, 2009. 3-36. Print.
Werbner, Pnina. “Introduction: the Dialects of Cultural Hybridity.” Debating Cultural
Hybridity: Multi-Cultural Identities and the Politics of Anti-Racism. Eds. Pnina
Werbner and Tariq Modood. London: Zed, 1997. 1-26. Print.
Westmoreland, Mark W. “Interruptions: Derrida and Hospitality.” Kritik 2.1 (2008): 1-10.
Print.
West-Pavlov, Russell. Transcultural Graffiti: Diasporic Writing and the Teaching of Literary
Studies. Amsterdam: Rodopi, 2005. Print.
White, Hayden. Metahistory: The Historical Imagination in Nineteenth-Century Europe.
London: John Hopkins, 1973. Print.
Wise, Christopher. “Excavating The New Republic: Post-colonial Subjectivity in Achebe's
Things Fall Apart.” Callaloo 22.4 (1999): 1054-1065. Print.
Wood, Michael. “In Reality.” Janus Head 5.2 (2002): 9-14. Print.
Woods, Tim. African Pasts: Memory and History in African Literatures. Manchester:
Manchester University Press, 2007. Print.
Young, Iris Marion. On Female Body Experience: Throwing Like a Girl and Other Essays. New
York: Oxford University Press, 2005. Print.
Yuval-Davis, Nira. Gender and Nation. London: Sage, 1997. Print.
159
PUBLICATIONS OF THE UNIVERSITY OF EASTERN FINLAND
DISSERTATIONS IN EDUCATION, HUMANITIES, AND THEOLOGY
1. Taru Viinikainen. Taipuuko “akrobaatti Aleksandra”? Nimikekonstruktio ja nimikkeen
taipuminen lehtikielessä 1900-luvulta 2000-luvulle. 2010.
2. Pekka Metso. Divine Presence in the Eucharistic Theology of Nicholas Cabasilas. 2010.
3. Pekka Kilpeläinen. In Search of a Postcategorical Utopia. James Baldwin and the Politics
of ‘Race’ and Sexuality. 2010.
4. Leena Vartiainen. Yhteisöllinen käsityö. Verkostoja, taitoja ja yhteisiä elämyksiä. 2010.
5. Alexandra Simon-López. Hypersurrealism. Surrealist Literary Hypertexts. 2010.
6. Merja Sagulin. Jälkiä ajan hiekassa. Kontekstuaalinen tutkimus Daniel Defoen Robinson
Crusoen suomenkielisten adaptaatioiden aatteellisista ja kirjallisista traditioista sekä
subjektikäsityksistä. 2010.
7. Pirkko Pollari. Vapaan sivistystyön kieltenopettajien pedagogiset ratkaisut ja käytänteet
teknologiaa hyödyntävässä vieraiden kielten opetuksessa. 2010.
8. Ulla Piela. Kansanparannuksen kerrotut merkitykset Pohjois-Karjalassa 1800- ja 1900-
luvuilla. 2010.
9. Lea Meriläinen. Language Transfer in the Written English of Finnish Students. 2010.
10. Kati Aho-Mustonen. Group Psychoeducation for Forensic Long-term Patients with
Schizophrenia. 2011.
11. Anne-Maria Nupponen. »Savon murre» savolaiskorvin. Kansa murteen havainnoijana.
2011.
12. Teemu Valtonen. An Insight into Collaborative Learning with ICT: Teachers’ and
Students’ Perspectives. 2011.
13. Teemu Kakkuri. Evankelinen liike kirkossa ja yhteiskunnassa 1944-1963. Aktiivinen
uudistusliike ja konservatiivinen sopeutuja. 2011.
14. Riitta Kärkkäinen. Doing Better? Children's and Their Parents' and Teachers'
Perceptions of the Malleability of the Child's Academic Competences. 2011.
15. Jouko Kiiski. Suomalainen avioero 2000-luvun alussa. Miksi avioliitto puretaan, miten
ero koetaan ja miten siitä selviydytään. 2011.
16. Liisa Timonen. Kansainvälisty tai väisty? Tapaustutkimus kansainvälisyysosaamisen ja
kulttuurienvälisen oppimisen merkityksenannoista oppijan, opettajan ja
korkeakoulutoimijan pedagogisen suhteen rajaamissa kohtaamisen tiloissa. 2011.
17. Matti Vänttinen. Oikeasti hyvä numero. Oppilaiden arvioinnin totuudet ja
totuustuotanto rinnakkaiskoulusta yhtenäiskouluun. 2011.
18. Merja Ylönen. Aikuiset opin poluilla. Oppimistukikeskuksen asiakkaiden
opiskelukokemuksista ja kouluttautumishalukkuudelle merkityksellisistä tekijöistä. 2011.
19. Kirsi Pankarinkangas. Leskien keski-iässä tai myöhemmällä iällä solmimat uudet
avioliitot. Seurantatutkimus. 2011.
20. Olavi Leino. Oppisopimusopiskelijan oppimisen henkilökohtaistaminen ja
oppimismahdollisuudet työpaikalla. 2011.
21. Kristiina Abdallah. Translators in Production Networks. Reflections on Agency, Quality
and Ethics. 2012.
22. Riina Kokkonen. Mittarissa lapsen keho ja vanhemmuus – tervettä lasta sekä ”hyvää”
ja ”huonoa” vanhemmuutta koskevia tulkintoja nyky-Suomessa. 2012.
23. Ari Sivenius. Aikuislukion eetos opettajien merkityksenantojen valossa. 2012.
160
24. Kamal Sbiri. Voices from the Margin. Rethinking History, Identity, and Belonging in the
Contemporary North African Anglophone Novel. 2012.
Publications of the University of Eastern Finland
Dissertations in Education, Humanities, and Theology
isbn 978-952-61-0678-6
issn 1798-5625
Publications of the University of Eastern FinlandDissertations in Education, Humanities, and Theology No 24
Kamal Sbiri
Voices from the Margin Rethinking History, Identity, and Belonging in the Contemporary North African Anglophone Novel
Voices from the Margin is a study
that seeks to engage in the post-
colonial debate on the notions of
history, identity, and belonging. By
analyzing three contemporary North
African novels in English, the study
attempts to negotiate alternative
modernities in order to accommodate
those histories in the margin in a
transcultural context. The thesis
shows that transcultural belonging
can help capture the voices in the
margin and help them engage in
a process of reconstructing their
identities in a global milieu.
disser
tation
s | No
24 | Ka
ma
l Sb
iri | V
oices from
the M
argin
Kamal SbiriVoices from the Margin
Rethinking History, Identity, and Belonging in the Con-temporary North African
Anglophone Novel
Top Related